typoes
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.86"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552015
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.endtable
440
441The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448.cindex "web site"
449.cindex "FTP site"
450The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457.cindex "wiki"
458.cindex "FAQ"
459As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496.cindex "training courses"
497Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503.cindex "bug reports"
504.cindex "reporting bugs"
505Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513.cindex "FTP site"
514.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516.display
517&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518.endd
519This is mirrored by
520.display
521&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522.endd
523The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534.endd
535where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540.cindex "distribution" "public key"
541.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554&url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564.endd
565For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573.display
574&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578.endd
579These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584.ilist
585.cindex "limitations of Exim"
586.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592.next
593.cindex "domainless addresses"
594.cindex "address" "without domain"
595Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599arrival.
600.next
601.cindex "transport" "external"
602.cindex "external transports"
603The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609.next
610Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613other means.
614.next
615Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619a number of common scanners are provided.
620.endlist
621
622
623.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6403, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652.cindex "terminology definitions"
653.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656below) by a blank line.
657
658.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665rise to further bounce messages.
666
667The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670otherwise.
671
672The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675until a later time.
676
677The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681.cindex "envelope, definition of"
682.cindex "sender" "definition of"
683A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691.cindex "header section" "definition of"
692The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696line.
697
698.cindex "local part" "definition of"
699.cindex "domain" "definition of"
700The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711.cindex "return path" "definition of"
712&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713message's envelope.
714
715.cindex "queue" "definition of"
716The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743.cindex "incorporated code"
744.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745.cindex "PCRE"
746.cindex "OpenDMARC"
747A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749.ilist
750Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756.next
757.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762following statements:
763
764.blockquote
765Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770version.
771This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775restrictions applied to it).
776.endblockquote
777.next
778.cindex "SPA authentication"
779.cindex "Samba project"
780.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784under the Gnu GPL.
785.next
786.cindex "Cyrus"
787.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792conditions expressed therein.
793
794.blockquote
795Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799are met:
800
801.olist
802Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804.next
805Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808distribution.
809.next
810The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813details, please contact
814.display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821.endd
822.next
823Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824acknowledgment:
825
826&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836.endlist
837.endblockquote
838
839.next
840.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841.cindex "X-windows"
842.cindex "Athena"
843The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848.blockquote
849Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852All Rights Reserved
853
854Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868SOFTWARE.
869.endblockquote
870
871.next
872.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877source code.
878
879.next
880Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883.endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897.cindex "design philosophy"
898Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907.cindex "policy control" "overview"
908Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914.ilist
915.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924error code.
925.next
926An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928.next
929When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933.next
934When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939.next
940Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943.next
944After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946runs at the start of every delivery process.
947.endlist
948
949
950
951.section "User filters" "SECID12"
952.cindex "filter" "introduction"
953.cindex "Sieve filter"
954In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959of filtering are available:
960
961.ilist
962Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963by RFC 3028.
964.next
965Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967.endlist
968
969User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975.cindex "format" "of message id"
976.cindex "id of message"
977.cindex "base62"
978.cindex "base36"
979.cindex "Darwin"
980.cindex "Cygwin"
981Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988not always case-sensitive.
989
990.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996somewhat eccentric:
997
998.ilist
999The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002way of representing the date and time of day).
1003.next
1004After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005received the message.
1006.next
1007There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008.olist
1009.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014.next
1015If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017(1/100) of a second.
1018.endlist
1019.endlist
1020
1021After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029.cindex "receiving mail"
1030.cindex "message" "reception"
1031The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034there are several possibilities:
1035
1036.ilist
1037If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040.next
1041If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047.next
1048If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053.next
1054A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058.endlist
1059
1060
1061.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112affect file system performance.
1113
1114The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136.cindex "message" "life of"
1137.cindex "message" "frozen"
1138A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150to be sent.
1151
1152.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158.cindex "message" "log file for"
1159.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168systems.
1169
1170.cindex "journal file"
1171.cindex "file" "journal"
1172All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191.cindex "router" "definition of"
1192.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207the driver's features in general.
1208
1209A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213to be bounced.
1214
1215A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232configuration.
1233
1234The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242configured to fail the address.
1243
1244The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261.cindex "router" "for verification"
1262.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267&%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282.cindex "router" "running details"
1283.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284.cindex "router" "result of running"
1285As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289the following:
1290
1291.ilist
1292&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294original address ceases,
1295.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300end of routing.
1301
1302Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307.next
1308&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313.next
1314&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319.next
1320&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323.next
1324&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328.next
1329&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331.endlist
1332
1333If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347.cindex "case of local parts"
1348.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365.ilist
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409.next
1410.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412.vindex "&$home$&"
1413If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417remaining preconditions.
1418.next
1419If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423could lead to confusion.
1424.next
1425If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426set of addresses that it defines.
1427.next
1428If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429specified files is tested.
1430.next
1431.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435.endlist
1436
1437
1438Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452.ilist
1453If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458filtering'&.
1459.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468filter.
1469.next
1470Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474processed entirely independently of each other.
1475.next
1476.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485.next
1486When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493addresses to the same domain.
1494.next
1495Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503.next
1504.cindex "queue runner"
1505When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514.next
1515.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521.next
1522If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525messages to other addresses.
1526.next
1527.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530&'deferred'&.
1531.next
1532When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535.endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543.cindex "queue runner"
1544Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551passed its retry time.
1552You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572also apply.
1573
1574If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577deferred,
1578.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602automatically.
1603
1604.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639.table2 140pt
1640.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648.endtable
1649
1650Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653.table2 140pt
1654.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661.endtable
1662
1663The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674system.
1675.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683.cindex "PCRE library"
1684Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692If your operating system has no
1693PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725possibilities:
1726
1727.olist
1728A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730.next
1731.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735file name is used unmodified.
1736.next
1737.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741.next
1742If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745.next
1746To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17482.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752.next
1753.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756operates on a single file.
1757.endlist
1758
1759.cindex "USE_DB"
1760.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765.code
1766USE_DB=yes
1767.endd
1768Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780in one of these lines:
1781.code
1782DBMLIB = -ldb
1783DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784.endd
1785Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789this example:
1790.code
1791INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793.endd
1794There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825be logged.
1826
1827.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830facilities, you need to set
1831.code
1832WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833.endd
1834in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857.cindex "RFC 2047"
1858The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871.code
1872HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873.endd
1874to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888line option).
1889
1890If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892implementing SSL.
1893
1894If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895.code
1896SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898.endd
1899in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901.code
1902SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905.endd
1906.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908.code
1909SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911.endd
1912.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914.code
1915SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926.endd
1927.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929.code
1930SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933.endd
1934
1935You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956you might have
1957.code
1958USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961.endd
1962in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964.code
1965exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966.endd
1967in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973further details.
1974
1975
1976.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982library files.
1983
1984Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989Exim used to
1990have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996.cindex "lookup modules"
1997.cindex "dynamic modules"
1998.cindex ".so building"
1999On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001on demand.
2002This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004dependencies.
2005Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017on demand:
2018.code
2019LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022.endd
2023
2024
2025.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026.cindex "build directory"
2027Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057.code
2058FULLECHO='' make -e
2059.endd
2060The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073order:
2074.display
2075&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077&_Local/Makefile_&
2078&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082.endd
2083.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089and are often not needed.
2090
2091The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106default values are.
2107
2108
2109.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121containing the lines
2122.code
2123CC=cc
2124CFLAGS=-std1
2125.endd
2126If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144.code
2145LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148.endd
2149and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157errors.
2158
2159.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169syntax. For instance:
2170.code
2171LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177.endd
2178
2179.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182.code
2183EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184.endd
2185must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194.code
2195X11=/usr/X11R6
2196XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198.endd
2199These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201.code
2202X11=/usr/openwin
2203XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205.endd
2206If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207definition of all three of these variables into your
2208&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221libraries.
2222
2223.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242.cindex "building Eximon"
2243A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244where the files that are involved are
2245.display
2246&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252.endd
2253.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260.ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264.cindex "installing Exim"
2265.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286.cindex "system aliases file"
2287.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306over SMTP.
2307
2308It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310command such as
2311.code
2312make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313.endd
2314This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338command:
2339.code
2340make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341.endd
2342The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346command:
2347.code
2348(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349.endd
2350.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353.ilist
2354&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356.next
2357&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358installed binary.
2359.endlist
2360
2361INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362.code
2363make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364.endd
2365The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368.code
2369make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370.endd
2371
2372
2373
2374.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379&<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398.cindex "testing" "installation"
2399Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402.code
2403exim -bV
2404.endd
2405If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410example,
2411.display
2412&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413.endd
2414should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415.display
2416&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417.endd
2418a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420user agent. For example:
2421.code
2422exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423From: user@your.domain.example
2424To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427This is a test message.
2428^D
2429.endd
2430The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440.display
2441&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442.endd
2443You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450.cindex "lock files"
2451One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475production version.
2476
2477
2478.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498as follows:
2499.code
2500sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504.endd
2505Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507favourite user agent.
2508
2509You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534.code
2535/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536.endd
2537If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542.code
2543pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544.endd
2545to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571were present before any other options.
2572The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573standard output.
2574This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582format.
2583
2584.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589.cindex "&'runq'&"
2590.cindex "queue runner"
2591If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596.cindex "alias file" "building"
2597.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612.ilist
2613.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620.cindex '&"From"& line'
2621.cindex "envelope sender"
2622Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639that are available to trusted users.
2640.next
2641.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659false.
2660.endlist
2661
2662
2663&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683. creates a man page for the options.
2684. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686.literal xml
2687<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688.literal off
2689
2690
2691.vlist
2692.vitem &%--%&
2693.oindex "--"
2694.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699.vitem &%--help%&
2700.oindex "&%--help%&"
2701This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703no arguments.
2704
2705.vitem &%--version%&
2706.oindex "&%--version%&"
2707This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708displayed.
2709
2710.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715ignored by Exim.
2716
2717.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718.oindex "&%-B%&"
2719.cindex "8-bit characters"
2720.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724.vitem &%-bd%&
2725.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726.cindex "daemon"
2727.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728.cindex "queue runner"
2729This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743When a listening daemon
2744.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750running as root.
2751
2752When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756The SIGHUP signal
2757.cindex "SIGHUP"
2758.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766.vitem &%-bdf%&
2767.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771.vitem &%-be%&
2772.oindex "&%-be%&"
2773.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804of a file. For example:
2805.code
2806exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807.endd
2808The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815&%-be%&).
2816
2817.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823system filters are recognized.
2824
2825.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827.cindex "filter" "testing"
2828.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835supplied.
2836
2837If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840.code
2841exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842.endd
2843This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847.code
2848# Exim filter
2849# Sieve filter
2850.endd
2851it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854redirection lists.
2855
2856The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861When testing a filter file,
2862.cindex "&""From""& line"
2863.cindex "envelope sender"
2864.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869options).
2870
2871.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876&$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884actually being delivered.
2885
2886.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890prefix.
2891
2892.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896suffix.
2897
2898.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908after a full stop. For example:
2909.code
2910exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912.endd
2913When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915conversion to the canonical form is
2916&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924&*Warning 1*&:
2925.cindex "RFC 1413"
2926You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929connection.
2930
2931&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940session were authenticated.
2941
2942The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948specialized SMTP test program such as
2949&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957.vitem &%-bi%&
2958.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959.cindex "alias file" "building"
2960.cindex "building alias file"
2961.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966recognized.
2967
2968If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979.cindex "querying exim information"
2980We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988.cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002.vitem &%-bm%&
3003.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004.cindex "local message reception"
3005This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024The format
3025.cindex "message" "format"
3026.cindex "format" "message"
3027.cindex "&""From""& line"
3028.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032.code
3033From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035.endd
3036(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050.cindex "testing", "malware"
3051.cindex "malware scan test"
3052This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068.vitem &%-bnq%&
3069.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090.vitem &%-bP%&
3091.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097arguments, for example:
3098.code
3099exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100.endd
3101.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106users, the output is as in this example:
3107.code
3108mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109.endd
3110If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115backward compatibility.)
3116If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118
3119.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121name will not be output.
3122
3123.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129written directly into the spool directory.
3130
3131If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132.code
3133exim -bP +local_domains
3134.endd
3135it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137
3138.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143that driver are output. For example:
3144.code
3145exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146.endd
3147The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152&%authenticators%&.
3153
3154.cindex "environment"
3155If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3156variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3157variables.
3158
3159.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3160If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3161are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3162for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3163The output format is one item per line.
3164
3165.vitem &%-bp%&
3166.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3167.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3168.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3169This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3170standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3171just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3172admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3173to allow any user to see the queue.
3174
3175Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3176.code
317725m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3178 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3179 <other addresses>
3180.endd
3181.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3182.cindex "size" "of message"
3183The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3184(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3185identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3186envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3187&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3188the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3189before the sender address.
3190
3191.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3192If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3193&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3194
3195The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3196displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3197been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3198expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3199displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3200complete.
3201
3202
3203.vitem &%-bpa%&
3204.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3205This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3206that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3207alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3208of just &"D"&.
3209
3210
3211.vitem &%-bpc%&
3212.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3213.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3214This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3215to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3216&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3217
3218
3219.vitem &%-bpr%&
3220.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3221This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3222chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3223lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3224going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3225
3226.vitem &%-bpra%&
3227.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3228This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3229
3230.vitem &%-bpru%&
3231.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3232This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3233
3234
3235.vitem &%-bpu%&
3236.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3237This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3238addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3239forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3240router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3241
3242
3243.vitem &%-brt%&
3244.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3245.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3246.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3247This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3248arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3249and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3250.code
3251exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3252Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3253.endd
3254See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3255argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3256&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3257contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3258retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3259with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3260rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3261sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3262used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3263.code
3264exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3265Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3266.endd
3267
3268.vitem &%-brw%&
3269.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3270.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3271.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3272This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3273a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3274complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3275would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3276&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3277
3278.vitem &%-bS%&
3279.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3280.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3281.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3282This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3283for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3284submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3285input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3286input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3287&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3288believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3289
3290The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3291dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3292provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3293
3294As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3295messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3296Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3297&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3298
3299Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3300as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3301QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3302
3303.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3304If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3305error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3306was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3307was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3308
3309More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3310&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3311
3312.vitem &%-bs%&
3313.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3314.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3315.cindex "local SMTP input"
3316This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3317on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3318policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3319Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3320messages to the MTA.
3321
3322In
3323.cindex "sender" "source of"
3324this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3325set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3326Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3327the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3328&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3329&%-bnq%& option is used.
3330
3331.cindex "inetd"
3332The
3333&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3334using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3335whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3336&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3337above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3338Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3339the listening daemon.
3340
3341.vitem &%-bt%&
3342.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3343.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3344.cindex "address" "testing"
3345This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3346as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3347written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3348user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3349sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3350
3351If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3352right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3353
3354Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3355&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3356security issues.
3357
3358Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3359(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3360written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3361&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3362genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3363program.
3364
3365.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3366The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3367failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3368code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3369
3370.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3371&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3372addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3373This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3374always shown.
3375
3376&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3377routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3378message,
3379.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3380you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3381&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3382default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3383whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3384those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3385doing such tests.
3386
3387.vitem &%-bV%&
3388.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3389.cindex "version number of Exim"
3390This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3391number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3392It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3393specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3394name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3395
3396As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3397configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3398values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3399detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3400alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3401realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3402dynamic testing facilities.
3403
3404.vitem &%-bv%&
3405.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3406.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3407.cindex "address" "verification"
3408This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3409taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3410not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3411happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3412(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3413including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3414
3415If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3416failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3417usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3418
3419If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3420right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3421
3422Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3423&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3424security issues.
3425
3426Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3427that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3428router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3429verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3430address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3431
3432If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3433address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3434latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3435causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3436addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3437and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3438to succeed.
3439
3440When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3441and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3442considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3443
3444The
3445.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3446return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3447failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3448code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3449
3450If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3451address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3452sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3453calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3454
3455.vitem &%-bvs%&
3456.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3457This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3458than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3459might happen.
3460
3461.vitem &%-bw%&
3462.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3463.cindex "daemon"
3464.cindex "inetd"
3465.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3466This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3467similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3468and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3469
3470In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3471listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3472inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3473each port only when the first connection is received.
3474
3475If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3476which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3477
3478.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3479.oindex "&%-C%&"
3480.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3481.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3482.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3483This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3484list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3485compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3486name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3487file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3488proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3489
3490When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3491from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3492runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3493However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3494file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3495which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3496listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3497CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3498not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3499
3500Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3501configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3502even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3503running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3504delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3505test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3506on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3507
3508If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3509prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3510must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3511However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3512CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3513usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3514unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3515
3516ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3517to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3518broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3519configuration file.
3520
3521The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3522syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3523caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3524require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3525specified by this option.
3526
3527
3528.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3529.oindex "&%-D%&"
3530.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3531This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3532(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3533unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3534If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3535completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3536
3537If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3538colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3539supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3540not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3541the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3542to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3543regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3544
3545The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3546command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3547string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3548synonymous:
3549.code
3550exim -DABC ...
3551exim -DABC= ...
3552.endd
3553To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3554quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3555example:
3556.code
3557exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3558.endd
3559&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3560.new
3561Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3562.wen
3563
3564
3565.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3566.oindex "&%-d%&"
3567.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3568.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3569This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3570error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3571database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3572filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3573writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3574return code.
3575
3576When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3577standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3578some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3579made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3580of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3581debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3582no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3583are:
3584.display
3585&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3586&`auth `& authenticators
3587&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3588&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3589&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3590&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3591&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3592&`filter `& filter handling
3593&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3594&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3595&`ident `& ident lookup
3596&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3597&`lists `& matching things in lists
3598&`load `& system load checks
3599&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3600 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3601&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3602&`memory `& memory handling
3603&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3604&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3605&`queue_run `& queue runs
3606&`receive `& general message reception logic
3607&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3608&`retry `& retry handling
3609&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3610&`route `& address routing
3611&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3612&`tls `& TLS logic
3613&`transport `& transports
3614&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3615&`verify `& address verification logic
3616&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3617.endd
3618The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3619for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3620tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3621is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3622generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3623turn everything off.
3624
3625.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3626.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3627The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3628with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3629unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3630rather than stderr.
3631
3632The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3633&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3634However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3635daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3636automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3637run in parallel.
3638
3639The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3640of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3641in processing.
3642
3643If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3644any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3645
3646.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3647.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3648This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3649starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3650subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3651behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3652
3653.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3654.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3655This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3656handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3657described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3658
3659.vitem &%-E%&
3660.oindex "&%-E%&"
3661.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3662This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3663failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3664and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3665generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3666could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3667follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3668new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3669
3670.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3671.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3672There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3673called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3674example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3675form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3676
3677.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3678.oindex "&%-F%&"
3679.cindex "sender" "name"
3680.cindex "name" "of sender"
3681This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3682message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3683entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3684their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3685between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3686
3687.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3688.oindex "&%-f%&"
3689.cindex "sender" "address"
3690.cindex "address" "sender"
3691.cindex "trusted users"
3692.cindex "envelope sender"
3693.cindex "user" "trusted"
3694This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3695message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3696by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3697users to use it.
3698
3699Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3700trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3701options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3702of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3703domain.
3704
3705There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3706can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3707never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3708string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3709examples of shell commands:
3710.code
3711exim -f '<>' user@domain
3712exim -f "" user@domain
3713.endd
3714In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3715with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3716&%-bv%& options.
3717
3718Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3719it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3720refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3721though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3722
3723White
3724.cindex "&""From""& line"
3725space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3726given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3727locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3728&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3729if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3730
3731.vitem &%-G%&
3732.oindex "&%-G%&"
3733.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3734This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3735.code
3736control = suppress_local_fixups
3737.endd
3738for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3739bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3740in future.
3741
3742As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3743this option.
3744
3745.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3746.oindex "&%-h%&"
3747.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3748This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3749Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3750headers.)
3751
3752.vitem &%-i%&
3753.oindex "&%-i%&"
3754.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3755.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3756This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3757line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3758no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3759command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3760
3761.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3762.oindex "&%-L%&"
3763.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3764This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3765file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3766Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3767read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3768effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3769
3770The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3771
3772.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3773.oindex "&%-M%&"
3774.cindex "forcing delivery"
3775.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3776.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3777This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3778any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3779delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3780and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3781
3782Retry
3783.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3784hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3785the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3786to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3787which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3788for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3789
3790The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3791not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3792produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3793use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3794
3795.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3796.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3797.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3798.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3799This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3800message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3801id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3802active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3803can be used only by an admin user.
3804
3805.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3806 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3807.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3808.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3809.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3810.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3811This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3812by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3813an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3814given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3815must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3816
3817.vitem &%-MCA%&
3818.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3819This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3821connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3822
3823.vitem &%-MCD%&
3824.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3825This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3827remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3828
3829.vitem &%-MCP%&
3830.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3831This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3833which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3834
3835.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3836.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3837This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3839started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3840together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3841signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3842messages through the same SMTP connection.
3843
3844.vitem &%-MCS%&
3845.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3846This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3847by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3848SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3849connection.
3850
3851.vitem &%-MCT%&
3852.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3853This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3854by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3855host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3856
3857.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3858.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3859.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3860.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3861This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3862but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3863that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3864provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3865order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3866However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3867respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3868overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3869If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3870&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3871and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3872
3873.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3874.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3875.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3876.cindex "sender" "changing"
3877This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3878given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3879&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3880be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3881is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3882This option can be used only by an admin user.
3883
3884.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3885.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3886.cindex "freezing messages"
3887.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3888This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3889prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3890either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3891However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3892attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3893user.
3894
3895.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3896.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3897.cindex "giving up on messages"
3898.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3899.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3900This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3901including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3902their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3903is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3904Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3905user.
3906
3907.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3909.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3910This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3911as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3912message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3913altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3914
3915.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3916.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3917.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3918.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3919.cindex "removing recipients"
3920This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3921(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3922the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3923addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3924(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3925can be used only by an admin user.
3926
3927.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3928.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3929.cindex "removing messages"
3930.cindex "abandoning mail"
3931.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3932This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3933bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3934the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3935only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3936placed on the queue.
3937
3938.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3939.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3940.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3941.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3942This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3943string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3944the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3945&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3946available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3947make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3948user. See also &%-bem%&.
3949
3950.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3952.cindex "thawing messages"
3953.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3954.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3955.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3956This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3957&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3958messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3959by an admin user.
3960
3961.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3962.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3963.cindex "listing" "message body"
3964.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3965This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3966written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3967
3968.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3969.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3970.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3971.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3972This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3973be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3974only by an admin user.
3975
3976.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3977.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3978.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3979.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3980.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3981This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3982written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3983
3984.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3985.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3986.cindex "listing" "message log"
3987.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3988This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3989the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3990
3991.vitem &%-m%&
3992.oindex "&%-m%&"
3993This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3994treats it that way too.
3995
3996.vitem &%-N%&
3997.oindex "&%-N%&"
3998.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3999.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4000This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4001level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4002it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4003had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4004database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4005than &"=>"&.
4006
4007Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4008user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4009words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4010which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4011address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4012routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4013the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4014for that message.
4015
4016.vitem &%-n%&
4017.oindex "&%-n%&"
4018This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4019For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4020When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4021
4022.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4023.oindex "&%-O%&"
4024This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4025Exim.
4026
4027.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4028.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4029.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4030This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4031alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4032description above.
4033
4034.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4035.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4036.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4037.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4038.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4039This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4040be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4041transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4042
4043.vitem &%-odb%&
4044.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4045.cindex "background delivery"
4046.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4047This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4048including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4049messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4050delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4051processes to finish.
4052
4053When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4054leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4055and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4056This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4057
4058If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4059(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4060overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4061setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4062
4063.vitem &%-odf%&
4064.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4065.cindex "foreground delivery"
4066.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4067This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4068accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4069&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4070and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4071
4072The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4073process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4074during deliveries.
4075
4076However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4077false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4078
4079If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4080message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4081process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4082restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4083
4084
4085.vitem &%-odi%&
4086.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4087This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4088Sendmail.
4089
4090.vitem &%-odq%&
4091.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4092.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4093.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4094.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4095This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4096including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4097not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4098are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4099process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4100&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4101conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4102forces queueing.
4103
4104.vitem &%-odqs%&
4105.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4106.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4107This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4108However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4109&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4110configuration file is in effect.
4111
4112When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4113message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4114also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4115in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4116done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4117runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4118messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4119host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4120configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4121&%-qq%& option.
4122
4123.vitem &%-oee%&
4124.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4125.cindex "error" "reporting"
4126If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4127example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4128message.
4129
4130.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4131Provided
4132this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4133exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4134is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4135This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4136
4137.vitem &%-oem%&
4138.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4139.cindex "error" "reporting"
4140.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4141This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4142return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4143This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4144
4145.vitem &%-oep%&
4146.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4147.cindex "error" "reporting"
4148If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4149error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4150.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4151The return code is 1 for all errors.
4152
4153.vitem &%-oeq%&
4154.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4155.cindex "error" "reporting"
4156This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4157effect as &%-oep%&.
4158
4159.vitem &%-oew%&
4160.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4161.cindex "error" "reporting"
4162This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4163effect as &%-oem%&.
4164
4165.vitem &%-oi%&
4166.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4167.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4168This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4169line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4170single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4171lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4172&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4173
4174.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4175.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4176This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4177
4178.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4179.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4180.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4181A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4182with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4183over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4184&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4185other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4186
4187The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4188number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4189.code
4190exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4191.endd
4192An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4193followed by a colon and the port number:
4194.code
4195exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4196.endd
4197The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4198port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4199are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4200whichever one is last.
4201
4202.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4203.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4204.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4205See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4206option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4207name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4208This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4209authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4210
4211.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4212.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4213.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4214See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4215option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4216This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4217where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4218&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4219
4220.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4221.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4222.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4223See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4224option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4225overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4226messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4227default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4228specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4229&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4230
4231.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4232.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4233.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4234See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4235option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4236using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4237&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4238
4239.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4240.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4241.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4242See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4243option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4244delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4245messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4246abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4247running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4248
4249The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4250The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4251is sending the bounce.
4252
4253.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4254.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4255.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4256.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4257See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4258option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4259&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4260or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4261SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4262&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4263one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4264be set by &%-oMr%&.
4265
4266.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4267.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4268.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4269See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4270option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4271present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4272uses the name it is given.
4273
4274.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4275.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4276.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4277See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4278option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4279local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4280used, when there is no default.
4281
4282.vitem &%-om%&
4283.oindex "&%-om%&"
4284.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4285In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4286message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4287expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4288
4289.vitem &%-oo%&
4290.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4291.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4292This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4293whatever that means.
4294
4295.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4296.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4297.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4298.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4299This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4300value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4301written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4302without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4303because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4304
4305.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4306.oindex "&%-or%&"
4307.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4308This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4309set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4310by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4311described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4312
4313.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4314.oindex "&%-os%&"
4315.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4316.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4317This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4318applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4319the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4320for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4321
4322.vitem &%-ov%&
4323.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4324This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4325
4326.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4327.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4328.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4329.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4330.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4331This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4332is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4333of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4334in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4335file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4336
4337.vitem &%-pd%&
4338.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4339.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4340This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4341chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4342option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4343needed.
4344
4345.vitem &%-ps%&
4346.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4347.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4348This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4349chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4350option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4351started.
4352
4353.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4354.oindex "&%-p%&"
4355For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4356.display
4357&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4358.endd
4359It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4360host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4361Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4362to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4363or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4364
4365.vitem &%-q%&
4366.oindex "&%-q%&"
4367.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4368This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4369configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4370relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4371and &%-S%& options).
4372
4373.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4374The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4375waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4376for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4377process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4378have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4379
4380If
4381.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4382.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4383.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4384the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4385passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4386proceeding.
4387
4388When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4389process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4390mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4391this to be repeated periodically.
4392
4393Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4394random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4395If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4396MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4397
4398It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4399order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4400&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4401
4402.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4403The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4404behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4405appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4406
4407.vitem &%-qq...%&
4408.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4409.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4410.cindex "queue" "routing"
4411.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4412An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4413stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4414every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4415transports are run.
4416
4417.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4418The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4419is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4420complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4421place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4422delivered down a single SMTP
4423.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4424.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4425.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4426connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4427This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4428intermittently.
4429
4430.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4431.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4432.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4433If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4434those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4435delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4436&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4437
4438.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4439.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4440.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4441.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4442If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4443message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4444their retry times are tried.
4445
4446.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4447.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4448.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4449If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4450frozen or not.
4451
4452.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4453.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4454.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4455The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4456be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4457for later delivery.
4458
4459.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4460.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4461When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4462lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4463starting message id. For example:
4464.code
4465exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4466.endd
4467Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4468second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4469are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4470.code
4471exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4472.endd
4473just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4474&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4475that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4476mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4477are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4478queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4479
4480.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4481.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4482.cindex "periodic queue running"
4483When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4484starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4485(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4486&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4487single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4488combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4489.code
4490/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4491.endd
4492Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4493process every 30 minutes.
4494
4495When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4496pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4497
4498.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4500This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4501compatibility.
4502
4503.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4504.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4505This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4506
4507.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4508.oindex "&%-R%&"
4509.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4510.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4511.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4512The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4513is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4514which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4515<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4516
4517This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4518perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4519queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4520address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4521way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4522regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4523
4524If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4525you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4526.code
4527exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4528.endd
4529This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4530every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4531applied to each queue run.
4532
4533Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4534are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4535information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4536means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4537existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4538address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4539will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4540information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4541address will be skipped.
4542
4543.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4544If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4545all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4546&'ff'& is present.
4547
4548The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4549to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4550command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4551effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4552an arbitrary command instead.
4553
4554.vitem &%-r%&
4555.oindex "&%-r%&"
4556This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4557
4558.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4559.oindex "&%-S%&"
4560.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4561.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4562This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4563message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4564conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4565has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4566
4567.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4568.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4569This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4570recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4571&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4572
4573.vitem &%-t%&
4574.oindex "&%-t%&"
4575.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4576.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4577.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4578.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4579When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4580input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4581from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4582from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4583takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4584
4585.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4586If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4587is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4588the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4589and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4590Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4591Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4592argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4593Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4594instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4595&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4596
4597.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4598If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4599recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4600lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4601with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4602&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4603
4604RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4605message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4606added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4607not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4608nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4609In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4610are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4611once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4612&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4613
4614.vitem &%-ti%&
4615.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4616This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4617compatibility with Sendmail.
4618
4619.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4620.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4621.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4622.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4623This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4624incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4625&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4626&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4627
4628
4629.vitem &%-U%&
4630.oindex "&%-U%&"
4631.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4632Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4633documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4634syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4635set. Exim ignores this option.
4636
4637.vitem &%-v%&
4638.oindex "&%-v%&"
4639This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4640describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4641receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4642dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4643the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4644selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4645unconditional.
4646
4647.vitem &%-x%&
4648.oindex "&%-x%&"
4649AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4650National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4651It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4652this option.
4653
4654.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4655.oindex "&%-X%&"
4656This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4657to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4658
4659.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4660.oindex "&%-z%&"
4661This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4662Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4663Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4664under most shells.
4665.endlist
4666
4667.ecindex IIDclo1
4668.ecindex IIDclo2
4669
4670
4671. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4672. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4673. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4674. creates a man page for the options.
4675. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4676
4677.literal xml
4678<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4679.literal off
4680
4681
4682
4683
4684
4685. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4686. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4687
4688
4689.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4690 "The runtime configuration file"
4691
4692.cindex "run time configuration"
4693.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4694.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4695.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4696.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4697.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4698Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4699binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4700because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4701control.
4702
4703If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4704writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4705The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4706errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4707not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4708actually alter the string.
4709
4710The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4711reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4712most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4713give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4714existing file in the list.
4715
4716.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4717.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4718.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4719.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4720.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4721.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4722The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4723specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4724configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4725group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4726CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4727
4728&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4729to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4730easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4731CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4732who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4733
4734Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4735be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4736since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4737compromise the Exim user account.
4738
4739A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4740is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4741defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4742configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4743CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4744&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4745configuration.
4746
4747
4748
4749.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4750.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4751A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4752option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4753&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4754unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4755CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4756is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4757is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4758installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4759specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4760
4761Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4762with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4763listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4764testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4765delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4766Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4767the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4768can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4769message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4770&%-M%&).
4771
4772If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4773prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4774start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4775There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4776name can be used with &%-C%&.
4777
4778One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4779option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4780configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4781non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4782If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4783completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4784
4785The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4786to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4787necessarily be discarded.
4788WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4789considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4790values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4791is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4792transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4793values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4794
4795Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4796share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4797If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4798looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4799and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4800file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4801each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4802
4803In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4804different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4805help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4806
4807
4808
4809.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4810.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4811.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4812Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4813option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4814are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4815is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4816space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4817
4818.ilist
4819&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4820&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4821.next
4822.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4823&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4824are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4825.next
4826&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4827addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4828&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4829.next
4830&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4831define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4832&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4833.next
4834&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4835If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4836defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4837are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4838&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4839.next
4840&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4841when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4842chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4843.next
4844&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4845want to use this feature, you must set
4846.code
4847LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4848.endd
4849in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4850facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4851.endlist
4852
4853.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4854.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4855.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4856Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4857
4858Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4859leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4860# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4861and does not introduce a comment.
4862
4863Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4864the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4865backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4866lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4867appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4868
4869A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4870default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4871change settings as required.
4872
4873The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4874described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4875respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4876items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4877onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4878described.
4879
4880
4881
4882.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4883.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4884.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4885.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4886.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4887You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4888using this syntax:
4889.display
4890&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4891&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4892.endd
4893on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4894the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4895second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4896name is required.
4897
4898Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4899configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4900If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4901because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4902
4903The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4904comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4905for example:
4906.code
4907hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4908 .include /some/file
4909.endd
4910Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4911process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4912inclusion appears.
4913
4914
4915
4916.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4917.cindex "macro" "description of"
4918.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4919If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4920&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4921definition, and must be of the form
4922.display
4923<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4924.endd
4925The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4926in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4927continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4928space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4929a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4930
4931Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4932definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4933ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4934
4935.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4936Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4937files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4938scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4939replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4940for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4941the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4942define
4943.display
4944&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4945&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4946.endd
4947but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4948error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4949before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4950consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4951line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4952comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4953
4954
4955.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4956Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4957(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4958&'='&. For example:
4959.code
4960MAC = initial value
4961...
4962MAC == updated value
4963.endd
4964Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4965subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4966the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4967Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4968.code
4969MAC = initial value
4970...
4971MAC == MAC and something added
4972.endd
4973This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4974from a number of other files.
4975
4976.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4977The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4978&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4979used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4980using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4981file to be ignored.
4982
4983
4984
4985.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4986As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4987up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4988strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4989.code
4990ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4991 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4992.endd
4993This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4994.code
4995data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4996.endd
4997In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4998address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4999section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5000
5001
5002.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5003.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5004.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5005You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5006&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5007portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5008read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5009
5010The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5011be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5012that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5013line. Thus:
5014.code
5015.ifdef AAA
5016message_size_limit = 50M
5017.else
5018message_size_limit = 100M
5019.endif
5020.endd
5021sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5022(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5023otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5024is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5025obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5026
5027Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5028it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5029in this line"& will always be true.
5030
5031Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5032to clarify complicated nestings.
5033
5034
5035
5036.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5037.cindex "common option syntax"
5038.cindex "syntax of common options"
5039.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5040For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5041each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5042lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5043these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5044space) and then the value. For example:
5045.code
5046qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5047.endd
5048.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5049.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5050.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5051Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5052accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5053line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5054word &"hide"&. For example:
5055.code
5056hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5057.endd
5058For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5059.code
5060mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5061.endd
5062If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5063all instances of the same driver.
5064
5065The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5066that are found in option settings.
5067
5068
5069.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5070.cindex "format" "boolean"
5071.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5072.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5073.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5074Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5075different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5076the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5077if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5078boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5079&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5080the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5081.code
5082queue_only
5083queue_only = true
5084.endd
5085The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5086.code
5087no_queue_only
5088queue_only = false
5089.endd
5090You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5091
5092
5093
5094
5095.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5096.cindex "integer configuration values"
5097.cindex "format" "integer"
5098If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5099hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5100number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5101with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5102hexadecimal number.
5103
5104If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5105it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5106of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
51071024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5108and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5109used.
5110
5111
5112.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5113.cindex "integer format"
5114.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5115If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5116interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5117Such options are always output in octal.
5118
5119
5120.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5121.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5122.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5123If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5124integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5125
5126
5127
5128.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5129.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5130.cindex "format" "time interval"
5131A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5132the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5133
5134.table2 30pt
5135.irow &%s%& seconds
5136.irow &%m%& minutes
5137.irow &%h%& hours
5138.irow &%d%& days
5139.irow &%w%& weeks
5140.endtable
5141
5142For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5143intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5144is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5145
5146
5147
5148.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5149.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5150.cindex "format" "string"
5151If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5152or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5153consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5154the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5155removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5156Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5157appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5158therefore equivalent:
5159.code
5160trusted_users = uucp:mail
5161trusted_users = uucp:\
5162 # This comment line is ignored
5163 mail
5164.endd
5165.cindex "string" "quoted"
5166.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5167If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5168double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5169continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5170
5171.table2 100pt
5172.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5173.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5174.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5175.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5176.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5177.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5178 character"
5179.endtable
5180
5181If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5182character, that character replaces the pair.
5183
5184Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5185insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5186trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5187current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5188in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5189and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5190
5191
5192.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5193.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5194Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5195by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5196circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5197is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5198strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5199However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5200backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5201within a quoted configuration string.
5202
5203
5204.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5205.cindex "user name" "format of"
5206.cindex "format" "user name"
5207.cindex "groups" "name format"
5208.cindex "format" "group name"
5209User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5210above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5211either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5212&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5213
5214
5215.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5216.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5217.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5218.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5219The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5220default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5221the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5222&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5223are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5224particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5225&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5226
5227In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5228input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5229&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5230in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5231on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5232start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5233example, the list
5234.code
5235local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5236.endd
5237contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5238
5239&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5240list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5241colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5242be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5243
5244.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5245.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5246.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5247Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5248introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5249with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5250character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5251above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5252.code
5253local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5254.endd
5255This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5256&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5257confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5258
5259.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5260.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5261It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5262code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5263must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5264are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5265sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5266interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5267generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5268.code
5269domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5270.endd
5271This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5272to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5273expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5274the value in quotes. For example:
5275.code
5276local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5277.endd
5278Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5279doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5280set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5281enclosing an empty list item.
5282
5283
5284
5285.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5286.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5287An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5288separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5289.code
5290senders = user@domain :
5291.endd
5292contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5293in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5294items, the second of which is empty:
5295.code
5296senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5297.endd
5298&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5299are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5300would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5301just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5302.code
5303senders = :
5304.endd
5305In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5306is at the end of the list.
5307
5308
5309
5310
5311.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5312.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5313There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5314and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5315instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5316a sequence of lines like this:
5317.display
5318<&'instance name'&>:
5319 <&'option'&>
5320 ...
5321 <&'option'&>
5322.endd
5323In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5324followed by three options settings:
5325.code
5326localuser:
5327 driver = accept
5328 check_local_user
5329 transport = local_delivery
5330.endd
5331For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5332setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5333settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5334deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5335a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5336described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5337
5338You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5339the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5340
5341The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5342passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5343transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5344authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5345them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5346server.
5347
5348.cindex "generic options"
5349.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5350Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5351and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5352same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5353&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5354.cindex "private options"
5355The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5356they all have default values.
5357
5358The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5359precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5360this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5361
5362Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5363elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5364with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5365a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5366instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5367confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5368configuration lines:
5369.code
5370remote_smtp:
5371 driver = smtp
5372.endd
5373create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5374&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5375different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5376instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5377thus:
5378.code
5379special_smtp:
5380 driver = smtp
5381 port = 1234
5382 command_timeout = 10s
5383.endd
5384The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5385these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5386lines.
5387
5388Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5389list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5390defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5391option.
5392
5393
5394
5395
5396
5397
5398. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5399. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5400
5401.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5402.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5403.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5404The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5405is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5406the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5407configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5408of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5409itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5410initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5411mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5412
5413
5414
5415.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5416The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5417file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5418the line
5419.code
5420# primary_hostname =
5421.endd
5422This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5423to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5424can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5425it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5426
5427The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5428.code
5429domainlist local_domains = @
5430domainlist relay_to_domains =
5431hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5432.endd
5433These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5434domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5435domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5436configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5437
5438The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5439later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5440on the local host.
5441
5442.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5443There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5444of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5445called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5446be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5447the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5448
5449The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5450list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5451controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5452domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5453domain is permitted.
5454
5455The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5456used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5457that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5458loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5459submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5460hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5461
5462Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5463we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5464and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5465
5466The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5467.code
5468acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5469acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5470.endd
5471These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5472during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5473command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5474respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5475&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5476section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5477accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5478to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5479contents of a message to be checked.
5480
5481Two commented-out option settings are next:
5482.code
5483# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5484# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5485.endd
5486These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5487content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5488scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5489details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5490
5491Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5492.code
5493# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5494# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5495# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5496.endd
5497These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5498support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5499first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5500connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5501other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5502key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5503More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5504
5505Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5506.code
5507# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5508# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5509.endd
5510.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5511.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5512.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5513.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5514.cindex "smtps protocol"
5515.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5516.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5517These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5518server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5519TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5520more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5521on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5522port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5523configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5524non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5525&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5526
5527Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5528.code
5529# qualify_domain =
5530# qualify_recipient =
5531.endd
5532The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5533complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5534receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5535the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5536you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5537addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5538
5539.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5540The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5541addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5542(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5543.code
5544# allow_domain_literals
5545.endd
5546The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5547Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5548quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5549try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5550people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5551&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5552
5553The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5554.code
5555never_users = root
5556.endd
5557It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5558convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5559setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5560The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5561list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5562FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5563contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5564FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5565
5566When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5567Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5568line,
5569.code
5570host_lookup = *
5571.endd
5572specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5573in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5574information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5575or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5576Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5577because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5578unreachable.
5579
5580The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
55811413 (hence their names):
5582.code
5583rfc1413_hosts = *
5584rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5585.endd
5586These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5587Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5588terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5589of an incoming SMTP connection.
5590If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5591information, you can change this.
5592
5593This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5594and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5595.code
5596prdr_enable = true
5597.endd
5598
5599When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5600be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5601if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5602find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5603.code
5604# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5605# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5606.endd
5607show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5608and recipient addresses, respectively.
5609
5610The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5611over the default:
5612.code
5613log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5614 +tls_certificate_verified
5615.endd
5616
5617The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5618.code
5619# percent_hack_domains =
5620.endd
5621It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5622This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5623anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5624
5625The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5626concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5627message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5628occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5629address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5630bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5631are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5632always bounce messages.
5633.code
5634ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5635timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5636.endd
5637The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5638discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5639message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5640after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5641bounce message ever lasts a week.
5642
5643
5644
5645.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5646.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5647.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5648In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5649It starts with the line
5650.code
5651begin acl
5652.endd
5653and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5654&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5655and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5656
5657.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5658The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5659RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5660are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5661rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5662result of the ACL processing.
5663.code
5664acl_check_rcpt:
5665.endd
5666This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5667ACL, and names it.
5668.code
5669accept hosts = :
5670.endd
5671This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5672But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5673names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5674list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5675host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5676important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5677
5678What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5679messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5680input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5681manner.
5682.code
5683deny message = Restricted characters in address
5684 domains = +local_domains
5685 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5686
5687deny message = Restricted characters in address
5688 domains = !+local_domains
5689 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5690.endd
5691These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5692characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5693Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5694&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5695in Internet mail addresses.
5696
5697The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5698addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5699option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5700in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5701programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5702at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5703characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5704policy of being as safe as possible.
5705
5706The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5707to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5708first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5709&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5710reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5711&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5712
5713The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5714block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5715or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5716have to modify this rule.
5717
5718Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5719allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5720common convention of local parts constructed as
5721&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5722the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5723with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5724file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5725that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5726is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5727
5728The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5729allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5730and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5731with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5732local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5733and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5734(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5735.code
5736accept local_parts = postmaster
5737 domains = +local_domains
5738.endd
5739This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5740local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5741&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5742reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5743&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5744
5745The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5746by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5747in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5748.code
5749require verify = sender
5750.endd
5751This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5752ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5753address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5754see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5755addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5756used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5757discusses the details of address verification.
5758.code
5759accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5760 control = submission
5761.endd
5762This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5763hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5764verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5765that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5766second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5767is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5768messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5769&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5770probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5771.code
5772accept authenticated = *
5773 control = submission
5774.endd
5775This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5776Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5777likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5778authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5779examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5780fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5781.code
5782require message = relay not permitted
5783 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5784.endd
5785This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5786one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5787.code
5788require verify = recipient
5789.endd
5790This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5791fails, the address is rejected.
5792.code
5793# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5794# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5795# $dnslist_text
5796# dnslists = black.list.example
5797#
5798# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5799# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5800# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5801# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5802.endd
5803These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5804sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5805from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5806line.
5807.code
5808# require verify = csa
5809.endd
5810This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5811authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5812records.
5813.code
5814accept
5815.endd
5816The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5817address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5818.code
5819acl_check_data:
5820.endd
5821This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5822of this ACL are commented out:
5823.code
5824# deny malware = *
5825# message = This message contains a virus \
5826# ($malware_name).
5827.endd
5828These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5829viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5830suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5831virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5832.code
5833# warn spam = nobody
5834# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5835# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5836# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5837# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5838.endd
5839These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5840SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5841and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5842&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5843series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5844whatever the spam score.
5845.code
5846accept
5847.endd
5848This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5849
5850
5851.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5852.cindex "default" "routers"
5853.cindex "routers" "default"
5854The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5855by the line
5856.code
5857begin routers
5858.endd
5859Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5860messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5861accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5862matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5863manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5864.code
5865# domain_literal:
5866# driver = ipliteral
5867# domains = !+local_domains
5868# transport = remote_smtp
5869.endd
5870.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5871This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5872support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5873you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5874&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5875.code
5876dnslookup:
5877 driver = dnslookup
5878 domains = ! +local_domains
5879 transport = remote_smtp
5880 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5881 no_more
5882.endd
5883The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5884domains. This is specified by the line
5885.code
5886domains = ! +local_domains
5887.endd
5888The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5889exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5890that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5891the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5892indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5893passed on to the following routers.
5894
5895The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5896and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5897the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5898instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5899one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5900
5901The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5902DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5903router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5904specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5905in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5906the address fails and is bounced.
5907
5908The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5909be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5910encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5911whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5912Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5913email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5914continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5915out.
5916.code
5917system_aliases:
5918 driver = redirect
5919 allow_fail
5920 allow_defer
5921 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5922# user = exim
5923 file_transport = address_file
5924 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5925.endd
5926Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5927domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5928alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5929data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5930the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5931the next router.
5932
5933&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5934often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5935file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5936&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5937.code
5938userforward:
5939 driver = redirect
5940 check_local_user
5941# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5942# local_part_suffix_optional
5943 file = $home/.forward
5944# allow_filter
5945 no_verify
5946 no_expn
5947 check_ancestor
5948 file_transport = address_file
5949 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5950 reply_transport = address_reply
5951.endd
5952This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5953redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5954individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5955local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5956router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5957namely:
5958.code
5959# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5960# local_part_suffix_optional
5961.endd
5962.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5963show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5964is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5965by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5966variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5967presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5968the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5969
5970When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5971home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5972declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5973redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5974
5975.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5976Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5977files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5978is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5979of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5980filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5981separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5982
5983The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5984verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5985There are two reasons for doing this:
5986
5987.olist
5988Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5989checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5990unnecessary work.
5991.next
5992More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5993command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5994The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5995It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5996this time.
5997.endlist
5998
5999The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6000address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6001works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6002forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6003
6004The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6005forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6006auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6007.code
6008a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6009.endd
6010the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6011transport.
6012.code
6013localuser:
6014 driver = accept
6015 check_local_user
6016# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6017# local_part_suffix_optional
6018 transport = local_delivery
6019.endd
6020The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6021part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6022the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6023routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6024same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6025
6026
6027.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6028.cindex "default" "transports"
6029.cindex "transports" "default"
6030Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6031only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6032not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6033.code
6034begin transports
6035.endd
6036One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6037.code
6038remote_smtp:
6039 driver = smtp
6040 hosts_try_prdr = *
6041.endd
6042This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6043The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6044The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6045It is negotiated between client and server
6046and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6047All other options are defaulted.
6048.code
6049local_delivery:
6050 driver = appendfile
6051 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6052 delivery_date_add
6053 envelope_to_add
6054 return_path_add
6055# group = mail
6056# mode = 0660
6057.endd
6058This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6059traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6060local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6061directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6062under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6063show how this can be done.
6064
6065Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6066&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6067similarly-named options above.
6068.code
6069address_pipe:
6070 driver = pipe
6071 return_output
6072.endd
6073This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6074redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6075option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6076be returned to the sender.
6077.code
6078address_file:
6079 driver = appendfile
6080 delivery_date_add
6081 envelope_to_add
6082 return_path_add
6083.endd
6084This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6085redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6086&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6087.code
6088address_reply:
6089 driver = autoreply
6090.endd
6091This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6092filter files.
6093
6094
6095
6096.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6097.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6098.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6099The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6100Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6101introduced by the line
6102.code
6103begin retry
6104.endd
6105In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6106errors:
6107.code
6108* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6109.endd
6110This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
61112 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
61121.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6113is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6114
6115If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6116if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6117temporary errors into permanent errors.
6118
6119
6120.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6121The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6122.code
6123begin rewrite
6124.endd
6125contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6126rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6127
6128
6129
6130.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6131.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6132The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6133.code
6134begin authenticators
6135.endd
6136defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6137configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6138which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6139standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6140mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6141to support most MUA software.
6142
6143The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6144.code
6145#PLAIN:
6146# driver = plaintext
6147# server_set_id = $auth2
6148# server_prompts = :
6149# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6150# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6151.endd
6152And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6153.code
6154#LOGIN:
6155# driver = plaintext
6156# server_set_id = $auth1
6157# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6158# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6159# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6160.endd
6161
6162The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6163in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6164&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6165that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6166i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6167when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6168when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6169need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6170
6171The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6172password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6173To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6174expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6175
6176Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6177usercode and password are in different positions.
6178Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6179
6180.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6181
6182
6183
6184. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6185. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6186
6187.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6188
6189.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6190.cindex "PCRE"
6191Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6192uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6193matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6194regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6195Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6196O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6197
6198The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6199are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6200description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6201the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6202the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6203case-insensitive.
6204
6205In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6206it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6207or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6208second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6209.code
6210domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6211.endd
6212The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6213precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6214of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6215regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6216backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6217normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6218matched.
6219
6220There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6221recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6222string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6223these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6224it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6225match anywhere in the subject string.
6226
6227In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6228you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6229.code
6230domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6231.endd
6232matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6233You need to use:
6234.code
6235domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6236.endd
6237if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6238$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6239
6240
6241
6242. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6243. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6244
6245.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6246.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6247.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6248.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6249Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6250messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6251
6252.olist
6253A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6254cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6255lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6256can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6257&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6258The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6259.next
6260Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6261way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6262returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6263succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6264chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6265The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6266.endlist
6267
6268String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6269that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6270involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6271if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6272time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6273chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6274
6275.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6276It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6277lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6278processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6279Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6280.code
6281domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6282domains = lsearch;/some/file
6283.endd
6284The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6285No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6286defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6287The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6288file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6289.code
6290192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6291192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6292.endd
6293When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6294possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6295
6296In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6297Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6298in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6299.code
6300domain1:
6301domain2:
6302.endd
6303Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6304matches the list item.
6305
6306It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6307Consider a file containing lines like this:
6308.code
6309192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6310.endd
6311If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6312first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6313causes a second lookup to occur.
6314
6315The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6316available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6317lookup is permitted.
6318
6319
6320.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6321.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6322.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6323Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6324
6325.ilist
6326The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6327and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6328lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6329.next
6330.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6331The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6332key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6333Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6334.endlist
6335
6336The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6337the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6338default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6339.code
6340LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6341LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6342.endd
6343which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6344For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6345libraries and header files before building Exim.
6346
6347
6348
6349
6350.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6351.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6352.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6353The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6354
6355.ilist
6356.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6357.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6358.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6359&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6360string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6361indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6362re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6363aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6364be found in several places:
6365.display
6366&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6367&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6368&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6369.endd
6370A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6371because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6372However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6373you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6374.next
6375.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6376.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6377.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6378&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6379DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6380zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6381&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6382
6383.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6384For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6385when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6386using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6387the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6388that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6389other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6390.next
6391.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6392.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6393.cindex "sasldb2"
6394.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6395&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6396interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6397ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6398authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6399&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6400&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6401.next
6402.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6403.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6404.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6405.cindex "Courier"
6406.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6407.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6408&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6409is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6410if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6411other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6412use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6413calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6414utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6415by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6416.next
6417.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6418.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6419&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6420whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6421contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6422the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6423symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6424lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6425&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6426.next
6427.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6428.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6429&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6430terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6431file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6432IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6433being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6434.code
64351.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6436192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6437"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6438"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6439.endd
6440The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6441file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6442key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6443&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6444&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6445
6446&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6447&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6448lookup types support only literal keys.
6449
6450&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6451the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6452&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6453.next
6454.cindex "linear search"
6455.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6456.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6457.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6458&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6459line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6460end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6461letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6462in the file is used.
6463
6464White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6465line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6466continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6467space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6468junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6469colon, for example:
6470.code
6471baduser: :fail:
6472.endd
6473Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6474middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6475that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6476wildcarding of any kind.
6477
6478.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6479.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6480In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6481characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6482If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6483matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6484contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6485quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6486quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6487
6488.next
6489.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6490.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6491.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6492&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6493the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6494&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6495reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6496aliases; the full map names must be used.
6497
6498.next
6499.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6500.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6501.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6502.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6503&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6504&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6505the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6506that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6507used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6508
6509.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6510Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6511file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6512&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6513
6514. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6515. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6516
6517.olist
6518The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6519.code
6520 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6521 *fish data for anythingfish
6522.endd
6523.next
6524The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6525example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6526.code
6527 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6528.endd
6529Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6530expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6531string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6532.code
6533 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6534.endd
6535The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6536expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6537For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6538.code
6539 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6540.endd
6541
6542If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6543either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6544ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6545colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6546escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6547
6548&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6549match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6550is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6551takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6552&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6553
6554.next
6555Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6556is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6557lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6558example:
6559.code
6560 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6561.endd
6562The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6563.endlist olist
6564
6565Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6566continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6567be followed by optional colons.
6568
6569&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6570&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6571lookup types support only literal keys.
6572.endlist ilist
6573
6574
6575.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6576.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6577.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6578The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6579many of them are given in later sections.
6580
6581.ilist
6582.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6583.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6584&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6585are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6586records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6587.next
6588.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6589.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6590&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6591.next
6592.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6593.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6594&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6595returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6596that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6597called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6598any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6599.next
6600.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6601.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6602&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6603MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6604.next
6605.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6606.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6607&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6608the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6609.next
6610.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6611.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6612&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6613Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6614.next
6615.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6616.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6617.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6618&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6619lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6620success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6621lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6622password value. For example:
6623.code
6624*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6625.endd
6626.next
6627.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6628.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6629&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6630PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6631
6632.next
6633.new
6634.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6635.cindex lookup Redis
6636&(redis)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6637Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6638.wen
6639
6640.next
6641.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6642.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6643&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6644that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6645
6646.next
6647&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6648not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6649.next
6650.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6651.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6652&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6653allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6654address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6655obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6656at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6657superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6658&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6659.code
6660require condition = \
6661 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6662.endd
6663The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6664the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6665this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6666one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6667.endlist
6668
6669
6670
6671.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6672.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6673Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6674completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6675reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6676options such as a list of local domains.
6677
6678When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6679of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6680temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6681or may give up altogether.
6682
6683
6684
6685.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6686.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6687.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6688.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6689.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6690.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6691In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6692that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6693
6694&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6695lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6696specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6697
6698If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6699and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6700provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6701
6702.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6703.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6704.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6705Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6706&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6707character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6708by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6709that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6710take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6711For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6712.code
6713data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6714.endd
6715Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6716looks up these keys, in this order:
6717.code
6718jane@eyre.example
6719*@eyre.example
6720*
6721.endd
6722The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6723&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6724complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6725Exim move on to try the next key.
6726
6727
6728
6729.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6730.cindex "partial matching"
6731.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6732.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6733.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6734.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6735The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6736match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6737being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6738information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6739domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6740a key in a DBM file is
6741.code
6742*.dates.fict.example
6743.endd
6744then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6745&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6746by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6747file.
6748
6749&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6750also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6751&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6752
6753Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6754keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6755be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6756partial matching keys
6757beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6758Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6759unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6760
6761Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6762the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6763is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6764is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6765fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6766start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6767remains.
6768
6769A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6770by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6771&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6772modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6773subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6774up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6775.code
67762250.dates.fict.example
6777*.2250.dates.fict.example
6778*.dates.fict.example
6779*.fict.example
6780.endd
6781As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6782finishes.
6783
6784.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6785.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6786The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6787changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6788formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6789parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6790.code
6791domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6792.endd
6793In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6794&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6795components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6796other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6797.code
6798domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6799.endd
6800For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6801&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6802
6803If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6804just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6805down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6806
6807.ilist
6808If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6809.next
6810If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6811example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6812.next
6813Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6814remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6815for &"*"& on its own.
6816.next
6817Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6818.endlist
6819
6820
6821If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6822&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6823this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6824specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6825prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6826lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6827&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6828
6829The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6830in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6831dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6832in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6833subject key is always followed by a dot.
6834
6835
6836
6837
6838.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6839.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6840.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6841Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6842lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6843of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6844single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6845
6846For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6847another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6848many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6849the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6850closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6851own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6852
6853The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6854strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6855complete.
6856
6857
6858
6859
6860.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6861.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6862.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6863When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6864is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6865the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6866.code
6867[name=$local_part]
6868.endd
6869will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6870For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6871.code
6872[name="$local_part"]
6873.endd
6874but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6875NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6876rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6877of the following form is provided:
6878.code
6879${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6880.endd
6881For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6882.code
6883[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6884.endd
6885See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6886operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6887lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6888
6889
6890
6891
6892.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6893.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6894.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6895.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6896The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6897of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6898an expansion string could contain:
6899.code
6900${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6901.endd
6902If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6903is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6904&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6905&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6906
6907The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6908and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6909If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6910
6911For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6912concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6913depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6914between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6915by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6916.code
6917${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6918.endd
6919It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6920white space is ignored.
6921For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6922an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6923separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6924
6925.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6926When the type is PTR,
6927the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6928&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6929.code
6930${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6931.endd
6932If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6933altered and nothing is added.
6934
6935.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6936.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6937For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6938each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6939port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6940The field separator can be modified as above.
6941
6942.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6943.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6944For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6945unless a field separator is specified.
6946To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6947For SPF records the
6948default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6949.code
6950${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6951${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6952${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6953.endd
6954It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6955white space is ignored.
6956
6957.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6958For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6959successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6960Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6961specified.
6962.code
6963${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6964.endd
6965
6966.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6967.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6968.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6969.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6970Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6971each followed by a comma,
6972that may appear before the record type.
6973
6974The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6975temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6976a defer-option modifier.
6977The possible keywords are
6978&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6979With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6980whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6981ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6982With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6983error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6984succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6985.code
6986${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6987${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6988.endd
6989Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6990yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6991
6992.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6993Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6994The possible keywords are
6995&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6996With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6997with the lookup.
6998With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6999is not labelled as authenticated data
7000is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7001The default is &"never"&.
7002
7003See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7004
7005.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7006.cindex "DNS" timeout
7007Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7008The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7009(e.g. &"5s"&).
7010The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7011
7012Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7013The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7014The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7015
7016.new
7017.cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7018.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7019.cindex DNS TTL
7020Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7021The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7022value of the set of returned DNS records.
7023.wen
7024
7025
7026.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7027.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7028By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7029each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7030the pseudo-type MXH:
7031.code
7032${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7033.endd
7034In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7035returned.
7036
7037.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7038Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7039records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7040component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7041records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7042error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7043but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7044top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7045.code
7046${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7047${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7048.endd
7049Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7050the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7051the name servers for &%edu%&.
7052
7053You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7054top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7055sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7056given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7057for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7058such a list.
7059
7060.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7061A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7062records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7063&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7064not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7065result of a successful lookup such as:
7066.code
7067${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7068.endd
7069has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7070The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7071authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7072
7073.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7074The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7075and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7076(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7077.code
7078${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7079.endd
7080
7081
7082.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7083In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7084However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7085&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7086the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7087.code
7088${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7089${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7090${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7091.endd
7092In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7093the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7094to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7095case, it does not treat it as a list.
7096
7097The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7098in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7099different separator can be specified, as described above.
7100
7101
7102
7103
7104.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7105.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7106.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7107.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7108The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7109become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7110implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7111contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7112the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7113it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7114indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7115your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7116.code
7117LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7118LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7119LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7120LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7121LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7122.endd
7123If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7124same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7125
7126There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7127the way they handle the results of a query:
7128
7129.ilist
7130&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7131gives an error.
7132.next
7133&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7134Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7135.next
7136&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7137from all of them are returned.
7138.endlist
7139
7140
7141For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7142Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7143the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7144First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7145
7146
7147.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7148.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7149An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7150the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7151.code
7152data = ${lookup ldap \
7153 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7154 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7155.endd
7156.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7157The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7158secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7159encrypted TLS connection is used.
7160
7161With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7162LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7163See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7164
7165Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7166controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7167&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7168your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7169&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7170certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7171running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7172methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7173&_exim.conf_&.
7174
7175
7176.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7177.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7178Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7179and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7180within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7181reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7182
7183The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7184filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7185the string:
7186.code
7187* => \2A
7188( => \28
7189) => \29
7190\ => \5C
7191.endd
7192in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7193to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7194.code
7195! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7196.endd
7197are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7198.code
7199${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7200.endd
7201yields
7202.code
7203%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7204.endd
7205Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7206.code
7207a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7208.endd
7209The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7210base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7211by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7212.code
7213, + " \ < > ;
7214.endd
7215It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7216before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7217is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7218.code
7219${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7220.endd
7221yields
7222.code
7223%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7224.endd
7225Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7226.code
7227\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7228.endd
7229There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7230authentication below.
7231
7232
7233.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7234.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7235The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7236is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7237an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7238by starting it with
7239.code
7240ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7241.endd
7242If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7243used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7244taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7245colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7246handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7247returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7248are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7249Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7250failures, and timeouts.
7251
7252For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7253of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7254&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7255doubled. For example
7256.code
7257ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7258.endd
7259If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7260to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7261the local host) is used.
7262
7263If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7264a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7265&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7266to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7267not available.
7268
7269For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7270for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7271can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7272the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7273.code
7274ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7275.endd
7276When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7277&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7278.code
7279${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7280.endd
7281When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7282a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7283specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7284socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7285&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7286or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7287the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7288backup host.
7289
7290If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7291specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7292&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7293
7294.ilist
7295Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7296interface.
7297.next
7298Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7299.endlist
7300
7301
7302Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7303&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7304
7305
7306
7307.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7308.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7309The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7310information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7311be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7312spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7313when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7314them. The following names are recognized:
7315.display
7316&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7317&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7318&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7319&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7320&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7321&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7322&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7323&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7324.endd
7325The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7326&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7327must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7328library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7329
7330.cindex LDAP timeout
7331.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7332The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7333backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7334enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7335network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7336&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7337LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7338if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7339SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7340Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7341
7342The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7343set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7344
7345The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7346to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7347default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7348server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7349different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7350different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7351alternate list (colon-separated).
7352
7353Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7354values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7355.code
7356${lookup ldap
7357 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7358 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7359 {$value}fail}
7360.endd
7361The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7362any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7363which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7364non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7365
7366The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7367connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7368on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7369
7370When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7371removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7372some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7373quoting has two advantages:
7374
7375.ilist
7376It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7377DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7378.next
7379It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7380.endlist
7381
7382For example, a setting such as
7383.code
7384USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7385.endd
7386should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7387
7388Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7389expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7390field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7391does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7392.code
7393PASS=${quote:$3}
7394.endd
7395The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7396SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7397&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7398
7399
7400
7401.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7402.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7403The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7404as a sequence of values, for example
7405.code
7406cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7407.endd
7408The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7409search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7410the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7411values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7412you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7413directory.
7414
7415In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7416result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7417has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7418part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7419
7420If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7421strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7422quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7423backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7424Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7425(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7426Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7427output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7428same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7429
7430Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7431LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7432&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7433&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7434(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7435
7436.code
7437ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7438value1.1,value1,,2
7439
7440ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7441value two
7442
7443ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7444value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7445
7446ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7447attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7448
7449ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7450objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7451.endd
7452You can
7453make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7454results of LDAP lookups.
7455The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7456individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7457The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7458of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7459The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7460comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7461
7462
7463
7464
7465.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7466.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7467.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7468NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7469and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7470contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7471of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7472values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7473.code
7474[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7475.endd
7476might return the string
7477.code
7478name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7479home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7480.endd
7481(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7482.code
7483[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7484.endd
7485would just return
7486.code
7487Martin Guerre
7488.endd
7489with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7490for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7491operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7492
7493
7494
7495.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7496.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7497.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7498.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7499.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7500.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7501.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7502.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7503.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7504.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7505.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7506.cindex lookup Redis
7507Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7508and SQLite
7509databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7510might be
7511.code
7512${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7513 {$value}fail}
7514.endd
7515If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7516field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7517.code
7518${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7519 {$value}}
7520.endd
7521might be
7522.code
7523home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7524.endd
7525Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7526quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7527field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7528.code
7529Mister X
7530.endd
7531If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7532with a newline between the data for each row.
7533
7534
7535.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7536.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7537.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7538.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7539.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7540.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7541.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7542.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7543.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7544.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7545.cindex lookup Redis
7546If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7547&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7548or &%redis_servers%&
7549option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7550information.
7551(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7552queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7553&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7554For all but Redis
7555each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7556items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7557Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7558name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7559.code
7560hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7561.endd
7562Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7563&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7564option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7565.code
7566hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7567 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7568.endd
7569For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7570because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7571query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7572a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7573found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7574servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7575
7576.new
7577For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7578own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7579If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7580information.
7581Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7582host, database number, and password.
7583.olist
7584The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7585port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7586higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7587.next
7588The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7589.next
7590The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7591.endlist
7592.wen
7593
7594.new
7595The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7596convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7597respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7598itself are escaped with backslashes.
7599
7600The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7601escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7602.wen
7603
7604.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7605For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7606it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7607done by starting the query with
7608.display
7609&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7610.endd
7611Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7612.olist
7613If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7614global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7615of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7616taken from there.
7617.next
7618If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7619.endlist
7620The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7621Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7622successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7623
7624This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7625are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7626master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7627like this:
7628.code
7629mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7630 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7631 master/db/name/pw
7632.endd
7633In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7634.code
7635${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7636.endd
7637That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7638the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7639option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7640.code
7641${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7642.endd
7643
7644
7645.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7646For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7647causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7648socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7649.new
7650An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7651the default value is &"exim"&.
7652.wen
7653The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7654.display
7655<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7656 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7657.endd
7658Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7659the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7660
7661No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7662the queries.
7663
7664If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7665or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7666
7667&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7668anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7669is zero because no rows are affected.
7670
7671
7672.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7673PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7674This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7675However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7676database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7677looks like this:
7678.code
7679hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7680.endd
7681In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7682given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7683visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7684
7685If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7686update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7687affected.
7688
7689.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7690.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7691.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7692SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7693addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7694daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7695of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7696separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7697contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7698.code
7699${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7700 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7701.endd
7702In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7703.code
7704domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7705 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7706.endd
7707The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7708quote, which it doubles.
7709
7710.cindex timeout SQLite
7711.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7712The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7713internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7714update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7715are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7716waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7717to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7718option.
7719.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7720.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7721
7722
7723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7724. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7725
7726.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7727 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7728 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7729.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7730A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7731email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7732contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7733are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7734arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7735
7736Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7737host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7738different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7739general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7740
7741Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7742support all the complexity available in
7743domain, host, address and local part lists.
7744
7745
7746
7747.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7748.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7749Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7750expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7751into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7752but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7753&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7754discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7755
7756
7757If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7758testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7759expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7760
7761If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7762other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7763misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7764the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7765expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7766.code
7767deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7768 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7769.endd
7770The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7771&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7772senders based on the receiving domain.
7773
7774
7775
7776
7777.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7778.cindex "list" "negation"
7779.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7780Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7781leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7782defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7783it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7784(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7785
7786The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7787subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7788subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7789subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7790was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7791.code
7792domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7793.endd
7794matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7795neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7796list is positive. However, if the setting were
7797.code
7798domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7799.endd
7800then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7801list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7802as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7803
7804Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7805the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7806item.
7807
7808
7809
7810.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7811.cindex "list" "file name in"
7812If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7813name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7814processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7815file names are not allowed,
7816and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7817Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7818lines:
7819
7820.ilist
7821For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7822file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7823.next
7824Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7825address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7826white space or the start of the line. For example:
7827.code
7828not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7829.endd
7830.endlist
7831
7832Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7833file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7834is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7835so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7836
7837If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7838within the file is inverted. For example, if
7839.code
7840hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7841.endd
7842and the file contains the lines
7843.code
7844!a.b.c
7845*.b.c
7846.endd
7847then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7848any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7849
7850
7851
7852.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7853As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7854to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7855confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7856an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7857sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7858non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7859always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7860
7861If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7862list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7863in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7864&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7865
7866
7867
7868
7869.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7870.cindex "named lists"
7871.cindex "list" "named"
7872A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7873which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7874particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7875places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7876the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7877a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7878locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7879.code
7880domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7881.endd
7882Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7883for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7884configured with the line
7885.code
7886domains = +local_domains
7887.endd
7888The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7889except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7890.code
7891dnslookup:
7892 driver = dnslookup
7893 domains = ! +local_domains
7894 transport = remote_smtp
7895 no_more
7896.endd
7897The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7898the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7899respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7900equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7901.code
7902hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7903addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7904.endd
7905A named list may refer to other named lists:
7906.code
7907domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7908domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7909domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7910.endd
7911&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7912effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7913out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7914.code
7915domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7916domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7917.endd
7918The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7919list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7920means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7921.code
7922domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7923.endd
7924where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7925referenced lists if you can.
7926
7927Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7928address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7929lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7930.code
7931domains = +local_domains
7932.endd
7933on several of your routers
7934or in several ACL statements,
7935the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7936if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7937references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7938the same each time they are referenced.
7939
7940By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7941extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7942is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7943hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7944
7945
7946
7947.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7948.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7949.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7950At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7951configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7952write
7953.code
7954ALIST = host1 : host2
7955auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7956.endd
7957it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7958.code
7959auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7960.endd
7961Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7962list, and write
7963.code
7964hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7965auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7966.endd
7967the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7968.code
7969auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7970.endd
7971
7972
7973.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7974.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7975.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7976While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7977it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7978the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7979that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7980an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7981message. For example:
7982.code
7983domainlist special_domains = \
7984 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7985.endd
7986This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7987address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7988in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7989cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7990same list each time.
7991
7992By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7993cache the result anyway. For example:
7994.code
7995domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7996.endd
7997If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7998the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7999
8000
8001
8002.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8003.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8004.cindex "list" "domain list"
8005Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8006The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8007
8008.ilist
8009.cindex "primary host name"
8010.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8011.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8012.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8013.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8014If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8015as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8016possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8017differ only in their names.
8018.next
8019.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8020.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8021.cindex "domain literal"
8022If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8023in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8024only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8025&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8026control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8027In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8028.next
8029.cindex "@mx_any"
8030.cindex "@mx_primary"
8031.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8032.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8033If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8034has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8035.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8036&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8037are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8038local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8039but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8040preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8041
8042The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8043performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8044example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8045resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8046options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8047
8048Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8049patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8050list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8051ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8052on a router). For example:
8053.code
8054domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8055.endd
8056This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8057the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8058
8059The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8060host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8061contain negative items.
8062
8063Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8064be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8065list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8066.code
8067domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8068 an.other.domain : ...
8069.endd
8070so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8071involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8072.code
8073domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8074 an.other.domain ? ...
8075.endd
8076.next
8077.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8078.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8079.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8080If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8081are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8082domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8083list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8084matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8085list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8086&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8087
8088.next
8089.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8090.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8091If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8092expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8093function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8094Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8095default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8096with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8097are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8098
8099&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8100must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8101use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8102it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8103expression by expansion, of course).
8104.next
8105.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8106.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8107If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8108semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8109must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8110&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8111.code
8112domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8113.endd
8114The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8115key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8116only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8117is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8118or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8119&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8120other statements in the same ACL.
8121
8122.next
8123Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8124&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8125.code
8126domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8127.endd
8128This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8129works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8130
8131.next
8132.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8133Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8134a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8135original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8136select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8137value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8138expansion variable.
8139.next
8140If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8141semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8142pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8143chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8144.code
8145hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8146 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8147.endd
8148In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8149example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8150whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8151&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8152variable and can be referred to in other options.
8153.next
8154.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8155If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8156between the pattern and the domain.
8157.endlist
8158
8159Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8160.code
8161domainlist funny_domains = \
8162 @ : \
8163 lib.unseen.edu : \
8164 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8165 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8166 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8167 nis;domains.byname : \
8168 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8169.endd
8170There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8171an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8172explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8173but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8174patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8175patterns earlier.
8176
8177
8178
8179.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8180.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8181.cindex "list" "host list"
8182Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8183example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8184may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8185two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8186pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8187You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8188involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8189
8190
8191.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8192.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8193.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8194If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8195involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8196process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8197not used.
8198
8199.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8200The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8201the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8202
8203
8204
8205.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8206.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8207If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8208the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8209&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8210list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8211systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8212concerns.)
8213
8214The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8215inspecting its IP address:
8216
8217.ilist
8218If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8219with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8220to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8221&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8222This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8223with the IP address of the subject host.
8224
8225If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8226lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8227ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8228temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8229what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8230
8231.next
8232.cindex "@ in a host list"
8233If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8234domain name, as just described.
8235
8236.next
8237If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8238subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8239IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8240be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8241separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8242without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8243IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8244that can never match a client host.
8245
8246.next
8247.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8248If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8249the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8250interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8251.code
8252accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8253accept hosts = @[]
8254.endd
8255.next
8256.cindex "CIDR notation"
8257If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8258example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8259host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8260included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8261specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8262significant end of the address.
8263
8264&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8265of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8266address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8267addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8268.code
8269192.168.23.236/31
8270.endd
8271matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
827232 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8273matches.
8274
8275Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8276.code
8277recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8278 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8279.endd
8280The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8281appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8282For example:
8283.code
8284recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8285.endd
8286could make use of a file containing
8287.code
8288172.16.0.0/12
82893ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8290.endd
8291to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8292addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8293changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8294.code
8295recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8296 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8297.endd
8298The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8299list.
8300.endlist
8301
8302
8303
8304.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8305 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8306.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8307When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8308address, the pattern takes this form:
8309.display
8310&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8311.endd
8312For example:
8313.code
8314hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8315.endd
8316The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8317IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8318letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8319&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8320quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8321returned by the lookup is not used.
8322
8323.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8324.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8325Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8326patterns of this form:
8327.display
8328&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8329.endd
8330For example:
8331.code
8332net24-dbm;/networks.db
8333.endd
8334The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8335length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8336mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8337is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8338&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8339
8340When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8341of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8342terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8343to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8344recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8345(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8346For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8347converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8348addresses are always used.
8349
8350Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8351colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8352However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8353configurations.
8354
8355&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8356IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8357the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8358case the IP address is used on its own.
8359
8360
8361
8362.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8363.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8364.cindex "unknown host name"
8365.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8366There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8367remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8368complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8369address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8370above.)
8371
8372If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8373patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8374Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8375DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8376Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8377effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8378Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8379
8380Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8381against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8382
8383By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8384if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8385&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8386are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8387security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8388for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8389Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8390discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8391found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8392
8393There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8394found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8395
8396.cindex "host" "alias for"
8397.cindex "alias for host"
8398As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8399of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8400
8401.ilist
8402.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8403If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8404the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8405&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8406requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8407expression.
8408.next
8409.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8410.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8411If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8412matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8413expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8414case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8415syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8416example,
8417.code
8418^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8419.endd
8420is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8421&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8422that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8423string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8424part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8425.code
8426sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8427.endd
8428&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8429&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8430example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8431required.
8432.endlist
8433
8434
8435
8436
8437.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8438.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8439While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8440name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8441from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8442behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8443
8444&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8445apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8446
8447.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8448.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8449Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8450lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8451Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8452does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8453To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8454&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8455not recognized in an indirected file).
8456
8457.ilist
8458If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8459cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8460.code
8461host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8462.endd
8463rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8464any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8465
8466.next
8467If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8468be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8469example:
8470.code
8471accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8472 192.168.4.5
8473.endd
8474accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8475whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8476name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8477.endlist
8478
8479Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8480list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8481list.
8482
8483.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8484 "SECTmixwilhos"
8485.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8486
8487This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8488as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8489wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8490
8491.ilist
8492If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8493IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8494addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8495.code
8496accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8497.endd
8498The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8499left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8500without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8501a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8502pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8503&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8504if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8505
8506.next
8507If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8508address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8509.code
8510accept hosts = *.friend.example
8511accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8512.endd
8513If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8514&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8515&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8516this section.
8517.endlist
8518
8519
8520.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8521 "SECTtemdnserr"
8522.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8523.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8524.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8525A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8526&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8527host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8528&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8529section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8530host lists such as whitelists.
8531
8532
8533
8534.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8535 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8536.cindex "unknown host name"
8537.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8538If a pattern is of the form
8539.display
8540<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8541.endd
8542for example
8543.code
8544dbm;/host/accept/list
8545.endd
8546a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8547lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8548is not used.
8549
8550&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8551keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8552addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8553&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8554two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8555lookup, both using the same file.
8556
8557
8558
8559.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8560If a pattern is of the form
8561.display
8562<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8563.endd
8564the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8565data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8566&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8567.code
8568hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8569 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8570.endd
8571The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8572can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8573use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8574operator.
8575
8576If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8577looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8578&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8579
8580Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8581host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8582&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8583still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8584effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8585See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8586
8587
8588
8589
8590
8591.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8592.cindex "list" "address list"
8593.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8594.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8595Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8596is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8597always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8598list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8599using this option setting:
8600.code
8601senders = :
8602.endd
8603The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8604data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8605detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8606and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8607
8608Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8609example:
8610.code
8611senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8612.endd
8613A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8614character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8615semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8616subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8617with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8618the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8619wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8620.code
8621deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8622 *@+hostile_domains:\
8623 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8624 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8625.endd
8626.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8627.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8628If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8629specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8630treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8631
8632If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8633contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8634address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8635domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8636is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8637.code
8638deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8639.endd
8640
8641The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8642address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8643senders:
8644
8645.ilist
8646.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8647.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8648If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8649done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8650You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8651as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8652to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8653.code
8654deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8655 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8656.endd
8657The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8658start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8659
8660.next
8661.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8662Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8663lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8664example:
8665.code
8666deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8667 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8668 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8669.endd
8670Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8671lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8672not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8673always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8674
8675Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8676cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8677panic log.
8678.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8679However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8680&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8681default. For example, with this lookup:
8682.code
8683accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8684.endd
8685the file could contains lines like this:
8686.code
8687user1@domain1.example
8688*@domain2.example
8689.endd
8690and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8691that are tried is:
8692.code
8693nimrod@jaeger.example
8694*@jaeger.example
8695*
8696.endd
8697&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8698would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8699
8700&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8701.code
8702deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8703deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8704.endd
8705The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8706because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8707domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8708.endlist
8709
8710
8711The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8712If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8713always fails.
8714
8715
8716.ilist
8717.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8718.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8719.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8720If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8721(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8722split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8723it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8724from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8725of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8726
8727.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8728The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8729keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8730patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8731even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8732with
8733.code
8734deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8735.endd
8736the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8737.code
8738baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8739.endd
8740to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8741
8742.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8743If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8744has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8745may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8746but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8747surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8748.code
8749aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8750 spammer3 : spammer4
8751.endd
8752As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8753doubling.
8754
8755If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8756of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8757list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8758might have entries like
8759.code
8760aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8761xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8762*: ^\d{8}$
8763.endd
8764in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8765local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8766each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8767chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8768
8769.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8770It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8771them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8772
8773.next
8774The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8775lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8776can only return a single list of local parts.
8777.endlist
8778
8779&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8780in these two examples:
8781.code
8782senders = +my_list
8783senders = *@+my_list
8784.endd
8785In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8786example it is a named domain list.
8787
8788
8789
8790
8791.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8792.cindex "case of local parts"
8793.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8794.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8795Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8796case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8797Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8798Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8799blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8800lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8801default.
8802
8803The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8804address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8805comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8806the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8807that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8808keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8809works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8810case-independent.
8811
8812.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8813To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8814an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8815part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8816longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8817lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8818performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8819become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8820
8821
8822
8823.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8824.cindex "list" "local part list"
8825.cindex "local part" "list"
8826Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8827lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8828setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8829set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8830case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8831matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8832&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8833option is case-sensitive from the start.
8834
8835If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8836comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8837only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8838Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8839that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8840&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8841Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8842types.
8843.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8844
8845
8846
8847
8848. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8849. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8850
8851.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8852.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8853Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8854them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8855
8856When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8857when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8858start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8859below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8860escape character, as described in the following section.
8861
8862Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8863dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8864options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8865the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8866conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8867reasons.
8868
8869
8870
8871.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8872.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8873An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8874backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8875character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8876If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8877required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8878the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8879
8880.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8881A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8882two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8883expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8884.code
8885deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8886.endd
8887On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8888without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8889string.
8890
8891
8892
8893.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8894.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8895A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8896expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8897carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8898octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8899backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8900encoding.
8901
8902These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8903in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8904and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8905
8906
8907.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8908.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8909.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8910.oindex "&%-be%&"
8911Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8912takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8913arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8914to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8915since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8916value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8917database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8918and &%nhash%&.
8919
8920Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8921instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8922using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8923
8924.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8925If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8926from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8927option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8928read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8929.code
8930exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8931.endd
8932The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8933Exim message identifier. For example:
8934.code
8935exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8936.endd
8937This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8938is therefore restricted to admin users.
8939
8940
8941.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8942.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8943A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8944alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8945(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8946used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8947instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8948the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8949that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8950its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8951from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8952taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8953being expanded.
8954
8955
8956
8957
8958.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8959The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8960between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8961outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8962white space is significant.
8963
8964.vlist
8965.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8966.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8967Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8968.code
8969$local_part
8970${domain}
8971.endd
8972The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8973characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8974&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8975section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8976given, the expansion fails.
8977
8978.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8979.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8980The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8981<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8982.code
8983${lc:$local_part}
8984.endd
8985The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8986leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8987below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8988one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8989string easier to understand.
8990
8991.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8992This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8993expansion item below.
8994
8995
8996.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8997.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8998.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8999The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9000arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9001Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9002arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9003and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9004are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9005a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9006the result of the expansion.
9007If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9008the expansion result is an empty string.
9009If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9010
9011
9012.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9013 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9014.cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
9015.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9016.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9017The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9018The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9019the certificate. Supported fields are:
9020.display
9021&`version `&
9022&`serial_number `&
9023&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9024&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9025&`notbefore `& time
9026&`notafter `& time
9027&`sig_algorithm `&
9028&`signature `&
9029&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9030&`ocsp_uri `& list
9031&`crl_uri `& list
9032.endd
9033If the field is found,
9034<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9035otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9036variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9037is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9038
9039If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9040key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9041extracted is used.
9042
9043Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9044
9045The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9046output a Distinguished Name string which is
9047not quite
9048parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9049(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9050RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9051a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9052result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9053The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9054a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9055Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9056
9057The field selectors marked as "time" above
9058take an optional modifier of "int"
9059for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9060Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9061in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9062
9063The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9064newline-separated by default,
9065(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9066The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9067a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9068
9069The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9070prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9071Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9072which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9073if so the element tags are omitted.
9074
9075If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9076
9077.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9078 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9079.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9080This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9081This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9082.code
9083EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9084.endd
9085set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9086object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9087(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9088
9089There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9090a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9091included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9092are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9093must have the following type:
9094.code
9095int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9096.endd
9097Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9098function should return one of the following values:
9099
9100&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9101into the expanded string that is being built.
9102
9103&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9104from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9105
9106&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9107taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9108
9109&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9110
9111When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9112you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9113configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9114
9115
9116.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9117.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9118.cindex "environment" "value from"
9119The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9120removed.
9121This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9122If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9123and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9124
9125Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9126appear, for example:
9127.code
9128${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9129.endd
9130This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9131{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9132
9133If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9134search failure.
9135If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9136search success.
9137
9138
9139.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9140 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9141.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9142.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9143The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9144white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9145must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9146form:
9147.display
9148<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9149.endd
9150.vindex "&$value$&"
9151where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9152values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9153values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9154described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9155for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9156the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9157otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9158variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9159is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9160
9161If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9162key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9163extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9164yield &"2001"&:
9165.code
9166${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9167${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9168.endd
9169Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9170appear, for example:
9171.code
9172${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9173.endd
9174This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9175{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9176
9177
9178.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9179 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9180.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9181.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9182The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9183apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9184This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9185behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9186extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9187argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9188<&'string3'&> as before.
9189
9190The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9191separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9192The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9193counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9194number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9195number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9196expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9197provided. For example:
9198.code
9199${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9200.endd
9201yields &"42"&, and
9202.code
9203${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9204.endd
9205yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9206empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9207
9208
9209.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9210.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9211.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9212.vindex "&$item$&"
9213After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9214default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9215in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9216evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9217item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9218separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9219input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9220.code
9221${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9222.endd
9223yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9224to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9225
9226
9227.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9228.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9229.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9230This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9231early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9232(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9233
9234The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9235<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9236<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9237use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9238.code
9239${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9240.endd
9241The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9242or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9243Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9244function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9245first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9246.code
9247abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9248.endd
9249If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9250letters appear. For example:
9251.display
9252&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9253&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9254&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9255.endd
9256
9257.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9258 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9259 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9260 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9261 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9262 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9263.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9264.vindex "&$header_$&"
9265.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9266.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9267.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9268.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9269.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9270Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9271.code
9272$header_reply-to:
9273.endd
9274The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9275internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9276lines) may be present.
9277
9278The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9279the data in the header line is interpreted.
9280
9281.ilist
9282.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9283&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9284processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9285
9286.next
9287.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9288&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9289or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9290character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9291&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9292.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9293produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9294what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9295
9296.next
9297&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9298standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9299be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9300returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9301&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9302a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9303.endlist ilist
9304
9305In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9306command of the following form:
9307.code
9308headers charset "UTF-8"
9309.endd
9310This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9311subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9312character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9313option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9314value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9315ISO-8859-1.
9316
9317Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9318any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9319&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9320if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9321
9322Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9323this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9324message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9325filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9326router or transport are not accessible.
9327
9328For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9329before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9330message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9331are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9332point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9333by earlier ACLs are visible.
9334
9335Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9336following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9337this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9338white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9339expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9340expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9341section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9342header.)
9343
9344If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9345to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9346&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9347each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9348newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9349newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9350those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9351junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9352
9353
9354.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9355.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9356.cindex &%hmac%&
9357This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9358shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9359RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9360&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9361cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9362or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9363present. For example:
9364.code
9365${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9366.endd
9367For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9368produces:
9369.code
9370dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9371.endd
9372As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9373an Exim configuration:
9374.code
9375SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9376.endd
9377In a router or a transport you could then have:
9378.code
9379headers_add = \
9380 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9381 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9382 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9383.endd
9384Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9385&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9386this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9387host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9388using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9389&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9390
9391
9392.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9393.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9394.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9395If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9396item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9397in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9398.code
9399${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9400.endd
9401The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9402true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9403be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9404case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9405&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9406
9407If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9408is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9409cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9410.code
9411condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9412.endd
9413you can use
9414.code
9415condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9416.endd
9417
9418
9419
9420.new
9421.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9422.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9423.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9424This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9425folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9426For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9427.wen
9428
9429
9430
9431.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9432.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9433.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9434The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9435strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9436you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9437change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9438some of the braces:
9439.code
9440${length_<n>:<string>}
9441.endd
9442The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9443of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9444&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9445
9446
9447.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9448 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9449.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9450.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9451.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9452The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9453apart from an optional leading minus,
9454and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9455
9456After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9457default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9458
9459The first field of the list is numbered one.
9460If the number is negative, the fields are
9461counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9462The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9463then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9464
9465If the modulus of the
9466number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9467the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9468
9469For example:
9470.code
9471${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9472.endd
9473yields &"42"&, and
9474.code
9475${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9476.endd
9477yields &"result: 42"&.
9478
9479If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9480If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9481extracted is used.
9482You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9483
9484
9485.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9486 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9487This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9488described in the next item.
9489
9490.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9491 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9492.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9493.cindex "file" "lookups"
9494.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9495The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9496discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9497lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9498<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9499
9500If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9501a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9502other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9503in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9504out by the system administrator.
9505
9506.vindex "&$value$&"
9507If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9508During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9509lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9510level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9511the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9512string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9513lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9514original lookup fails.
9515
9516If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9517data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9518expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9519the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9520appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9521to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9522{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9523successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9524
9525For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9526search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9527type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9528&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9529
9530.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9531If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9532and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9533They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9534
9535This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9536.code
9537${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9538.endd
9539This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9540the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9541.code
9542${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9543 {$value}fail}
9544.endd
9545
9546
9547.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9548.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9549.vindex "&$item$&"
9550After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9551default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9552in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9553expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9554for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9555setting is not included in the output. For example:
9556.code
9557${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9558.endd
9559expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9560value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9561and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9562
9563.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9564.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9565.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9566The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9567<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9568if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9569can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9570.code
9571${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9572.endd
9573The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9574the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9575processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9576slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9577example,
9578.code
9579${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9580.endd
9581returns the string &"6/33"&.
9582
9583
9584
9585.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9586.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9587.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9588This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9589interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9590expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9591additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9592name of the subroutine, is nine.
9593
9594The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9595the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9596way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9597Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9598return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9599not its contents.
9600
9601If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9602with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9603Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9604
9605The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9606out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9607
9608
9609.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9610.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9611The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9612keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9613it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9614to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9615as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9616and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9617
9618.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9619 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9620.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9621This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9622checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9623yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9624empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9625prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9626version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9627variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9628
9629These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9630retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9631against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9632which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9633
9634The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9635string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9636result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9637whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9638is the expansion of the third argument.
9639
9640All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9641However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9642For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9643
9644.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9645.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9646.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9647.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9648The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9649then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9650the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9651newlines are left in the string.
9652String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9653you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9654the string expansion fails.
9655
9656The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9657locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9658
9659
9660
9661.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9662 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9663.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9664.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9665.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9666This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9667string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9668examples:
9669.code
9670${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9671${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9672.endd
9673For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9674For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9675a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9676number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9677optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9678example:
9679.code
9680${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9681.endd
9682Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9683one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9684both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9685unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9686and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9687is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9688extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9689.code
9690${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9691.endd
9692A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9693that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9694turns them into spaces:
9695.code
9696${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9697.endd
9698As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9699happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9700addition, the following errors can occur:
9701
9702.ilist
9703Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9704.next
9705Failure to connect the socket;
9706.next
9707Failure to write the request string;
9708.next
9709Timeout on reading from the socket.
9710.endlist
9711
9712By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9713you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9714errors occurs. For example:
9715.code
9716${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9717 {socket failure}}
9718.endd
9719You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9720expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9721and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9722if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9723non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9724
9725The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9726locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9727
9728
9729.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9730.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9731.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9732.vindex "&$value$&"
9733.vindex "&$item$&"
9734This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9735<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9736separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9737assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9738list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9739them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9740iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9741added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9742number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9743.code
9744${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9745.endd
9746The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9747can be found:
9748.code
9749${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9750.endd
9751At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9752restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9753expansion items.
9754
9755.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9756This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9757expansion item above.
9758
9759.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9760 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9761.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9762.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9763The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9764split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9765in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9766executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9767a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9768
9769Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9770which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9771simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9772script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9773variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9774quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9775in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9776around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9777variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9778character.
9779
9780The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9781and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9782.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9783.vindex "&$value$&"
9784If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9785and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9786from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9787<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9788expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9789&$value$&.
9790
9791If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9792can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9793command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9794of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9795
9796.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9797The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9798In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9799troubleshoot:
9800.code
9801warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9802 log_message = Output of id: $value
9803.endd
9804If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9805shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9806.code
9807${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9808.endd
9809
9810.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9811The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9812remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9813.code
9814if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9815 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9816 ...
9817endif
9818.endd
9819If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9820the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9821commands.
9822
9823&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9824option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9825testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9826by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9827
9828The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9829out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9830
9831
9832.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9833.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9834.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9835This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9836option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9837modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9838into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9839a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9840.code
9841${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9842.endd
9843yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9844if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9845substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9846.code
9847${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9848.endd
9849yields &"defabc"&, and
9850.code
9851${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9852.endd
9853yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9854the regular expression from string expansion.
9855
9856
9857
9858.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9859.cindex sorting "a list"
9860.cindex list sorting
9861.cindex expansion "list sorting"
9862After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9863default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9864The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9865of a two-argument expansion condition.
9866The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9867The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9868if the first value should sort before the second value.
9869The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9870the element being placed in &$item$&,
9871to give values for comparison.
9872
9873The item result is a sorted list,
9874with the original list separator,
9875of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9876
9877Examples:
9878.code
9879${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9880.endd
9881sorts a list of numbers, and
9882.code
9883${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9884.endd
9885will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9886
9887
9888.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9889.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9890.cindex "substring extraction"
9891.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9892The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9893<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9894if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9895can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9896.code
9897${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9898.endd
9899The second number is optional (in both notations).
9900If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9901omitted.
9902
9903The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9904&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9905length required. For example
9906.code
9907${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9908.endd
9909If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9910null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9911length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9912given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9913
9914The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9915from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9916second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9917.code
9918${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9919.endd
9920yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9921length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9922the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9923.code
9924${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9925.endd
9926yields an empty string, but
9927.code
9928${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9929.endd
9930yields &"1"&.
9931
9932When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9933is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9934string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9935no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9936.code
9937${substr_-1:abcde}
9938${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9939.endd
9940yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9941
9942
9943
9944.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9945 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9946.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9947.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9948This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9949argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9950matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9951replacement list. For example
9952.code
9953${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9954.endd
9955yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9956last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9957last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9958place.
9959.endlist
9960
9961
9962
9963.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9964.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9965For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9966the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9967The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9968following operations can be performed:
9969
9970.vlist
9971.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9972.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9973.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9974The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9975header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9976not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9977
9978
9979.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9980.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9981.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9982The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
99832822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9984operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9985result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9986doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9987Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9988
9989It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9990separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9991character. For example:
9992.code
9993${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9994.endd
9995expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9996expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9997address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9998processing lists.
9999
10000To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10001a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10002unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10003email address separator. For the example header line:
10004.code
10005From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10006.endd
10007The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10008properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10009It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10010example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10011de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10012The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10013quoted.
10014.code
10015# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10016=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10017user@example.com
10018# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10019Last:user@example.com
10020# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10021user@example.com
10022.endd
10023
10024.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10025.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10026.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10027The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10028base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10029the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10030its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10031names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10032be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10033
10034.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10035.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10036.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10037The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10038environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10039identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10040string.
10041
10042.new
10043.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10044.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10045.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10046.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10047.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10048This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10049
10050If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10051returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10052
10053
10054.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10055.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10056.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10057.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10058This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10059.wen
10060
10061
10062.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10063.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10064.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10065The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10066from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10067
10068
10069.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10070.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10071.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10072If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10073escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10074significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10075is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10076
10077
10078.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10079.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10080.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10081.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10082These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10083expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10084arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10085logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10086integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10087C programming language):
10088.table2 70pt 300pt
10089.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10090.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10091.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10092.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10093.irow "" "and (&&)"
10094.irow "" "xor (^)"
10095.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10096.endtable
10097Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10098space is permitted before or after operators.
10099
10100For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10101hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10102decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10103permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10104times, which often do have leading zeros.
10105
10106A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10107or 1024*1024*1024,
10108respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10109a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10110
10111.display
10112&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10113&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10114&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10115&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10116&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10117&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10118&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10119&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10120&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10121&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10122&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10123.endd
10124
10125As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10126.code
10127deny message = Too many bad recipients
10128 condition = \
10129 ${if and { \
10130 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10131 { \
10132 < \
10133 {$recipients_count} \
10134 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10135 } \
10136 }{yes}{no}}
10137.endd
10138The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10139fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10140
10141
10142.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10143.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10144The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10145example,
10146.code
10147${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10148.endd
10149first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10150and then re-expands what it has found.
10151
10152
10153.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10154.cindex "Unicode"
10155.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10156.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10157.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10158The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10159email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10160to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10161UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10162converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10163the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10164
10165Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10166ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10167For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10168way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10169characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10170single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10171translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10172
10173
10174.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10175.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10176.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10177The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10178be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10179change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10180.code
10181${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10182.endd
10183See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10184abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10185
10186
10187
10188.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10189.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10190.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10191.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10192This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10193be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10194
10195
10196
10197.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10198.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10199.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10200This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10201escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10202as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10203byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10204
10205
10206.new
10207.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10208.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10209.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10210This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10211of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10212A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10213Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10214
10215.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10216.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10217.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10218.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10219This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10220Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10221set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10222A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10223Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10224.wen
10225
10226
10227.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10228.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10229.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10230.cindex "lower casing"
10231.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10232.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10233This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10234.code
10235${lc:$local_part}
10236.endd
10237
10238.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10239.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10240.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10241The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10242can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10243changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10244.code
10245${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10246.endd
10247See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10248&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10249when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10250
10251
10252.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10253.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10254.cindex "list" "item count"
10255.cindex "list" "count of items"
10256.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10257The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10258
10259
10260.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10261.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10262.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10263The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10264expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10265If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10266and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10267Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10268matching list is returned.
10269
10270
10271.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10272.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10273.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10274The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10275extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10276empty.
10277
10278
10279.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10280.cindex "masked IP address"
10281.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10282.cindex "CIDR notation"
10283.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10284.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10285If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10286slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10287expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10288masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10289the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10290.code
10291${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10292.endd
10293returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10294be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10295address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10296terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10297.code
10298${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10299.endd
10300returns the string
10301.code
103023ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10303.endd
10304Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10305
10306
10307.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10308.cindex "MD5 hash"
10309.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10310.cindex certificate fingerprint
10311.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10312The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10313as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10314
10315If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10316returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10317
10318
10319.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10320.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10321.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10322The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10323that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10324strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10325.code
10326${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10327.endd
10328See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10329
10330
10331.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10332.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10333.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10334.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10335The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10336is an empty string or
10337contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10338Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10339Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10340respectively For example,
10341.code
10342${quote:ab"*"cd}
10343.endd
10344becomes
10345.code
10346"ab\"*\"cd"
10347.endd
10348The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10349variable or a message header.
10350
10351.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10352.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10353This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10354required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10355example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10356If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10357(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10358
10359
10360.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10361.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10362This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10363query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10364the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10365.code
10366${quote_ldap:two * two}
10367.endd
10368returns
10369.code
10370two%20%5C2A%20two
10371.endd
10372For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10373yields an unchanged string.
10374
10375
10376.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10377.cindex "random number"
10378This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10379supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10380on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10381If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10382If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10383for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10384Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10385srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10386random().
10387
10388
10389.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10390.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10391This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10392dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10393dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10394for DNS. For example,
10395.code
10396${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10397${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10398.endd
10399returns
10400.code
104014.2.0.192
10402f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10403.endd
10404
10405
10406.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10407.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10408.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10409.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10410This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10411encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10412assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10413&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10414contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10415characters
10416.code
10417? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10418.endd
10419it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10420string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10421characters.
10422
10423
10424.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10425.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10426.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10427.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10428This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10429bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10430character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10431not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10432
10433&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10434access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10435to use this operator as well.
10436
10437
10438
10439.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10440.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10441.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10442.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10443The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10444characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10445variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10446
10447
10448.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10449.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10450.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10451.cindex certificate fingerprint
10452.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10453The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10454it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10455
10456If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10457returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10458
10459
10460.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10461.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10462.cindex certificate fingerprint
10463.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10464.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10465The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10466certificate,
10467and returns
10468it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10469Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10470
10471
10472.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10473.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10474.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10475.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10476The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10477function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10478expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10479series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10480except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10481a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1048210-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10483&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10484can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10485
10486The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10487the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10488systems for files larger than 2GB.
10489
10490.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10491.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10492.new
10493Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10494.wen
10495
10496
10497
10498.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10499.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10500.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10501.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10502The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10503decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10504
10505
10506.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10507.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10508.cindex "substring extraction"
10509.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10510The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10511can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10512that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10513.code
10514${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10515.endd
10516See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10517abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10518
10519.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10520.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10521.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10522This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10523seconds.
10524
10525.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10526.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10527.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10528The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10529represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10530number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10531&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10532
10533.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10534.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10535.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10536.cindex "upper casing"
10537.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10538.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10539This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10540
10541.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10542.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10543.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10544.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10545.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10546.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10547This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10548
10549.new
10550.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10551 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10552 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10553 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10554.cindex expansion UTF-8
10555.cindex UTF-8 expansion
10556.cindex EAI
10557.cindex internationalisation
10558.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10559.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10560.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10561.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10562These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10563For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10564.wen
10565.endlist
10566
10567
10568
10569
10570
10571
10572.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10573.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10574The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10575while expanding strings:
10576
10577.vlist
10578.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10579.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10580.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10581Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10582condition.
10583
10584.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10585.cindex "numeric comparison"
10586.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10587There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10588are:
10589.display
10590&`= `& equal
10591&`== `& equal
10592&`> `& greater
10593&`>= `& greater or equal
10594&`< `& less
10595&`<= `& less or equal
10596.endd
10597For example:
10598.code
10599${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10600.endd
10601Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10602two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10603optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10604lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10605As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10606zero.
10607
10608In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10609<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1061010M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10611
10612
10613.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10614 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10615.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10616.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10617The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10618arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10619Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10620arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10621and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10622are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10623a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10624the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10625If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10626If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10627
10628.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10629.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10630.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10631This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10632a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10633(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10634false if zero.
10635An empty string is treated as false.
10636Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10637thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10638All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10639
10640When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10641make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10642For example:
10643.code
10644${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10645.endd
10646
10647
10648.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10649.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10650.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10651Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10652where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10653loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10654and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10655true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10656
10657Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10658
10659.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10660.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10661.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10662.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10663This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10664authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10665necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10666included in the binary.
10667
10668The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10669compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10670be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10671encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10672does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10673&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10674Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10675string in LDAP form is:
10676.code
10677{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10678.endd
10679If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10680be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10681.code
10682${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10683.endd
10684The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10685supported:
10686
10687.ilist
10688.cindex "MD5 hash"
10689.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10690&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10691printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10692length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10693(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10694hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10695comparison fails.
10696
10697.next
10698.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10699&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10700printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10701length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10702If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10703SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10704
10705.next
10706.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10707&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10708only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10709systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10710whatever its length.
10711
10712.next
10713.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10714&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10715use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10716modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10717.endlist
10718Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10719&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10720HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10721operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10722the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10723support &[crypt16()]&.
10724
10725Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10726it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10727turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10728&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10729algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10730
10731However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10732functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10733Exim is seen as very low priority.
10734
10735If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10736comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10737determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10738default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10739function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10740
10741.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10742.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10743.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10744The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10745variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10746variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10747.code
10748${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10749.endd
10750Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10751variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10752
10753.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10754 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10755.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10756This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10757exists in the message. For example,
10758.code
10759${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10760.endd
10761&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10762the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10763
10764.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10765 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10766.cindex "string" "comparison"
10767.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10768.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10769.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10770The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10771resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10772letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10773
10774.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10775.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10776.cindex "file" "existence test"
10777.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10778The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10779condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10780is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10781users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10782
10783.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10784.cindex "delivery" "first"
10785.cindex "first delivery"
10786.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10787.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10788This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10789attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10790
10791
10792.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10793 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10794.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10795.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10796.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10797.vindex "&$item$&"
10798These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10799the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10800the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10801be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10802condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10803.ilist
10804For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10805the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10806items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10807.next
10808For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10809and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10810all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10811.endlist
10812Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10813items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10814that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10815list separator is changed to a comma:
10816.code
10817${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10818.endd
10819The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10820being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10821
10822To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10823
10824
10825.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10826 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10827.cindex "string" "comparison"
10828.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10829.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10830.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10831The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10832string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10833comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10834case-independent.
10835
10836.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10837 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10838.cindex "string" "comparison"
10839.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10840.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10841.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10842The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10843string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10844includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10845case-independent.
10846
10847.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10848 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10849.cindex "string" "comparison"
10850.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10851Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10852strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10853is true.
10854
10855These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10856Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10857.code
10858${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10859 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10860${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10861 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10862.endd
10863
10864.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10865 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10866 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10867.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10868.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10869.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10870.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10871.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10872The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10873an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10874&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10875
10876For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10877which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10878colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10879hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10880component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10881
10882&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10883values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10884check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10885host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10886.code
10887${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10888.endd
10889to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10890
10891.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10892.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10893.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10894.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10895This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10896&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10897queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10898query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10899password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10900server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10901with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10902will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10903of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10904this can be used.
10905
10906
10907.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10908 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10909.cindex "string" "comparison"
10910.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10911.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10912.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10913The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10914string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10915comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10916case-independent.
10917
10918.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10919 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10920.cindex "string" "comparison"
10921.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10922.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10923.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10924The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10925string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10926includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10927case-independent.
10928
10929
10930.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10931.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10932.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10933.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10934The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10935expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10936regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10937escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10938(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10939premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10940&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10941For example,
10942.code
10943${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10944.endd
10945If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10946backslashes is also required.
10947
10948The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10949The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10950metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10951and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10952the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10953metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10954
10955.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10956At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10957substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10958succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10959will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10960of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10961combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10962variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10963
10964.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10965.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10966See &*match_local_part*&.
10967
10968.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10969.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10970See &*match_local_part*&.
10971
10972.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10973.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10974This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10975be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10976address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10977list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10978.code
10979${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10980.endd
10981The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10982
10983.ilist
10984An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10985.next
10986A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10987.next
10988An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10989useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10990in a single test such as
10991. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10992. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10993. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10994. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10995.code
10996 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10997.endd
10998where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10999.next
11000The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11001.next
11002Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11003even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11004address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11005&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11006masks. For example:
11007.code
11008 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11009.endd
11010It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11011do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11012address mask, for example:
11013.code
11014 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11015.endd
11016However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11017just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11018.code
11019 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11020.endd
11021.endlist ilist
11022
11023Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11024Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11025
11026Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11027
11028.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11029.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11030.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11031.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11032.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11033This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11034possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11035condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11036example is:
11037.code
11038${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11039.endd
11040In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11041list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
11042expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11043Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11044.code
11045${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11046.endd
11047.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11048For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11049item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11050have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11051caselessly.
11052
11053Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11054Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11055
11056&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11057hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11058how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11059matched using &%match_ip%&.
11060
11061.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11062.cindex "PAM authentication"
11063.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11064.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11065.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11066.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11067&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11068(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11069available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11070distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11071the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11072.code
11073SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11074.endd
11075in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11076in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11077
11078The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11079colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11080The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11081taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11082The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11083from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11084request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11085
11086There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11087characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11088separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11089item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11090of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11091.code
11092server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11093.endd
11094For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11095.code
11096server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11097.endd
11098In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11099running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11100messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11101A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11102Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11103The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11104to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11105group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11106
11107
11108.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11109.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11110.cindex "Cyrus"
11111.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11112.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11113This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11114This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11115that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11116deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11117
11118The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11119the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11120building Exim. For example:
11121.code
11122CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11123.endd
11124You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11125the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11126from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11127access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11128
11129The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11130password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11131configuration, you might have this:
11132.code
11133server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11134.endd
11135Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11136.code
11137server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11138.endd
11139.vitem &*queue_running*&
11140.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11141.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11142.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11143This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11144initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11145
11146
11147.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11148.cindex "Radius"
11149.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11150.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11151Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11152set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11153the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11154support.
11155
11156With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11157library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11158this library, you need to set
11159.code
11160RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11161.endd
11162in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11163&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11164.code
11165RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11166.endd
11167in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11168You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11169Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11170
11171The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11172Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11173the authentication is successful. For example:
11174.code
11175server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11176.endd
11177
11178
11179.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11180 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11181.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11182.cindex "Cyrus"
11183.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11184.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11185This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11186daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11187Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11188by a process that is not running as root.
11189
11190The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11191the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11192building Exim. For example:
11193.code
11194CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11195.endd
11196You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11197the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11198from the Cyrus SASL library.
11199
11200Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11201two are mandatory. For example:
11202.code
11203server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11204.endd
11205The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11206in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11207realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11208.endlist vlist
11209
11210
11211
11212.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11213.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11214Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11215and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11216conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11217sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11218the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11219
11220
11221.vlist
11222.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11223.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11224.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11225The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11226any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11227For example,
11228.code
11229${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11230.endd
11231When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11232evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11233numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11234
11235.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11236.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11237.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11238The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11239all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11240sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11241the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11242parsed but not evaluated.
11243.endlist
11244.ecindex IIDexpcond
11245
11246
11247
11248
11249.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11250.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11251This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11252of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11253support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11254
11255.vlist
11256.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11257.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11258When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11259captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11260processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11261In the expansion condition case
11262they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11263values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11264variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11265precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11266Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11267matching condition.
11268
11269.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11270Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11271any arguments are copied to these variables,
11272any unused variables being made empty.
11273
11274.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11275Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11276can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11277long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11278example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11279variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11280used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11281same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11282with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11283during subsequent delivery.
11284
11285.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11286These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11287are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11288received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11289message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11290also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11291message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11292and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11293delivery.
11294
11295.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11296Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11297this variable has the number of arguments.
11298
11299.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11300.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11301After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11302message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11303be preserved by coding like this:
11304.code
11305warn !verify = sender
11306 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11307.endd
11308You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11309&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11310failure.
11311
11312.vitem &$address_data$&
11313.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11314This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11315value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11316and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11317the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11318for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11319user filter files.
11320
11321If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11322a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11323conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11324to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11325of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11326from the child's routing.
11327
11328If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11329sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11330&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11331address.
11332
11333In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11334after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11335these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11336
11337.vitem &$address_file$&
11338.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11339When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11340to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11341is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11342default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11343.code
11344/home/r2d2/savemail
11345.endd
11346then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11347contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11348.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11349For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11350then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11351to the relevant file.
11352
11353.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11354.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11355When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11356this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11357
11358.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11359.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11360These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11361&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11362
11363.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11364.cindex "authentication" "id"
11365.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11366When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11367preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11368&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11369user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11370in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11371&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11372When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11373the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11374process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11375command line option.
11376
11377.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11378.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11379.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11380When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11381will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11382id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11383available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11384A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11385authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11386the ACL's as well.
11387
11388
11389.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11390.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11391.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11392.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11393.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11394When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11395SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11396described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11397&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11398available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11399sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11400
11401.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11402When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11403value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11404name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11405can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11406
11407
11408.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11409.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11410.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11411This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11412command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11413possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11414(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11415&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11416is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11417negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11418an undefined mechanism.
11419
11420.vitem &$av_failed$&
11421.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11422This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11423extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11424problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11425the ACL malware condition.
11426
11427.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11428.cindex "message body" "line count"
11429.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11430.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11431When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11432number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11433
11434.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11435.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11436.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11437.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11438.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11439When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11440number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11441
11442.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11443.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11444This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11445it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11446chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11447
11448.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11449.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11450This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11451up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11452file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11453
11454.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11455.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11456.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11457The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11458not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11459&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11460incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11461
11462.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11463.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11464.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11465The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11466not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11467&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11468incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11469
11470.vitem &$callout_address$&
11471.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11472After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11473address that was connected to.
11474
11475.vitem &$compile_number$&
11476.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11477The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11478of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11479compilations of the same version of the program.
11480
11481.vitem &$config_dir$&
11482.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11483The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11484&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11485contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11486&$config_dir$& is ".".
11487
11488.vitem &$config_file$&
11489.vindex "&$config_file$&"
11490The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11491
11492.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11493.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11494This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11495the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11496details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11497
11498.vitem &$demime_reason$&
11499.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11500This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11501content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11502see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11503
11504.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11505 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11506 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11507 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11508 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11509 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11510 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11511 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11512 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11513 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11514 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11515 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11516 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11517 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11518 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11519 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11520 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11521 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11522 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11523 &$dkim_key_length$&
11524These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11525For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11526
11527.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11528.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11529When a message has been received this variable contains
11530a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11531For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11532
11533.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11534 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11535 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11536 &$dnslist_value$&
11537.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11538.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11539.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11540.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11541.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11542When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11543the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11544looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11545main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11546
11547.vitem &$domain$&
11548.vindex "&$domain$&"
11549When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11550contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11551case for &$domain$&.
11552
11553Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11554&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11555is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11556message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11557
11558When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11559RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11560have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11561at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11562the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11563which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11564
11565.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11566At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11567set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11568
11569The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11570
11571.ilist
11572When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11573the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11574&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11575normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11576is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11577&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11578the &(smtp)& transport.
11579
11580.next
11581When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11582&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11583it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11584rewrite domains by file lookup.
11585
11586.next
11587With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11588&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11589a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11590is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11591that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11592recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11593
11594.next
11595.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11596.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11597When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11598the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11599.endlist
11600
11601
11602.vitem &$domain_data$&
11603.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11604When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11605means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11606of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11607address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11608transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11609used.
11610
11611&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11612domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11613the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11614to nothing.
11615
11616.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11617.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11618This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11619
11620.vitem &$exim_path$&
11621.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11622This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11623
11624.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11625.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11626This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11627
11628.vitem &$exim_version$&
11629.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11630This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11631The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11632Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11633There may be other characters following the minor version.
11634
11635.vitem &$found_extension$&
11636.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11637This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11638content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11639see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11640
11641.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11642This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11643inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11644be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11645characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11646
11647.vitem &$headers_added$&
11648.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11649Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11650the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11651The headers are a newline-separated list.
11652
11653.vitem &$home$&
11654.vindex "&$home$&"
11655When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11656directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11657means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11658explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11659by a setting on the transport itself.
11660
11661When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11662of the environment variable HOME.
11663
11664.vitem &$host$&
11665.vindex "&$host$&"
11666If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11667list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11668to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11669to local and remote transports.
11670
11671.cindex "transport" "filter"
11672.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11673For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11674&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11675particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11676using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11677&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11678is connected.
11679
11680When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11681&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11682client is connected.
11683
11684
11685.vitem &$host_address$&
11686.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11687This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11688for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11689when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11690
11691.vitem &$host_data$&
11692.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11693If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11694result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11695allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11696.code
11697deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11698message = $host_data
11699.endd
11700.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11701.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11702.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11703This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11704message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11705name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11706variables is set to &"1"&.
11707
11708.ilist
11709If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11710succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11711
11712.next
11713If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11714tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11715lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11716.endlist ilist
11717
11718Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11719single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11720names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11721is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11722&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11723IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11724sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11725lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11726the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11727&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11728
11729.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11730.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11731See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11732
11733.vitem &$host_port$&
11734.vindex "&$host_port$&"
11735This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11736for an outbound connection.
11737
11738
11739.vitem &$inode$&
11740.vindex "&$inode$&"
11741The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11742option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11743of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11744a unique name for the file.
11745
11746.vitem &$interface_address$&
11747.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11748This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11749
11750.vitem &$interface_port$&
11751.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11752This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11753
11754.vitem &$item$&
11755.vindex "&$item$&"
11756This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11757conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11758&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11759empty.
11760
11761.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11762.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11763This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11764contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11765lookup.
11766
11767.vitem &$load_average$&
11768.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11769This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11770is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11771variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11772
11773.vitem &$local_part$&
11774.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11775When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11776variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11777delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11778session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11779
11780Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11781&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11782&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11783because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11784once.
11785
11786.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11787.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11788If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11789value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11790any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11791&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11792
11793When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11794result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11795the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11796&$address_pipe$&).
11797
11798When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11799local part of the recipient address.
11800
11801When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11802&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11803it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11804
11805In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11806the addresses
11807.code
11808"abc:xyz"@test.example
11809abc\:xyz@test.example
11810.endd
11811the value of &$local_part$& is
11812.code
11813abc:xyz
11814.endd
11815If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11816inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11817have:
11818.code
11819data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11820.endd
11821&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11822to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11823&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11824
11825.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11826.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11827When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11828lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11829router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11830to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11831handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11832
11833&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11834matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11835available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11836variable expands to nothing.
11837
11838.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11839.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11840When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11841specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11842variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11843
11844.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11845.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11846When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11847specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11848variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11849
11850.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11851.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11852This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11853a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11854
11855.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11856.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11857See &$local_user_uid$&.
11858
11859.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11860.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11861This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11862&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11863are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11864and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11865router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11866are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11867
11868.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11869.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11870This contains the expanded value of the
11871&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11872been read.
11873
11874.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11875.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11876The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11877log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11878referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11879the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11880
11881.vitem &$log_space$&
11882.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11883The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11884partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11885whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11886ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11887the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11888
11889
11890.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11891.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11892This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11893a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11894.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11895It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11896&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11897and &"yes"& if it was.
11898Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11899the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11900as authenticated data.
11901
11902.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11903.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11904This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11905&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11906&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11907contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11908without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11909variable is empty.
11910
11911.vitem &$malware_name$&
11912.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11913This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11914content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11915when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11916
11917.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11918.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11919.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11920.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11921This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11922received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11923character(s).
11924
11925.vitem &$message_age$&
11926.cindex "message" "age of"
11927.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11928This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11929of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11930delivery attempt.
11931
11932.vitem &$message_body$&
11933.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11934.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11935.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11936.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11937.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11938This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11939being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11940number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11941&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11942
11943.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11944By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11945easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11946this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11947zeros are always converted into spaces.
11948
11949.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11950.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11951.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11952.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11953This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11954body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11955&$message_body$&.
11956
11957.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11958.cindex "body of message" "size"
11959.cindex "message body" "size"
11960.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11961When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11962in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11963separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11964also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11965
11966.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11967.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11968When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11969unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11970An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11971received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11972line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11973&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11974
11975.vitem &$message_headers$&
11976.vindex &$message_headers$&
11977This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11978is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11979lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11980same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11981
11982.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11983.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11984This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11985contents of header lines is done.
11986
11987.vitem &$message_id$&
11988This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11989
11990.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11991.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11992This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11993message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11994During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11995number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11996routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11997&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11998lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11999from the body is not counted.
12000
12001As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12002appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12003&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12004file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12005header and the body).
12006
12007Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12008.code
12009deny message = Too many lines in message header
12010 condition = \
12011 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12012.endd
12013In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12014message has not yet been received.
12015
12016.vitem &$message_size$&
12017.cindex "size" "of message"
12018.cindex "message" "size"
12019.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12020When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12021most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12022message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12023deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12024expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12025doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12026precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12027&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12028
12029.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12030While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12031contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12032value may not, of course, be truthful.
12033
12034.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12035A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12036available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12037details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12038
12039.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12040These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12041of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12042
12043.vitem &$original_domain$&
12044.vindex "&$domain$&"
12045.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12046When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12047same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12048generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12049variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12050differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12051aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12052single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12053
12054If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12055filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12056part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12057
12058.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12059.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12060.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12061When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12062same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12063local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12064part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12065filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12066the original address.
12067
12068If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12069case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12070This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12071one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12072delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12073
12074If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12075filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12076part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12077
12078.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12079.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12080.cindex "sender" "gid"
12081.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12082.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12083This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12084message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12085gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12086normally the gid of the Exim user.
12087
12088.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12089.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12090.cindex "sender" "uid"
12091.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12092.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
12093The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12094messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12095For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12096user.
12097
12098.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12099.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12100This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12101above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12102
12103.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12104.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12105This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12106(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12107
12108.vitem &$pid$&
12109.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12110.vindex "&$pid$&"
12111This variable contains the current process id.
12112
12113.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12114.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12115.cindex "transport" "filter"
12116.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12117This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12118&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12119&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12120(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12121It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12122variable"& error if encountered.
12123
12124.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12125.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12126This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12127configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12128a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12129&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12130qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12131
12132
12133.new
12134.vitem &$proxy_host_address$& &&&
12135 &$proxy_host_port$& &&&
12136 &$proxy_target_address$& &&&
12137 &$proxy_target_port$& &&&
12138 &$proxy_session$&
12139These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12140or Socks5 support
12141For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12142.wen
12143
12144.new
12145.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12146.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12147This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12148current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12149.wen
12150
12151.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12152This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12153which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12154&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12155
12156.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12157This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12158which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12159&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12160
12161.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12162This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12163which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12164&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12165
12166.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12167.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12168The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12169
12170.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12171.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12172The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12173or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12174
12175.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12176.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12177When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12178RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12179RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12180
12181.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12182.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12183.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12184When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12185RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12186temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12187
12188.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12189.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12190When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12191RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12192permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12193
12194.vitem &$received_count$&
12195.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12196This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12197including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12198is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12199delivering.
12200
12201.vitem &$received_for$&
12202.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12203If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12204variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12205built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12206the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12207
12208.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12209.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12210As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12211variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12212is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12213&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12214the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12215option.
12216
12217As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12218could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12219on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12220values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12221messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12222time.
12223For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12224
12225.vitem &$received_port$&
12226.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12227See &$received_ip_address$&.
12228
12229.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12230.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12231When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12232protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12233by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12234&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12235(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12236is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12237connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12238
12239Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12240automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12241&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12242encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12243where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12244STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12245
12246The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12247messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12248identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12249
12250.vitem &$received_time$&
12251.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12252This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12253as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12254
12255.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12256.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12257This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12258condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12259until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12260.display
12261&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12262&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12263.endd
12264&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12265method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12266The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12267expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12268
12269.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12270.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12271In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12272information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12273
12274.ilist
12275&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12276was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12277
12278.next
12279&"route"&: Routing failed.
12280
12281.next
12282&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12283or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12284MAIL).
12285
12286.next
12287&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12288.next
12289
12290&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12291.endlist
12292
12293The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12294rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12295
12296.vitem &$recipients$&
12297.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12298This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12299a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12300is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12301unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12302cases:
12303
12304.olist
12305In a system filter file.
12306.next
12307In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12308is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12309&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12310&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12311.next
12312From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12313.endlist
12314
12315
12316.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12317.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12318When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12319envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12320from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12321increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12322
12323
12324.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12325.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12326This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12327&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12328
12329.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12330.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12331When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12332these variables contain the
12333captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12334
12335
12336.vitem &$reply_address$&
12337.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12338When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12339&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12340contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12341white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12342decoding or character code translation takes place.
12343
12344.vitem &$return_path$&
12345.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12346When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12347the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12348in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12349same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12350mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12351for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12352address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12353that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12354the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12355envelope sender.
12356
12357.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12358.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12359This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12360
12361.vitem &$router_name$&
12362.cindex "router" "name"
12363.cindex "name" "of router"
12364.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12365During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12366
12367.vitem &$runrc$&
12368.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12369.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12370This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12371&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12372assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12373preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12374reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12375another.
12376
12377.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12378.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12379.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12380When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12381local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12382One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12383happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12384original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12385
12386.vitem &$sender_address$&
12387.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12388When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12389that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12390is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12391value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12392
12393.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12394.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12395.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12396If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12397sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12398distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12399after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12400longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12401
12402.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12403.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12404The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12405
12406.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12407.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12408The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12409
12410.vitem &$sender_data$&
12411.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12412This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12413in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12414value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12415this:
12416.display
12417&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12418&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12419.endd
12420&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12421method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12422The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12423expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12424
12425.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12426.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12427When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12428name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12429brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12430enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12431issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12432looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12433&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12434start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12435verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12436the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12437the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12438
12439.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12440.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12441This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12442.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12443done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12444
12445.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12446.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12447When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12448command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12449set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12450the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12451
12452.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12453.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12454When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12455this variable contains that
12456host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12457
12458.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12459.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12460This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12461driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12462received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12463&$authenticated_id$&.
12464
12465.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12466.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12467If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12468(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12469otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12470resolver library states that both
12471the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12472other times, this variable is false.
12473
12474.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12475It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12476library, by setting:
12477.code
12478dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12479.endd
12480
12481Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12482validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12483
12484If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12485mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12486
12487
12488.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12489.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12490When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12491host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12492other means, this variable is empty.
12493
12494.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12495If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12496&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12497A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12498via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12499any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12500&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12501
12502.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12503However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12504DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12505&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12506
12507Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12508host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12509in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12510is set to &"1"&.
12511
12512Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12513maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12514these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12515following are true:
12516
12517.ilist
12518A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12519.next
12520The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12521configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12522to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12523.next
12524Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12525that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12526&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12527.next
12528The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12529In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12530EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12531.next
12532The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12533domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12534. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12535. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12536.code
12537 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12538.endd
12539which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12540IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12541.endlist
12542
12543
12544.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12545.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12546When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12547number that was used on the remote host.
12548
12549.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12550.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12551When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12552identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12553been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12554called Exim.
12555
12556.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12557A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12558&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12559&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12560
12561.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12562.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12563.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12564.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12565This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12566either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12567there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12568there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12569the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12570followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12571first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12572the parentheses.
12573
12574There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12575was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12576address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12577all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12578into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12579
12580.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12581.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12582In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12583about the failure. The details are the same as for
12584&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12585
12586.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12587.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12588This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12589been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12590used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12591on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12592connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12593
12594.vitem &$sending_port$&
12595.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12596This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12597been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12598connections, see &$received_port$&.
12599
12600.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12601.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12602During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12603host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12604&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12605value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12606
12607.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12608.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12609During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12610entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12611the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12612.code
12613MAIL FROM:<>
12614MAIL FROM: <>
12615.endd
12616For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12617command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12618rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12619the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12620
12621.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12622.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12623.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12624While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12625argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12626space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12627somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12628
12629.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12630.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12631This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12632daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12633in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12634connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12635the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12636never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12637there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12638single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12639daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12640
12641.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12642These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12643that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12644filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12645example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12646message is junk mail.
12647
12648.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12649A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12650is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12651&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12652
12653
12654.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12655.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12656The name of Exim's spool directory.
12657
12658.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12659.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12660The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12661being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12662If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12663is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12664
12665.vitem &$spool_space$&
12666.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12667The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12668Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12669variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12670find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12671value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12672megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12673.code
12674condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12675.endd
12676See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12677
12678
12679.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12680.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12681This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12682command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12683command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12684interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12685
12686.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12687.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12688Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12689on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12690this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12691If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12692The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12693when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12694
12695The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12696except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12697the outbound.
12698
12699.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12700.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12701Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12702on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12703this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12704If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12705
12706.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12707.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12708.cindex certificate veriables
12709This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12710inbound connection when the message was received.
12711It is only useful as the argument of a
12712&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12713or a &%def%& condition.
12714
12715.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12716.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12717This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12718inbound connection when the message was received.
12719It is only useful as the argument of a
12720&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12721or a &%def%& condition.
12722If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12723which is not the leaf.
12724
12725.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12726.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12727This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12728outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12729&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12730or a &%def%& condition.
12731
12732.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12733.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12734This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12735outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12736&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12737or a &%def%& condition.
12738If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12739which is not the leaf.
12740
12741.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12742.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12743This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12744message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12745
12746The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12747except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12748the outbound.
12749
12750.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12751.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12752This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12753outbound SMTP connection was made,
12754and &"0"& otherwise.
12755
12756.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12757.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12758.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12759When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12760connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12761example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12762received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12763&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12764non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12765
12766The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12767but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12768becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12769
12770.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12771.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12772This variable is
12773cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12774and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12775&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12776details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12777
12778.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12779.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12780When a message is received from a remote client connection
12781the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12782.code
127830 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
127841 No response to request
127852 Response not verified
127863 Verification failed
127874 Verification succeeded
12788.endd
12789
12790.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12791.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12792When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12793the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12794See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12795
12796.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12797.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12798.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12799.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12800When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12801connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12802the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12803&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12804If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12805which is not the leaf.
12806
12807The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12808except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12809the outbound.
12810
12811.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12812.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12813When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12814connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12815the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12816&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12817If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12818which is not the leaf.
12819
12820.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12821.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12822.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12823.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12824When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12825Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12826If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12827some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12828will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12829a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12830used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12831
12832The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12833except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12834the outbound.
12835
12836.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12837.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12838.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12839During outbound
12840SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12841the transport.
12842
12843.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12844.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12845The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12846files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12847
12848.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12849.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12850The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12851
12852.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12853.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12854The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12855
12856.vitem &$tod_full$&
12857.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12858A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12859+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12860positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12861values for those that are behind (west).
12862
12863.vitem &$tod_log$&
12864.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12865The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
128661995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12867
12868.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12869.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12870This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12871is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12872flag.
12873
12874.vitem &$tod_zone$&
12875.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12876This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12877-0500.
12878
12879.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12880.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12881This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12882by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12883
12884.vitem &$transport_name$&
12885.cindex "transport" "name"
12886.cindex "name" "of transport"
12887.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12888During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12889
12890.vitem &$value$&
12891.vindex "&$value$&"
12892This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12893or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12894&*reduce*& expansion.
12895
12896.vitem &$verify_mode$&
12897.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12898While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12899or for cutthrough delivery,
12900contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12901Otherwise, empty.
12902
12903.vitem &$version_number$&
12904.vindex "&$version_number$&"
12905The version number of Exim.
12906
12907.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12908.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12909This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12910delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12911
12912.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12913.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12914This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12915delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12916.endlist
12917.ecindex IIDstrexp
12918
12919
12920
12921. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12922. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12923
12924.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12925.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12926Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12927Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12928use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12929your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12930the line
12931.code
12932EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12933.endd
12934in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12935
12936
12937.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12938.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12939Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12940&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12941no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12942interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12943the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12944option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12945a newly created Perl interpreter.
12946
12947The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12948need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12949should usually be something like
12950.code
12951perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12952.endd
12953where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12954use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12955soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12956the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12957its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12958fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12959necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12960the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12961two ways:
12962
12963.ilist
12964.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12965Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12966a startup when Exim is entered.
12967.next
12968The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12969overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12970.endlist
12971
12972There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12973initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12974
12975
12976.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12977When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12978of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12979by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12980forms:
12981.code
12982${perl{foo}}
12983${perl{foo}{argument}}
12984${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12985.endd
12986which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12987arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12988with an error message of the form
12989.code
12990Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12991.endd
12992The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12993it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12994return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12995an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12996by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12997that was passed to &%die%&.
12998
12999
13000.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13001Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13002is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13003the Perl code
13004.code
13005my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13006.endd
13007makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13008Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13009&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13010
13011If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13012&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13013expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13014an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13015
13016.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13017.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13018Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13019&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13020debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13021&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13022timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13023
13024
13025.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13026.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13027You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13028Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13029before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13030SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13031is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13032error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13033avoided, but the output is lost.
13034
13035.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13036The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13037Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13038you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13039output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13040change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13041For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13042.code
13043$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13044.endd
13045Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13046example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13047include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13048as the first subroutine argument.
13049.ecindex IIDperl
13050
13051
13052. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13053. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13054
13055.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13056 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13057 "Starting the daemon"
13058.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13059.cindex "interface" "listening"
13060.cindex "network interface"
13061.cindex "interface" "network"
13062.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13063.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13064.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13065.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13066A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13067hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13068or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13069works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13070In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13071IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13072knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13073
13074.olist
13075When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13076and ports to listen on.
13077.next
13078When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13079are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13080processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13081same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13082when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13083local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13084option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13085as an error situation.
13086.next
13087When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13088for the outgoing connection.
13089.endlist
13090
13091
13092Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13093of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13094addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13095standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13096rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13097
13098In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13099interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13100options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13101chapter describes how they operate.
13102
13103When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13104actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13105
13106
13107
13108.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13109When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13110option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13111following options:
13112
13113.ilist
13114&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13115or service names.
13116(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13117.next
13118&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13119listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13120.endlist
13121
13122The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13123described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13124it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13125colons. For example:
13126.code
13127local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13128 192.168.23.65 ; \
13129 ::1 ; \
13130 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13131.endd
13132There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13133in &%local_interfaces%&:
13134
13135.olist
13136The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13137on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13138.code
13139local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13140 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13141.endd
13142.next
13143The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13144with a colon separator, for example:
13145.code
13146local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13147 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13148.endd
13149.endlist
13150
13151When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13152default setting contains just one port:
13153.code
13154daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13155.endd
13156If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13157specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13158&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13159&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13160IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13161
13162
13163
13164.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13165The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13166as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13167case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13168instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13169default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13170.code
13171local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13172.endd
13173when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13174.code
13175local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13176.endd
13177Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13178
13179
13180
13181.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13182The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13183&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13184instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13185option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13186the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13187exim.
13188
13189The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13190changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13191contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13192&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13193items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13194replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13195.code
13196-oX 1225
13197.endd
13198overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13199whereas
13200.code
13201-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13202.endd
13203overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13204(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13205value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13206
13207
13208
13209.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13210.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13211.cindex "smtps protocol"
13212.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13213.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13214Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13215before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13216still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13217list of port numbers or service names,
13218connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13219common use of this option is expected to be
13220.code
13221tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13222.endd
13223because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13224a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13225this way when a daemon is started.
13226
13227&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13228daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13229&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13230because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13231connections via the daemon.)
13232
13233
13234
13235
13236.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13237.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13238IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13239can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13240interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13241address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13242percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13243adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13244.code
13245fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13246.endd
13247To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13248allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13249to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13250percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13251address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13252&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13253.code
13254IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13255.endd
13256is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13257Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13258instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13259function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13260&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13261
13262.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13263.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13264Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13265run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13266using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13267connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13268.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13269&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13270activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13271that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13272etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13273to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13274
13275On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13276disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13277option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13278and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13279IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13280
13281
13282
13283.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13284The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13285.code
13286daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13287local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13288.endd
13289This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13290Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13291the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13292read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13293
13294To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13295.code
13296daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13297.endd
13298(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13299.code
13300local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13301 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13302.endd
13303To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13304IPv4 loopback address only:
13305.code
13306local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13307.endd
13308To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13309.code
13310local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13311.endd
13312&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13313
13314
13315
13316.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13317The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13318whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13319addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13320treated as local.
13321
13322For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13323the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13324available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13325(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13326
13327Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13328many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13329email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13330interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13331&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13332&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13333used for listening. Consider this example:
13334.code
13335local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13336 192.168.53.235 ; \
13337 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13338
13339extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13340.endd
13341The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13342address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13343Exim is routing.
13344
13345In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13346address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13347desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13348these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13349This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13350during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13351host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13352addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13353
13354
13355
13356.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13357Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13358allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13359there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13360&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13361description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13362details.
13363
13364
13365
13366
13367. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13368. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13369
13370.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13371.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13372.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13373The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13374
13375.ilist
13376Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13377&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13378.next
13379Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13380&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13381section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13382.next
13383Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13384(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13385&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13386only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13387settings.
13388.endlist
13389
13390This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13391types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13392in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13393are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13394an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13395listed in more than one group.
13396
13397.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13398.table2
13399.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13400.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13401.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13402.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13403.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13404.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13405.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13406.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13407.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13408.endtable
13409
13410
13411.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13412.table2
13413.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13414.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13415.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13416.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13417.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13418.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13419.endtable
13420
13421
13422
13423.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13424.table2
13425.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13426.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13427.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13428.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13429.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13430.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13431.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13432.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13433.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13434.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13435.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13436.endtable
13437
13438
13439
13440.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13441.table2
13442.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13443.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13444.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13445.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13446.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13447.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13448.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13449.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13450.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13451.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13452.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13453.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13454.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13455.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13456.endtable
13457
13458
13459
13460.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13461.table2
13462.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13463.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13464.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13465.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13466.endtable
13467
13468
13469
13470.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13471.table2
13472.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13473.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13474.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13475.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13476.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13477.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13478.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13479.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13480.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13481.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13482.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13483.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13484.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13485.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13486.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13487.endtable
13488
13489
13490
13491.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13492.table2
13493.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13494.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13495.endtable
13496
13497
13498
13499.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13500.table2
13501.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13502.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13503.endtable
13504
13505
13506
13507.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13508.table2
13509.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13510.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13511.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13512.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13513.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13514.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13515.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13516.endtable
13517
13518
13519
13520.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13521.table2
13522.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13523.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13524.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13525.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13526.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13527.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13528.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13529.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13530.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13531.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13532.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13533.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13534.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13535.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13536.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13537.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13538 connection"
13539.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13540.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13541.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13542.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13543.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13544.endtable
13545
13546
13547
13548.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13549.table2
13550.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13551.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13552.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13553.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13554.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13555.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13556.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13557.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13558.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13559.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13560.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13561.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13562.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13563.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13564.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13565.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13566.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13567.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13568.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13569.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13570.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13571.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13572 words""&"
13573.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13574.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13575.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13576.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13577.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13578.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13579.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13580.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13581.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13582.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13583.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13584.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13585.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13586.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13587.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13588.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13589.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13590.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13591.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13592.endtable
13593
13594
13595
13596.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13597.table2
13598.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13599 item"
13600.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13601 item"
13602.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13603.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13604.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13605.endtable
13606
13607
13608
13609.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13610.table2
13611.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13612.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13613.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13614.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13615.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13616.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13617.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13618.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13619.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13620.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13621.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13622.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13623.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13624.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13625.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13626.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13627.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13628.endtable
13629
13630
13631
13632.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13633.table2
13634.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13635.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13636.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13637.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13638.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13639.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13640.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13641.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13642.endtable
13643
13644
13645
13646.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13647.table2
13648.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13649.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13650.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13651.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13652.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13653.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13654.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13655.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13656.endtable
13657
13658
13659
13660
13661.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13662.table2
13663.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13664.endtable
13665
13666
13667
13668
13669
13670.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13671See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13672
13673.table2
13674.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13675.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13676.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13677.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13678.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13679.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13680.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13681.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13682.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13683.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13684.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13685.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13686.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13687.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13688.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13689 connection"
13690.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13691.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13692.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13693.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13694.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13695.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13696.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13697.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13698.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13699.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13700.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13701.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13702.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13703.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13704.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13705.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13706.endtable
13707
13708
13709
13710.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13711.table2
13712.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13713.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13714.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13715.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13716.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13717.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13718.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13719.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13720.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13721.endtable
13722
13723
13724
13725.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13726.table2
13727.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13728.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13729.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13730.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13731 words""&"
13732.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13733.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13734.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13735.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13736.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13737.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13738.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13739.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13740.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13741.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13742.endtable
13743
13744
13745
13746.section "System filter" "SECID115"
13747.table2
13748.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13749.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13750 directory"
13751.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13752.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13753.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13754.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13755.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13756.endtable
13757
13758
13759
13760.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13761.table2
13762.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13763.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13764.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13765.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13766.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13767.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13768.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13769.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13770.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13771.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13772.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13773.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13774.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13775.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13776.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13777.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13778.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13779.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13780.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13781.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13782.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13783.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13784.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13785.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13786.endtable
13787
13788
13789
13790.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13791.table2
13792.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13793.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13794.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13795.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13796.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13797.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13798.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13799.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13800.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13801.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13802.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13803.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13804.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13805.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13806.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13807.endtable
13808
13809
13810
13811.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13812Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13813&dagger;.
13814
13815.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13816.cindex "8BITMIME"
13817.cindex "8-bit characters"
13818.cindex "log" "selectors"
13819.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13820This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13821EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13822However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13823takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13824
13825Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13826feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13827It now defaults to true.
13828A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13829.display
13830&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13831.endd
13832
13833To log received 8BITMIME status use
13834.code
13835log_selector = +8bitmime
13836.endd
13837
13838.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13839.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13840.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13841This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13842read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13843further details.
13844
13845.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13846This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13847messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13848SMTP messages.
13849
13850.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13851.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13852.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13853This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13854non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13855
13856.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13857.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13858.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13859This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13860received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13861
13862.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13863.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13864This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13865See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13866
13867.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13868.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13869This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13870processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13871acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13872
13873.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13874.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13875.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13876.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13877.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13878This option defines the ACL that,
13879if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13880is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13881processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13882acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13883
13884.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13885.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13886This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13887of a received message.
13888See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13889
13890.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13891.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13892This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13893received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13894
13895.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13896.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13897This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13898received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13899
13900.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13901.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13902.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13903This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13904command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13905
13906
13907.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13908.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13909This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13910received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13911
13912.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13913.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13914This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13915a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13916&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13917
13918.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13919.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13920This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13921extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13922section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13923
13924.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13925.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13926This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13927ends without a QUIT command being received.
13928See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13929
13930.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13931This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13932received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13933further details.
13934
13935.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13936.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13937This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13938received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13939
13940.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13941.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13942This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13943received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13944
13945.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13946.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13947This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13948received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13949
13950.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13951.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13952This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13953received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13954
13955.new
13956.option add_environment main "string list" empty
13957.cindex "environment" "inherited"
13958This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
13959currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
13960default list is empty,
13961.wen
13962
13963.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13964.cindex "admin user"
13965This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13966current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13967colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13968programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13969admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13970not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13971To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13972
13973.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13974.cindex "domain literal"
13975If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13976email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13977format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13978has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13979
13980Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13981format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13982addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13983&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13984domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13985configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13986the local host's IP addresses.
13987
13988
13989.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13990.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13991It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13992and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13993MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13994that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13995practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13996&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13997recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13998
13999.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14000.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14001.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14002Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14003camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14004that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14005experiment if they wish.
14006
14007If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14008UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14009letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14010enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14011adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14012suitable setting is:
14013.code
14014dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14015 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14016.endd
14017Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14018.code
14019dns_check_names_pattern =
14020.endd
14021That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14022
14023
14024.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14025.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14026.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14027If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14028response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14029Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14030Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14031advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14032authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14033&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14034authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14035
14036Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14037and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14038not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14039authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14040to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14041which Exim advertises AUTH.
14042
14043.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14044If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14045is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14046option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14047.code
14048auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14049.endd
14050.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14051If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14052the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14053expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14054
14055
14056.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14057.cindex "thawing messages"
14058.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14059If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14060new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14061this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14062being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14063saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14064
14065&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14066&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14067thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14068
14069
14070.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14071This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14072It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14073.code
14074sophie:/var/run/sophie
14075.endd
14076If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14077before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14078
14079
14080.option bi_command main string unset
14081.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14082This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14083the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14084just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14085required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14086
14087
14088.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14089.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14090.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14091This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14092for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14093chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14094
14095
14096.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14097When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14098message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14099delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14100
14101.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14102.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14103This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14104bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14105causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14106value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14107message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14108error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14109point at which the error was detected are returned.
14110.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14111
14112.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14113.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14114.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14115.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14116This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14117that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14118when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14119The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14120If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14121treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14122
14123The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14124during reception of a messsage.
14125In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14126
14127The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14128
14129
14130.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14131If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14132bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14133&%bounce_return_body%&.
14134
14135
14136.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14137.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14138.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14139.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14140This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14141senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14142limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14143any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14144that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14145
14146When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14147greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14148added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14149to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14150size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14151messages.
14152
14153.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14154.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14155.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14156.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14157This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14158bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14159connection. A typical setting might be:
14160.code
14161bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14162.endd
14163which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14164.code
14165MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14166.endd
14167The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14168address.
14169
14170.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14171.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14172.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14173This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14174domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14175section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14176
14177
14178.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14179This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14180domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14181section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14182
14183
14184.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14185This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14186address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14187section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14188
14189
14190.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14191This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14192address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14193section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14194
14195
14196.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14197This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14198callout verification. The default value is
14199.code
14200$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14201.endd
14202See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14203
14204
14205.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14206See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14207
14208
14209.option check_log_space main integer 0
14210See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14211
14212.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14213.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14214.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14215RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14216system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14217word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14218multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14219exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14220of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14221set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14222
14223
14224.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14225See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14226
14227
14228.option check_spool_space main integer 0
14229.cindex "checking disk space"
14230.cindex "disk space, checking"
14231.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14232The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14233message is accepted.
14234
14235.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14236.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14237.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14238.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14239When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14240want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14241testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14242&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14243
14244
14245&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14246either value is greater than zero, for example:
14247.code
14248check_spool_space = 10M
14249check_spool_inodes = 100
14250.endd
14251The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14252SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14253transit.
14254
14255&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14256files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14257&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14258
14259If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14260incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14261error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14262SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14263&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14264&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14265
14266The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14267number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14268
14269For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14270failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14271it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14272
14273.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14274.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14275.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14276This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14277listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14278backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14279
14280.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14281.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14282This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14283the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14284(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14285defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14286&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14287
14288.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14289See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14290
14291.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14292.cindex "warning of delay"
14293.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14294When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14295intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14296after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14297string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14298message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14299between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14300with
14301.code
14302delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14303.endd
14304the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14305the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14306because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14307just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14308.code
14309delay_warning = 6h
14310.endd
14311messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14312a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14313.code
14314delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14315.endd
14316Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14317which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14318Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14319
14320.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14321.vindex "&$domain$&"
14322The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14323deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14324expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14325forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14326&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14327not sent. The default is:
14328.code
14329delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14330 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14331 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14332 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14333 } {no}{yes}}
14334.endd
14335This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14336&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14337&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14338&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14339
14340.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14341.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14342.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14343If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14344delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14345the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14346of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14347chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14348
14349.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14350.cindex "load average"
14351.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14352When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14353becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14354ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14355See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14356
14357
14358.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14359.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14360Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14361message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14362handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14363should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14364removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14365occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14366
14367.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14368.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14369This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14370ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14371a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14372build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14373really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14374distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14375
14376When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14377updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14378such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14379Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14380
14381
14382.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14383.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14384If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14385activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14386that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14387etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14388to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14389
14390
14391.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14392.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14393This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14394It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14395the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14396See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14397
14398
14399.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14400.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14401DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14402&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14403keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14404incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14405may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14406anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14407This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14408by a setting such as this:
14409.code
14410dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14411.endd
14412This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14413&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14414since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14415&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14416when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14417options are applied after this global option.
14418
14419.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14420.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14421When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14422names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14423the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14424contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14425a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14426done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14427value of this option. The default pattern is
14428.code
14429dns_check_names_pattern = \
14430 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14431.endd
14432which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14433they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14434permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14435accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14436&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14437empty string.
14438
14439.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14440This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14441DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14442
14443.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14444This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14445reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14446section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14447
14448
14449.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14450.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14451.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14452If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14453DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14454default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14455
14456If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14457
14458
14459.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14460.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14461.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14462When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14463looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14464(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14465domain matches this list.
14466
14467This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14468not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14469servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14470
14471
14472.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14473.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14474.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14475.cindex "DNS" timeout
14476The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14477retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14478defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14479time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14480totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14481take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14482parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14483but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14484to set in them.
14485See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14486
14487
14488.option dns_retry main integer 0
14489See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14490
14491
14492.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14493.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14494.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14495If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14496(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14497DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14498match with this expanded domain list.
14499
14500Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14501authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14502bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14503mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14504Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14505a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14506
14507Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14508to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14509zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14510
14511If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14512in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14513authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14514authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14515record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14516
14517.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14518.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14519.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14520.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14521If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14522DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14523the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14524on.
14525
14526If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14527
14528
14529.option drop_cr main boolean false
14530This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14531handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14532described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14533
14534.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14535.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14536.cindex "DSN" "success"
14537.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14538DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14539and accepted from, these hosts.
14540Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14541and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14542A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14543A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14544are sent.
14545
14546.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14547.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14548.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14549This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14550bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14551Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14552.code
14553dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14554.endd
14555The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14556panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14557
14558.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14559.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14560Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14561message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14562handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14563message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14564be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14565the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14566delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14567
14568
14569.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14570.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14571.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14572Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14573generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14574coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14575items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14576a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14577must be enclosed in double quotes.
14578
14579Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14580(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14581the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14582items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14583are examined. For example:
14584.code
14585errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14586 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14587 postmaster@mydomain.example
14588.endd
14589.vindex "&$domain$&"
14590.vindex "&$local_part$&"
14591The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14592and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14593there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14594.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14595variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14596
14597
14598.option errors_reply_to main string unset
14599.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14600By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14601.display
14602&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14603.endd
14604.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14605where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14606A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14607&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14608overrides the default.
14609
14610Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14611&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14612and warning messages. For example:
14613.code
14614errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14615.endd
14616The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14617address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14618&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14619own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14620not used.
14621
14622
14623.new
14624.option event_action main string&!! unset
14625.cindex events
14626This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14627For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14628.wen
14629
14630
14631.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14632.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14633.cindex "Exim group"
14634This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14635privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14636option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14637of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14638configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14639security issues.
14640
14641
14642.option exim_path main string "see below"
14643.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14644This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14645needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14646the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14647is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14648other place.
14649&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14650you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14651where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14652settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14653
14654
14655.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14656.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14657.cindex "Exim user"
14658This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14659privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14660time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14661options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14662
14663Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14664&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14665not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14666used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14667
14668
14669.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14670This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14671routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14672&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14673
14674
14675. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14676. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14677
14678.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14679 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14680.oindex "&%-t%&"
14681.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14682.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14683According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14684are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14685envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14686line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14687behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14688command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14689&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14690argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14691addresses.
14692
14693
14694.option finduser_retries main integer 0
14695.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14696On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14697distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14698related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14699Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14700errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14701many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14702retries.
14703
14704.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14705You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14706a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14707search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14708
14709
14710
14711.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14712.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14713On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14714ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14715delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14716&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14717feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14718warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14719freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14720is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14721supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14722message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14723freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14724log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14725logging that you require.
14726
14727
14728.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14729.cindex "HP-UX"
14730.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14731Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14732password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14733looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14734headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14735of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14736it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14737upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14738
14739When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14740expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14741login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14742user's name.
14743
14744.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14745Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14746pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14747name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14748.code
14749gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14750gecos_name = $1
14751.endd
14752
14753.option gecos_pattern main string unset
14754See &%gecos_name%& above.
14755
14756
14757.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14758This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14759server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14760implementations of TLS.
14761
14762
14763option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14764This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14765the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14766
14767See
14768&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14769for documentation.
14770
14771
14772
14773.option headers_charset main string "see below"
14774This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14775&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14776default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14777ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14778insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14779
14780
14781
14782.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14783.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14784.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14785This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14786section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14787&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14788sections are rejected.
14789
14790
14791.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14792.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14793.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14794This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14795all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14796header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14797zero means &"no limit"&.
14798
14799
14800
14801
14802.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14803.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14804.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14805Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14806mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14807some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14808this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14809if you want to do semantic checking.
14810See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14811set.
14812
14813
14814.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14815.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14816.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14817.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14818This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14819all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14820hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14821.code
14822helo_allow_chars = _
14823.endd
14824Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14825
14826
14827.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14828.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14829.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14830If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14831list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14832default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14833its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14834do.
14835
14836
14837.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14838.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14839.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14840By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14841&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14842to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14843condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14844Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14845to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14846necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14847encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14848Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14849
14850When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14851&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14852EHLO command either:
14853
14854.ilist
14855is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14856.next
14857.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14858.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14859matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14860calling host address, or
14861.next
14862when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14863.endlist
14864
14865However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14866fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14867be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14868
14869If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14870.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14871&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14872
14873.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14874.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14875.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14876Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14877backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14878name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14879&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14880rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14881If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14882error.
14883
14884.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14885.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14886.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14887This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14888manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14889&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14890verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14891item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14892it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14893
14894This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14895delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14896configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14897domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14898&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14899
14900A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14901messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14902time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14903retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14904
14905
14906.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14907.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14908Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14909is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14910&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14911option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14912default configuration file contains
14913.code
14914host_lookup = *
14915.endd
14916which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14917is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14918
14919After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14920has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14921this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14922
14923.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14924.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14925After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14926unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14927&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14928&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14929
14930
14931.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14932This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14933to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14934first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14935if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14936if you want.
14937
14938&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14939multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14940&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14941case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14942
14943
14944
14945.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14946.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14947If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14948as soon as the connection is made.
14949This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14950nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14951connections immediately.
14952
14953The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14954ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14955sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14956incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14957chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14958
14959
14960.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14961.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14962This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14963happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14964you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14965127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14966the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14967list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14968local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14969.code
14970hosts_connection_nolog = :
14971.endd
14972If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14973
14974
14975
14976.new
14977.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
14978.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
14979This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
14980connections. For details see &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
14981.wen
14982
14983
14984.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14985.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14986.cindex "host" "treated as local"
14987If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14988if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14989records
14990or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14991host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14992
14993This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14994&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14995section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14996&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14997that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14998chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14999interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15000
15001
15002.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15003.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15004This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15005to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15006The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15007
15008
15009
15010.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15011.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15012.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15013This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15014that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15015suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15016
15017After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15018because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15019message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15020the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15021again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15022bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15023for frozen messages. For example,
15024.code
15025ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15026.endd
15027retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15028failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15029failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15030value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15031dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15032&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15033
15034
15035.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15036.cindex "&""From""& line"
15037.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15038Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15039the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15040message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15041such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15042match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15043process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15044&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15045
15046
15047.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15048See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15049
15050.new
15051.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15052.cindex "environment" "inherited"
15053This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15054You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15055these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15056during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15057installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15058environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15059external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15060
15061Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15062(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15063
15064WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15065FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15066unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15067that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15068
15069Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startupif you do not mention
15070&%keep_environment%& or &%add_environment%& in your runtime configuration
15071file.
15072.wen
15073
15074
15075.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15076This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15077have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15078next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15079logged.
15080
15081
15082.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15083.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15084.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15085This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15086a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15087While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15088Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15089and constrained to be a directory.
15090
15091
15092.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15093.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15094.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15095This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15096a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15097While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15098Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15099and constrained to be a file.
15100
15101
15102.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15103.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15104.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15105This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15106Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15107Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15108
15109
15110.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15111.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15112.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15113This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15114to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15115Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15116identity to be proven.
15117
15118
15119.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15120.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15121This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15122the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15123cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15124
15125
15126.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15127.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15128This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15129LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15130details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15131with LDAP support.
15132
15133
15134.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15135.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15136This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15137A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15138See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15139Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15140to hard/demand.
15141
15142
15143.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15144.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15145If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15146connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15147"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15148of SSL-on-connect.
15149In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15150by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15151
15152
15153.option ldap_version main integer unset
15154.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15155This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15156LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15157-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15158the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15159has been built with LDAP support.
15160
15161
15162
15163.option local_from_check main boolean true
15164.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15165.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15166When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15167an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15168checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15169the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15170
15171&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15172locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15173&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15174
15175You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15176on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15177&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15178and the default qualify domain.
15179
15180If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15181and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15182&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15183&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15184
15185.cindex "envelope sender"
15186These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15187is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15188&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15189
15190For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15191request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15192has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15193
15194
15195
15196
15197.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15198When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15199matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15200ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15201done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15202appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15203&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15204example, if
15205.code
15206local_from_prefix = *-
15207.endd
15208is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15209.code
15210From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15211.endd
15212will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15213matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15214qualify domain.
15215
15216
15217.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15218See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15219
15220
15221.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15222This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15223listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15224&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15225options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15226&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15227&%local_interfaces%& is
15228.code
15229local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15230.endd
15231when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15232.code
15233local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15234.endd
15235
15236.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15237.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15238.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15239This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15240&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15241the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15242message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15243non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15244
15245
15246
15247.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15248.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15249When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15250an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15251do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15252also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15253See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15254&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15255
15256
15257
15258
15259.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15260.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15261.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15262.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15263Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15264uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15265value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15266after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15267host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15268range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15269systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15270&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15271characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15272time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15273section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15274
15275
15276
15277.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15278.cindex "log" "file path for"
15279This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15280files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15281when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15282name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15283or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15284they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15285Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15286section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15287used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15288variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15289configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15290&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15291early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15292
15293
15294.option log_selector main string unset
15295.cindex "log" "selectors"
15296This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15297writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15298minus characters. For example:
15299.code
15300log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15301.endd
15302A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15303logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15304
15305
15306.option log_timezone main boolean false
15307.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15308.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15309.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15310By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15311timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15312in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15313avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15314&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15315timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15316of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15317&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15318another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15319
15320
15321.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15322.cindex "too many open files"
15323.cindex "open files, too many"
15324.cindex "file" "too many open"
15325.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15326.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15327This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15328lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15329Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15330file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15331recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15332actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15333as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15334open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15335&%lookup_open_max%&.
15336
15337
15338.option max_username_length main integer 0
15339.cindex "length of login name"
15340.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15341.cindex "limit" "user name length"
15342Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15343&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15344this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15345an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15346
15347
15348.option message_body_newlines main bool false
15349.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15350.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15351.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15352.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15353By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15354the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15355option is set true, this no longer happens.
15356
15357
15358.option message_body_visible main integer 500
15359.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15360.cindex "message body" "visible size"
15361.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15362.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15363This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15364&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15365
15366
15367.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15368.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15369If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15370(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15371locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15372means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15373Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15374Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15375replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15376empty string, the option is ignored.
15377
15378
15379.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15380If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15381the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15382message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15383take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15384the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15385it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15386yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15387before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15388that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15389means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15390colons will become hyphens.
15391
15392
15393.option message_logs main boolean true
15394.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15395.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15396If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15397&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15398Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15399minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15400per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15401which is not affected by this option.
15402
15403
15404.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15405.cindex "message" "size limit"
15406.cindex "limit" "message size"
15407.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15408This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15409value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15410to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15411TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15412optionally followed by K or M.
15413
15414&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15415other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15416the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15417error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15418&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15419
15420Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15421exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15422failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15423an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15424the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15425message that an individual transport can process.
15426
15427If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15428maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15429failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15430virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15431probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15432default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15433some problems may result.
15434
15435A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15436SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15437SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15438
15439
15440.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15441.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15442This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15443.code
15444SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15445.endd
15446in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15447moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15448and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15449standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15450lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15451
15452
15453.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15454Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15455it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15456contains a full description of this facility.
15457
15458
15459
15460.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15461.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15462This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15463be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15464option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15465
15466
15467.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15468This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15469message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15470recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15471It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15472safety precaution.
15473
15474When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15475list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15476the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15477contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15478can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15479
15480If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15481&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15482example is
15483.code
15484never_users = root:daemon:bin
15485.endd
15486Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15487harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15488transport driver.
15489
15490
15491.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use"
15492.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15493This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15494by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15495each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15496
15497This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15498available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15499The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15500the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15501list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15502&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15503names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15504
15505Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15506SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15507yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15508adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15509invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15510
15511The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15512
15513Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15514"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15515with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15516some now infamous attacks.
15517
15518Examples:
15519.code
15520# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15521openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15522 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15523
15524# Disable older protocol versions:
15525openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15526.endd
15527
15528Possible options may include:
15529.ilist
15530&`all`&
15531.next
15532&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15533.next
15534&`cipher_server_preference`&
15535.next
15536&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15537.next
15538&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15539.next
15540&`legacy_server_connect`&
15541.next
15542&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15543.next
15544&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15545.next
15546&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15547.next
15548&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15549.next
15550&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15551.next
15552&`no_compression`&
15553.next
15554&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15555.next
15556&`no_sslv2`&
15557.next
15558&`no_sslv3`&
15559.next
15560&`no_ticket`&
15561.next
15562&`no_tlsv1`&
15563.next
15564&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15565.next
15566&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15567.next
15568&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15569.next
15570&`single_dh_use`&
15571.next
15572&`single_ecdh_use`&
15573.next
15574&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15575.next
15576&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15577.next
15578&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15579.next
15580&`tls_d5_bug`&
15581.next
15582&`tls_rollback_bug`&
15583.endlist
15584
15585As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15586all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15587to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15588to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15589release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15590where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15591
15592
15593.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15594.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15595This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15596to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15597The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15598
15599
15600.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15601.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15602.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15603.cindex "address" "source-routed"
15604The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15605percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15606replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15607also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15608option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15609but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15610an ACL.
15611
15612&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15613trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15614if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15615implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15616routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15617a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15618local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15619
15620
15621.option perl_at_start main boolean false
15622This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15623interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15624
15625
15626.option perl_startup main string unset
15627This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15628interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15629
15630
15631.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15632.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15633This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15634data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15635&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15636PostgreSQL support.
15637
15638
15639.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15640.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15641.cindex "pid file, path for"
15642This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15643process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15644to the host name:
15645.code
15646pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15647.endd
15648If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15649spool directory.
15650The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15651option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15652of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15653
15654
15655.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15656.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15657This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15658PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15659control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15660&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15661for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15662that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15663not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15664
15665
15666.option prdr_enable main boolean false
15667.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15668This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15669to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15670If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15671If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15672an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15673is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15674
15675.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15676.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15677If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15678completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15679called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15680purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15681volume of mail. Use with care!
15682
15683
15684.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15685.cindex "name" "of local host"
15686.cindex "host" "name of local"
15687.cindex "local host" "name of"
15688.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15689This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15690HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15691option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15692The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15693server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15694
15695If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15696name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15697contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15698&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15699version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15700explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15701
15702
15703.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15704.cindex "printing characters"
15705.cindex "8-bit characters"
15706By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1570732&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15708when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15709sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15710is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15711characters.
15712
15713This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15714&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15715the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15716described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15717Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15718standards.
15719
15720
15721.option process_log_path main string unset
15722.cindex "process log path"
15723.cindex "log" "process log"
15724.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15725This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15726&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15727utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15728in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15729can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15730different spool directories.
15731
15732
15733.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15734.oindex "&%-M%&"
15735.oindex "&%-R%&"
15736.oindex "&%-q%&"
15737The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15738admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15739&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15740
15741
15742.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15743.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15744.cindex "address" "qualification"
15745This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15746addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15747recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15748are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15749also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15750locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15751
15752Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15753unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15754&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15755addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15756necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15757addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15758&%primary_hostname%& value.
15759
15760
15761.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15762This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15763addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15764
15765
15766
15767.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15768.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15769.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15770.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15771This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15772A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15773domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15774next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15775
15776
15777.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15778.oindex "&%-bp%&"
15779The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15780queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15781&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15782
15783
15784.option queue_only main boolean false
15785.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15786.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15787If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15788whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15789next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15790delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15791
15792The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15793and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15794&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15795&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15796
15797
15798.option queue_only_file main string unset
15799.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15800.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15801This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15802one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15803it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15804each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15805For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15806&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15807.code
15808queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15809.endd
15810causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15811&_/some/file_& exists.
15812
15813
15814.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15815.cindex "load average"
15816.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15817.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15818If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15819all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15820happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15821the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15822the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15823false.
15824
15825Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15826option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15827determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15828&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15829
15830
15831.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15832.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15833When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15834because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15835all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15836This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15837threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15838connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15839circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15840where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15841should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15842re-evaluated for each message.
15843
15844
15845.option queue_only_override main boolean true
15846.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15847When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15848setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15849&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15850to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15851
15852
15853.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15854.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15855If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15856in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15857must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15858single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15859and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15860single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15861the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15862avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15863&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15864when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15865large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15866
15867
15868
15869.option queue_run_max main integer 5
15870.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15871This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15872can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15873but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15874start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15875very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15876however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15877started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15878
15879Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15880the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15881run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15882the daemon's command line.
15883
15884.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15885.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15886.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15887When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15888received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15889However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15890&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15891message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15892has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15893when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15894over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15895SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15896&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15897&%queue_domains%&.
15898
15899
15900.option receive_timeout main time 0s
15901.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15902This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15903maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15904the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15905&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15906controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15907
15908.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15909.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15910.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15911This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15912added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15913on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15914used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15915added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15916&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15917header lines. The default setting is:
15918
15919.code
15920received_header_text = Received: \
15921 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15922 {${if def:sender_ident \
15923 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15924 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15925 by $primary_hostname \
15926 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15927 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15928 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15929 ${if def:sender_address \
15930 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15931 id $message_exim_id\
15932 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15933.endd
15934
15935The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15936support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15937locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15938header lines such as the following:
15939.code
15940Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15941by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15942(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15943id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15944for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15945Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15946id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15947.endd
15948Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15949the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15950checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15951message was accepted.
15952
15953
15954.option received_headers_max main integer 30
15955.cindex "loop" "prevention"
15956.cindex "mail loop prevention"
15957.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15958When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15959counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15960have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15961This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15962
15963
15964.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15965.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15966.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15967This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15968recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15969qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15970affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15971addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15972host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15973or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15974option was not set.
15975
15976
15977.option recipients_max main integer 0
15978.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15979.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15980If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15981original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15982by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15983all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15984Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15985done.
15986
15987.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15988&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15989RCPT commands in a single message.
15990
15991
15992.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15993If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15994recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15995error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15996error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15997initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15998for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15999
16000
16001.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16002.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16003This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16004hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16005does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16006message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16007have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16008deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16009deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16010each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16011same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16012&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16013with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16014tagged with its process id.
16015
16016This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16017message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16018manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16019deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16020is received.
16021
16022.cindex "number of deliveries"
16023.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16024If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16025need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16026are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16027daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16028fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16029runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16030delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16031then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16032&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16033
16034If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16035&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16036doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16037host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16038
16039
16040.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16041.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16042.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16043When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16044domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16045.code
16046remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16047.endd
16048would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16049then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16050
16051
16052.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16053.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16054This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16055database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16056host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16057past failures.
16058
16059
16060.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16061.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16062.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16063Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16064intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16065straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16066retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16067the default value.
16068
16069
16070.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16071.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16072RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16073&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16074The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16075MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16076in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16077&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16078received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16079the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16080
16081
16082.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16083This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16084
16085
16086.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16087.cindex "RFC 1413"
16088.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16089RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16090an item in the list.
16091The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16092for the system.
16093
16094.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16095.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16096.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16097This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16098no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16099
16100
16101.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16102.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16103.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16104This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16105sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16106&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16107not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16108it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16109&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16110using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16111
16112.option set_environment main "string list" empty
16113.cindex "environment"
16114This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16115currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16116default list is empty,
16117
16118
16119.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16120.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16121.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16122This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16123If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16124and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16125Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16126
16127
16128
16129.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16130.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16131This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16132TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16133connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16134other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16135still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16136this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16137connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16138tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16139hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16140
16141
16142
16143.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16144.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16145.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16146.cindex "inetd"
16147This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16148that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16149control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16150value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16151non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16152set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16153
16154A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16155has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16156that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16157and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16158
16159
16160.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16161.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16162.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16163Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16164the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16165check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16166client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16167client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16168
16169When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16170allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16171but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16172or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16173starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16174counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16175following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16176MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16177
16178
16179.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16180You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16181check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16182changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16183live with.
16184
16185
16186. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16187. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16188. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16189. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16190. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16191. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16192. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16193. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16194. the option name to split.
16195
16196.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16197 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16198.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16199.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16200The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16201prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16202results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16203response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16204precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16205seen).
16206
16207
16208.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16209.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16210.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16211This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16212host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16213expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16214reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16215connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16216is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16217of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16218required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16219
16220&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16221constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16222happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16223without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16224could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16225doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16226
16227
16228
16229.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16230.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16231.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16232.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16233If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16234listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16235on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16236fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16237subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16238to all messages received in the same connection.
16239
16240A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16241if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16242also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16243various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16244
16245
16246. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16247
16248.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16249 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16250.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16251.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16252This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16253automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16254the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16255and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16256number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16257are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16258restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16259systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16260dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16261
16262
16263.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16264.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16265.cindex "host" "reserved"
16266When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16267number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16268that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16269&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16270restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16271of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16272of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16273the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16274individual host.
16275
16276For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16277set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16278connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16279provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16280
16281
16282.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16283.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16284.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16285.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16286This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16287several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16288is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16289responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16290incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16291
16292.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16293The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16294is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16295in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16296
16297If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16298expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16299used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16300panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16301value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16302For example:
16303.code
16304smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16305 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16306.endd
16307
16308Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16309messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16310verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16311&%helo_data%& value.
16312
16313.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16314.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16315.cindex "banner for SMTP"
16316.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16317.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16318This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16319positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16320.code
16321smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16322 $version_number $tod_full
16323.endd
16324Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16325multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16326appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16327in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16328multiline response).
16329
16330
16331.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16332.cindex "checking disk space"
16333.cindex "disk space, checking"
16334.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16335When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16336option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16337spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16338leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16339is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16340
16341
16342.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16343.cindex "connection backlog"
16344.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16345.cindex "backlog of connections"
16346This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16347this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16348of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16349attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16350say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16351out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16352value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16353attacks by SYN flooding.
16354
16355
16356.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16357.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16358.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16359The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16360the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16361synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16362fewer, but they still exist.
16363
16364Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16365for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16366client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16367SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16368for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16369input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16370does detect many instances.
16371
16372The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16373If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16374hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16375(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16376
16377
16378
16379.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16380.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16381.vindex "&$domain$&"
16382If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16383command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16384chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16385are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16386argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16387example:
16388.code
16389smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16390 $sender_host_address
16391.endd
16392A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16393complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16394run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16395a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16396receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16397the command.
16398
16399
16400.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16401.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16402When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16403one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16404section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16405
16406
16407.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16408.cindex "load average"
16409If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16410accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16411If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16412the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16413systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16414&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16415
16416
16417
16418.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16419.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16420.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16421Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16422particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16423.code
16424RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16425.endd
16426causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16427(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16428example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16429too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16430dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16431
16432.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16433When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16434&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16435Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16436&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16437not count towards the limit.
16438
16439
16440
16441.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16442.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16443.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16444If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16445Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16446that subvert web
16447clients
16448into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16449non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16450
16451
16452
16453.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16454.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16455.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16456.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16457Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16458can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16459recipients.
16460
16461Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16462facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16463&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16464&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16465
16466When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16467&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16468rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16469respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16470values:
16471
16472.ilist
16473A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16474.next
16475An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16476fractional parts are allowed here.
16477.next
16478A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16479.next
16480A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16481because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16482.endlist
16483
16484For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16485first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16486.code
16487smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16488smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16489.endd
16490The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16491two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16492seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16493delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16494
16495
16496.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16497See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16498
16499
16500.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16501See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16502
16503
16504.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16505.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16506.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16507This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16508input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16509data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16510the message is abandoned.
16511A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16512.code
16513SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16514SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16515.endd
16516The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16517means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16518
16519If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16520expanded before use and may depend on
16521&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16522
16523
16524.oindex "&%-os%&"
16525The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16526&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16527this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16528of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16529timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16530
16531
16532.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16533This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16534&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16535
16536
16537.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16538.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16539.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16540In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16541&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16542reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16543to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16544policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16545&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16546example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16547.code
16548550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16549550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16550.endd
16551
16552
16553.new
16554.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16555.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16556When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16557the availability therof is advertised in
16558response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16559chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16560.wen
16561
16562
16563.option spamd_address main string "see below"
16564This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16565extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16566The default value is
16567.code
16568127.0.0.1 783
16569.endd
16570See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16571
16572
16573
16574.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16575.cindex "multiple spool directories"
16576.cindex "spool directory" "split"
16577.cindex "directories, multiple"
16578If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16579subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16580sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16581subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16582arrival of the message.
16583
16584Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16585where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16586directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16587directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16588are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16589
16590It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16591changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16592&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16593after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16594automatically deleted.
16595
16596When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16597changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16598trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16599sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16600sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16601spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16602particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16603if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16604entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16605
16606
16607.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16608.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16609This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16610it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16611configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16612string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16613&$primary_hostname$&.
16614
16615If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16616that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16617log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16618Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16619as failures in the configuration file.
16620
16621By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16622tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16623
16624.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16625.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16626This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16627access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16628
16629.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16630.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16631This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16632variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16633is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16634&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16635
16636.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16637.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16638If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16639items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16640treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16641passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16642option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16643
16644
16645.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16646.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16647.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16648If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16649ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16650MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16651domain causes a syntax error.
16652However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16653syntax checking.
16654
16655
16656.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16657.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16658When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16659separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16660be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16661separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16662nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16663particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16664both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16665containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16666Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16667the LOG_ALERT priority.
16668
16669
16670.option syslog_facility main string unset
16671.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16672This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16673syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16674&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16675If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16676details of Exim's logging.
16677
16678
16679
16680.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16681.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16682This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16683syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16684&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16685
16686
16687
16688.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16689.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16690If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16691omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16692details of Exim's logging.
16693
16694
16695.option system_filter main string&!! unset
16696.cindex "filter" "system filter"
16697.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16698.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16699This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16700the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16701must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16702generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16703appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16704which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16705&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16706
16707
16708.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16709.vindex "&$address_file$&"
16710This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16711&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16712implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16713During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16714
16715
16716.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16717.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16718This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16719command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16720the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16721
16722.option system_filter_group main string unset
16723.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16724This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16725gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16726with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16727
16728.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16729.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16730.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16731This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16732is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16733contains the pipe command.
16734
16735
16736.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16737.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16738This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16739is used in a system filter.
16740
16741
16742.option system_filter_user main string unset
16743.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16744If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16745delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16746process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16747Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16748is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16749configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16750specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16751&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16752
16753If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16754under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16755transport option overrides.
16756
16757
16758.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16759.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16760.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16761.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16762If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16763TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16764turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16765performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16766should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16767However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16768this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16769daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16770TCP_NODELAY.
16771
16772
16773.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16774.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16775.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16776If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16777message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16778is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16779bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16780sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16781If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16782frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16783
16784&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16785frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16786messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16787
16788
16789.option timezone main string unset
16790.cindex "timezone, setting"
16791The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16792running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16793created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16794to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16795.code
16796timezone = UTC
16797.endd
16798The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16799or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16800is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16801time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16802runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16803unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16804
16805
16806.new
16807.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16808.wen
16809.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16810.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16811.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16812When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16813of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16814response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16815chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16816.new
16817Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16818using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16819the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16820.wen
16821
16822
16823.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16824.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16825.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16826The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16827file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16828assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16829&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16830
16831&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16832receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16833use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16834option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16835
16836If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16837if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16838Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16839&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16840
16841.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16842.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16843.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16844This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16845be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16846
16847See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16848
16849
16850.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16851.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16852The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16853the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16854interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16855suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16856
16857The value must be at least 1024.
16858
16859The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16860hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16861by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16862
16863If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16864number.
16865
16866Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16867little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16868larger prime than requested.
16869
16870
16871.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16872.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16873The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16874to be used by Exim.
16875
16876If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16877parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16878PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16879OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16880fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16881loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16882and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16883
16884If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16885loaded by Exim.
16886
16887If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16888Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16889does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16890See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16891
16892If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16893a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
168942.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16895in IKE is assigned number 23.
16896
16897Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16898of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16899"ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16900"ike23".
16901
16902The available primes are:
16903&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16904&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16905&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16906
16907Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16908Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16909
16910The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16911to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16912whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16913tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16914need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16915userbase.
16916
16917Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16918is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16919applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16920used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16921mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16922prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16923acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16924
16925
16926.option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16927.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16928If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16929this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16930
16931Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16932For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16933are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16934which tell the library to choose.
16935
16936If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16937
16938
16939.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16940.cindex TLS "certificate status"
16941.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16942This option
16943must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16944status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16945Certificate Authority.
16946
16947.new
16948Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16949.wen
16950
16951
16952.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16953.cindex SSMTP
16954.cindex SMTPS
16955This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16956operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16957set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16958further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16959
16960
16961
16962.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16963.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16964The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16965file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16966the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16967key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16968&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16969
16970See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16971
16972
16973.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16974.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16975.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16976If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16977&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16978support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16979TLS session.
16980
16981
16982.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16983.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16984.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16985This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16986The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16987connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16988different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16989permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16990in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16991preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16992&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16993
16994
16995.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16996.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16997.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16998See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16999
17000
17001.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17002.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17003.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17004The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17005word "system"
17006or the absolute path to
17007a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17008match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17009
17010The "system" value for the option will use a
17011system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17012This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17013and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17014must be specified.
17015
17016The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17017preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17018
17019With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17020explicitly
17021either by file or directory
17022are added to those given by the system default location.
17023
17024These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17025than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17026the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17027connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17028Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17029use the explicit directory version.
17030
17031See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17032
17033A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17034being unset.
17035
17036
17037.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17038.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17039.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17040This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17041certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17042&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17043either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17044&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17045
17046Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17047&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17048present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17049aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17050the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17051connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17052ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17053
17054A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17055matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17056certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17057abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17058state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17059such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17060but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17061certificate"&.
17062
17063Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17064certificates.
17065
17066
17067.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17068.cindex "trusted groups"
17069.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17070This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17071option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17072which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17073specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17074details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17075&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17076are trusted.
17077
17078.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17079.cindex "trusted users"
17080.cindex "user" "trusted"
17081This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17082option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17083trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17084&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17085If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17086Exim user are trusted.
17087
17088.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17089.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17090.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17091This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17092the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17093gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17094used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17095can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17096is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17097&%-F%& option.
17098
17099.option unknown_username main string unset
17100See &%unknown_login%&.
17101
17102.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17103.cindex "trusted users"
17104.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17105.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17106.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17107.cindex "envelope sender"
17108When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17109normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17110default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17111senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17112is used) is ignored.
17113
17114However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17115to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17116.code
17117exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17118.endd
17119.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17120The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17121other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17122users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17123patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17124identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17125users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17126followed by a hyphen
17127by a setting like this:
17128.code
17129untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17130.endd
17131If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17132restriction, you can use
17133.code
17134untrusted_set_sender = *
17135.endd
17136The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17137only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17138to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17139parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17140&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17141necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17142overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17143described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17144
17145The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17146&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17147&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17148envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17149sender address.
17150
17151
17152.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17153.cindex "&""From""& line"
17154.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17155Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17156an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17157particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17158of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17159matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17160&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17161default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17162.code
17163From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17164From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17165.endd
17166The pattern can be seen by running
17167.code
17168exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17169.endd
17170It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17171year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17172regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17173&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17174(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17175&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17176
17177
17178.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17179See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17180
17181
17182.option warn_message_file main string unset
17183.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17184.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17185This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17186for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17187been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17188&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17189&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17190
17191
17192.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17193.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17194If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17195See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17196.ecindex IIDconfima
17197.ecindex IIDmaiconf
17198
17199
17200
17201
17202. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17203. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17204
17205.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17206.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17207.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17208This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17209Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17210
17211For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17212&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17213which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17214provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17215&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17216
17217
17218
17219.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17220.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17221The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17222precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17223router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17224&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17225delivery of the address to be deferred.
17226
17227.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17228When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17229accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17230routers, and the eventual transport.
17231
17232&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17233that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17234in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17235either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17236put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17237
17238Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17239with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17240on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17241&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17242&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17243
17244The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17245for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17246you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17247.code
17248uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17249.endd
17250In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17251.code
17252file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17253.endd
17254This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17255lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17256
17257.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17258.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17259The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17260from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17261&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17262ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17263verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17264
17265
17266
17267.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17268.oindex "&%-bt%&"
17269.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17270If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17271by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17272your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17273having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17274routing.
17275
17276
17277
17278.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17279.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17280.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17281This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17282routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17283&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17284&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17285value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17286includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17287well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17288you could put:
17289.code
17290cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17291.endd
17292on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17293and
17294.code
17295cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17296.endd
17297on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17298this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17299explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17300logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17301
17302
17303.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17304.cindex "case of local parts"
17305.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17306By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17307manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17308If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17309this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17310part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17311turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17312more details.
17313
17314.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17315.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17316.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17317The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17318router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17319an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17320is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17321addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17322and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17323
17324This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17325recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17326modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17327(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17328
17329
17330
17331.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17332.cindex "local user, checking in router"
17333.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17334.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17335.vindex "&$home$&"
17336When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17337address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17338local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17339than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17340holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17341user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17342preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17343given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17344overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17345the router is skipped.
17346
17347If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17348or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17349setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17350two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17351setting to achieve this. For example:
17352.code
17353local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17354.endd
17355Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17356up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17357&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17358
17359
17360
17361.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17362.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17363This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17364router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17365evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17366result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17367&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17368router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17369
17370If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17371precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17372
17373This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17374All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17375
17376The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17377running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17378the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17379.code
17380condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17381.endd
17382Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17383.code
17384condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17385.endd
17386
17387A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17388.code
17389condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17390condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17391condition = foobar
17392.endd
17393
17394If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17395of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17396be specified using &%condition%&.
17397
17398Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17399are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17400they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17401parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17402ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17403Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17404Router rules processing behavior.
17405
17406This is best illustrated in an example:
17407.code
17408# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17409# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17410
17411$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17412true {yes} {no}}
17413
17414$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17415 {yes} {no}}
17416.endd
17417In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17418&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17419default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17420(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17421string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17422with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17423resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17424&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17425
17426In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17427&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17428mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17429conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17430string characters.
17431
17432Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17433true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17434match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17435contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17436expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17437
17438
17439.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17440.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17441If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17442option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17443the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17444If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17445output, and Exim carries on processing.
17446This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17447so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17448option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17449variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17450&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17451are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17452The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17453
17454
17455
17456.option disable_logging routers boolean false
17457If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17458or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17459unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17460transport option of the same name.
17461
17462.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17463.cindex "MX record" "security"
17464.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17465.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17466.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17467DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17468the dnssec request bit set.
17469This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17470
17471.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17472.cindex "MX record" "security"
17473.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17474.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17475.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17476DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17477the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17478(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17479This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17480
17481
17482.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17483.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17484.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17485If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17486the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17487lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17488expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17489a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17490
17491
17492
17493.option driver routers string unset
17494This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17495to be used.
17496
17497
17498.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17499.cindex "DSN" "success"
17500.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17501If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17502Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17503instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17504Not effective on redirect routers.
17505
17506
17507
17508.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17509.cindex "envelope sender"
17510.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17511If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17512transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17513there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17514message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17515provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17516expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17517
17518The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17519subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17520settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17521setting.
17522
17523If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17524the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17525address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17526expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17527
17528If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17529SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17530any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17531sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17532settings:
17533.code
17534errors_to =
17535errors_to = ""
17536.endd
17537An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17538this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17539no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17540address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17541overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17542
17543.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17544If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17545MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17546path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17547setting &%return_path%&.
17548
17549The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17550manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17551implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17552
17553
17554
17555.option expn routers&!? boolean true
17556.cindex "address" "testing"
17557.cindex "testing" "addresses"
17558.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17559.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17560If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17561as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17562want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17563on for the system alias file.
17564See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17565are evaluated.
17566
17567The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17568&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17569an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17570
17571
17572
17573.option fail_verify routers boolean false
17574.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17575Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17576&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17577
17578
17579
17580.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17581If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17582verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17583
17584
17585
17586.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17587If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17588verifying a sender, verification fails.
17589
17590
17591
17592.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17593.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17594.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17595String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17596colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17597changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17598each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17599defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17600&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17601
17602If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17603associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17604list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17605randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17606transport for further details.
17607
17608
17609.option group routers string&!! "see below"
17610.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17611.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17612.cindex "transport" "local"
17613.cindex "router" "setting group"
17614When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17615specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17616process.
17617The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17618error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17619The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17620is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17621and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17622
17623
17624
17625.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17626.cindex "header lines" "adding"
17627.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17628This option specifies a list of text headers,
17629newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17630that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17631Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17632option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17633the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17634&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17635message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17636header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17637&"see"& the added header lines.
17638
17639The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17640&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17641an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17642failures are treated as configuration errors.
17643
17644Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17645for a router; all listed headers are added.
17646
17647&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17648router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17649
17650.cindex "duplicate addresses"
17651.oindex "&%unseen%&"
17652&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17653additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17654For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17655address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17656modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17657circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17658which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17659avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17660
17661
17662
17663.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17664.cindex "header lines" "removing"
17665.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17666This option specifies a list of text headers,
17667colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17668that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17669Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17670option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17671the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17672section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17673the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17674to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17675&"see"& the original header lines.
17676
17677The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17678&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17679the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17680errors.
17681
17682Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17683for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17684
17685&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17686router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17687
17688&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17689removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17690routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17691warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17692
17693&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17694items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17695To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17696
17697
17698
17699.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17700.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17701.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17702Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17703entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17704IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17705address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17706like
17707.code
17708remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17709.endd
17710by setting
17711.code
17712ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17713.endd
17714on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17715discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17716attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17717domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17718Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17719router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17720
17721You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17722means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17723.code
17724ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17725ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17726.endd
17727The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17728in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17729
17730This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17731addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17732is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17733domain that is being routed.
17734
17735.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17736During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17737checked.
17738
17739.option initgroups routers boolean false
17740.cindex "additional groups"
17741.cindex "groups" "additional"
17742.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17743.cindex "transport" "local"
17744If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17745the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17746&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17747any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17748and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17749
17750
17751
17752.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17753.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17754.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17755If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17756one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17757section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17758evaluated.
17759
17760The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17761used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17762asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17763the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17764some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17765.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17766.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17767Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17768section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17769
17770.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17771.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17772During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17773running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17774expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17775the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17776a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17777command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17778This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17779the relevant transport.
17780
17781When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17782behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17783means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17784callout.
17785
17786The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17787&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17788&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17789to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17790immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17791.code
17792real_localuser:
17793 driver = accept
17794 local_part_prefix = real-
17795 check_local_user
17796 transport = local_delivery
17797.endd
17798For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17799router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17800.code
17801 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17802 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17803.endd
17804
17805If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17806both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17807are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17808separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17809
17810
17811.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17812See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17813
17814
17815
17816.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17817.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17818.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17819This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17820local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17821&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17822mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17823character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17824parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17825&%username-foo%&.
17826
17827
17828.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17829See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17830
17831
17832
17833.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17834.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17835.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17836The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17837See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17838are evaluated, and
17839section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17840string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17841example:
17842.code
17843local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17844.endd
17845.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17846If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17847for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17848expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17849example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17850send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17851each virtual domain:
17852.code
17853postmaster:
17854 driver = redirect
17855 local_parts = postmaster
17856 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17857.endd
17858
17859
17860.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17861.cindex "log" "delivery line"
17862.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17863Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17864deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17865recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17866this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17867router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17868router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17869redirect addresses.
17870
17871
17872
17873.option more routers boolean&!! true
17874The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17875that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17876result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17877fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17878delivery to be deferred.
17879
17880If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17881further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17882.oindex "&%self%&"
17883However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17884means of the setting
17885.code
17886self = pass
17887.endd
17888or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17889does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17890case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17891
17892Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17893expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17894controls what happens next.
17895
17896
17897.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17898.cindex "timeout" "of router"
17899.cindex "router" "timeout"
17900If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17901address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17902router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17903intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17904host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17905
17906There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17907lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17908applies to all of them.
17909
17910
17911
17912.option pass_router routers string unset
17913.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17914Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17915&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17916routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17917these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17918router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17919of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17920be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17921to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17922&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17923
17924
17925
17926.option redirect_router routers string unset
17927.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17928Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17929generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17930example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17931point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17932
17933The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17934It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17935instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17936which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17937
17938
17939
17940.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17941.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17942.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17943This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17944router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17945Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17946through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17947
17948Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17949be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17950If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17951failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17952
17953If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17954below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17955&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17956existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17957preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17958
17959.cindex "NFS"
17960If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17961the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17962unavailable.
17963
17964This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17965options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17966look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17967full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17968these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17969to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17970that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17971transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17972
17973During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17974facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17975This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17976operates as follows:
17977
17978If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17979characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17980comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17981but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17982used. For example:
17983.code
17984require_files = mail:/some/file
17985require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17986.endd
17987If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17988&%require_files%& condition fails.
17989
17990Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17991checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17992directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17993access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17994
17995&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17996incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17997may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17998may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17999user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18000
18001&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18002&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18003without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18004is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18005check again in that process.
18006
18007The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18008be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18009existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18010circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18011not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18012name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18013as if the file did not exist. For example:
18014.code
18015require_files = +/some/file
18016.endd
18017If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18018handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18019option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18020
18021
18022
18023.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18024.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18025.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18026When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18027in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18028domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18029other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18030Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18031latter kind.
18032
18033This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18034hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18035router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18036set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18037for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18038same name.
18039
18040The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18041appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18042independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18043
18044
18045
18046.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18047.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18048.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18049.vindex "&$home$&"
18050This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18051&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18052transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18053sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18054forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18055cause the router to defer.
18056
18057Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18058&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18059place.
18060(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18061are evaluated.)
18062While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18063&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18064
18065When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18066the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18067delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18068of these values that is set:
18069
18070.ilist
18071The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18072.next
18073The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18074.next
18075The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18076.next
18077The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18078.endlist
18079
18080In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18081router, but not for the transport.
18082
18083
18084
18085.option self routers string freeze
18086.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18087.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18088This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18089list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18090and &(manualroute)& routers.
18091Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18092of remote hosts.
18093Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18094&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18095host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18096The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18097&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18098
18099Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18100example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18101error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18102reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18103freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18104cases:
18105
18106.vlist
18107.vitem &%defer%&
18108Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18109
18110.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18111The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18112be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18113behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18114
18115.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18116The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18117reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18118rewritten.
18119
18120.vitem &%pass%&
18121.oindex "&%more%&"
18122.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18123The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18124&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18125subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18126name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18127distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18128combination
18129.code
18130self = pass
18131no_more
18132.endd
18133ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18134Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18135be passed to the next router.
18136
18137.vitem &%fail%&
18138Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18139
18140.vitem &%send%&
18141.cindex "local host" "sending to"
18142The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18143setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18144makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18145is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18146different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18147.endlist
18148
18149
18150
18151.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18152.cindex "router" "checking senders"
18153If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18154address matches something on the list.
18155See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18156are evaluated.
18157
18158There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18159dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18160setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18161to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18162set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18163verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18164SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18165matters.
18166
18167
18168.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18169.cindex "IP address" "translating"
18170.cindex "packet radio"
18171.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18172There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18173it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18174mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18175routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18176is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18177code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18178SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18179
18180.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18181The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18182by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18183expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18184For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18185If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18186address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18187up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18188produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18189addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18190.code
18191translate_ip_address = \
18192 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18193 {$value}fail}}
18194.endd
18195The file would contain lines like
18196.code
1819710.2.3.128/26 some.host
1819810.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18199.endd
18200You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18201are doing.
18202
18203
18204
18205.option transport routers string&!! unset
18206This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18207and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18208only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18209after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18210and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18211delivery is deferred.
18212
18213The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18214have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18215(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18216
18217
18218
18219.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18220.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18221This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18222to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18223explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18224file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18225option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18226overridden by a setting on the transport.
18227If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18228logged, and delivery is deferred.
18229See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18230environment.
18231
18232
18233
18234
18235.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18236.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18237This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18238local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18239configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18240pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18241string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18242setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18243If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18244logged, and delivery is deferred.
18245
18246If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18247&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18248the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18249the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18250is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18251
18252See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18253environment.
18254
18255
18256
18257
18258.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18259.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18260The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18261that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18262result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18263fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18264delivery to be deferred.
18265
18266When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18267address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18268overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18269&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18270the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18271sometimes true and sometimes false).
18272
18273.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18274Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18275qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18276delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18277In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18278&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18279to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18280&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18281
18282&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18283this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18284only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18285no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18286a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18287duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18288duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18289&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18290so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18291&%redirect%& router may be of help.
18292
18293Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18294&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18295subsequent routers.
18296
18297
18298.option user routers string&!! "see below"
18299.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18300.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18301.cindex "transport" "local"
18302.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18303.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18304When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18305specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18306The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18307error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18308This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18309The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18310the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18311a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18312See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18313&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18314
18315
18316
18317.option verify routers&!? boolean true
18318Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18319&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18320
18321
18322.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18323.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18324.oindex "&%-bv%&"
18325.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18326If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18327delivering in cutthrough mode or
18328testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18329with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18330restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18331&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18332
18333&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18334SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18335accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18336user or group.
18337
18338
18339.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18340If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18341addresses,
18342delivering in cutthrough mode
18343or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18344See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18345are evaluated.
18346See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18347
18348
18349.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18350If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18351or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18352See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18353are evaluated.
18354See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18355.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18356.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18357
18358
18359
18360
18361
18362
18363. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18364. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18365
18366.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18367.cindex "&(accept)& router"
18368.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18369The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18370used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18371be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18372specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18373it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18374up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18375.code
18376localusers:
18377 driver = accept
18378 domains = mydomain.example
18379 check_local_user
18380 transport = local_delivery
18381.endd
18382The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18383&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18384When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18385address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18386
18387
18388
18389
18390
18391
18392. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18393. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18394
18395.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18396.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18397.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18398The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18399recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18400unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18401
18402If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18403SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18404MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18405However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18406records.
18407
18408MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18409looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18410When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18411except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18412IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18413generic option, the router declines.
18414
18415Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18416to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18417are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18418
18419.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18420.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18421.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18422If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18423address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18424happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18425
18426
18427.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18428There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18429Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18430SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18431MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18432problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18433
18434For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18435&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18436&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18437an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18438domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18439such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18440proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18441look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18442case routing fails.
18443
18444
18445.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18446.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18447There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18448an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18449domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18450
18451The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18452is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18453
18454Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18455.ilist
18456The domain does not exist in DNS
18457.next
18458The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18459convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18460for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18461.next
18462Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18463.next
18464MX record points to a non-existent host.
18465.next
18466MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18467&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18468.next
18469MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18470addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18471.next
18472The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18473&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18474.next
18475&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18476not be found in the MX records (see below)
18477.endlist
18478
18479
18480
18481
18482.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18483.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18484The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18485
18486.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18487.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18488If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18489(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18490process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18491differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18492the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18493
18494
18495.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18496.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18497The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18498addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18499enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18500required. For example,
18501.code
18502check_srv = smtp
18503.endd
18504looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18505expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18506to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18507submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18508option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18509normal way.
18510
18511When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18512the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18513host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18514this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18515SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18516according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18517
18518When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18519the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18520records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18521this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18522defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18523and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18524have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18525trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18526
18527See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18528when there is a DNS lookup error.
18529
18530
18531
18532
18533.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18534.cindex "MX record" "not found"
18535DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18536which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18537rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18538This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18539domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18540However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18541also being queued.
18542
18543
18544.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18545.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18546.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18547A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18548record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18549For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18550records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18551setting:
18552.code
18553mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18554.endd
18555This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18556has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18557the address record.
18558
18559
18560.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18561If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18562DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18563&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18564
18565
18566
18567
18568.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18569.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18570.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18571When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18572lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18573single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18574called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18575&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18576resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18577&'resolv.conf'&.
18578
18579
18580
18581.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18582.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18583.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18584If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18585qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18586an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18587expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18588occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18589&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18590any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18591header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18592
18593This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18594ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18595sense.
18596
18597When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18598servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18599making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18600some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18601name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18602header rewriting.
18603
18604
18605.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18606.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18607Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18608to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18609options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18610default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18611servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18612any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18613
18614If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18615domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18616local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18617lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18618routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18619message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18620without processing them independently,
18621provided the following conditions are met:
18622
18623.ilist
18624No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18625&%headers_remove%&.
18626.next
18627The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18628the domain.
18629.endlist
18630
18631
18632
18633
18634.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18635.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18636When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18637lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18638applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18639the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18640domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18641up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18642&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18643actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18644
18645Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18646record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18647local wildcard.
18648
18649
18650
18651.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18652If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18653DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18654&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18655
18656
18657
18658
18659.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18660.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18661If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18662added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18663if
18664.code
18665widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18666.endd
18667is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18668&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18669&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18670and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18671the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18672when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18673
18674
18675.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18676When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18677of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18678corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18679is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18680
18681These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18682for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18683such as that implied by
18684.code
18685domains = @mx_any
18686.endd
18687that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18688entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18689.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18690.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18691
18692
18693
18694
18695
18696
18697
18698
18699
18700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18701. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18702
18703.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18704.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18705.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18706.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18707This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18708verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18709generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18710takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18711router handles the address
18712.code
18713root@[192.168.1.1]
18714.endd
18715by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18716consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18717are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18718.code
18719postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18720.endd
18721Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18722grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18723
18724.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18725If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18726declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18727&%self%& option determines what happens.
18728
18729The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18730controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18731also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18732Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18733
18734
18735
18736. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18737. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18738
18739.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18740.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18741.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18742The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18743Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18744not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18745must set
18746.code
18747ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18748.endd
18749in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18750
18751The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18752connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18753a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18754message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18755this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18756can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18757must not be specified for it.
18758
18759.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18760.option hosts iplookup string unset
18761This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18762names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18763(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18764and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18765happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18766
18767
18768.option optional iplookup boolean false
18769If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18770is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18771delivery to the address is deferred.
18772
18773
18774.option port iplookup integer 0
18775.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18776This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18777call.
18778
18779
18780.option protocol iplookup string udp
18781This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18782protocols is to be used.
18783
18784
18785.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18786This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18787default value is:
18788.code
18789$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18790.endd
18791The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18792query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18793
18794
18795.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18796If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18797returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18798string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18799in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18800&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18801whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18802up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18803
18804
18805.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18806This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18807returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18808router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18809response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18810check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18811address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18812the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18813following could be used:
18814.code
18815response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18816reroute = $local_part@$1
18817.endd
18818
18819.option timeout iplookup time 5s
18820This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18821machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18822call. It does not apply to UDP.
18823
18824
18825
18826
18827. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18828. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18829
18830.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18831.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18832.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18833.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18834The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18835routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18836route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18837normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18838route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18839messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18840
18841The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18842it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18843has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18844include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18845&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18846generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18847being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18848
18849.vindex "&$host$&"
18850In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18851router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18852an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18853transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18854with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18855passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18856host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18857text string.
18858
18859The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18860&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18861or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18862any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18863below, following the list of private options.
18864
18865
18866.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18867
18868.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18869The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18870
18871.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18872See &%host_find_failed%&.
18873
18874.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18875This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18876address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18877of the following values:
18878.code
18879decline
18880defer
18881fail
18882freeze
18883ignore
18884pass
18885.endd
18886The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18887error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18888forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18889&%pass_router%&),
18890.oindex "&%more%&"
18891overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18892router only if &%more%& is true.
18893
18894The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18895cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18896controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18897as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18898
18899The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18900state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18901generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18902
18903
18904.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18905.cindex "randomized host list"
18906.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18907If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18908is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18909overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18910crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18911same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18912(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18913deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18914
18915When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18916into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18917set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18918item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18919.code
18920route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18921.endd
18922The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18923randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18924If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18925randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18926&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18927
18928
18929.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18930If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18931Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18932example:
18933.code
18934route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18935.endd
18936If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18937router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18938deferred.
18939
18940
18941.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18942This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18943unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18944that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18945
18946
18947.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18948.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18949Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18950router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18951router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18952default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18953servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18954any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18955
18956If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18957domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18958local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18959lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18960&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18961addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18962same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18963if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18964
18965
18966
18967
18968.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18969The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18970rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18971entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18972described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18973Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18974.display
18975<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18976.endd
18977The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18978no options:
18979.code
18980route_list = \
18981 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18982 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18983.endd
18984The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18985list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18986usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18987single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18988pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18989&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18990except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18991That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18992lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18993in a &%route_list%&).
18994
18995The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18996matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18997then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18998&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18999
19000
19001
19002.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19003The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19004routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19005hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19006The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19007Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19008expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19009like this:
19010.code
19011dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19012thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19013.endd
19014This data can be accessed by setting
19015.code
19016route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19017.endd
19018Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19019decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19020requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19021possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19022be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19023
19024
19025
19026
19027.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19028A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19029always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19030declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19031and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19032in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19033as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19034
19035If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19036variables are set during its expansion:
19037
19038.ilist
19039.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19040If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19041&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19042.code
19043route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19044.endd
19045.next
19046&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19047.next
19048&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19049
19050.next
19051.vindex "&$value$&"
19052If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19053looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19054.code
19055route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19056.endd
19057.endlist
19058
19059Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19060semicolon is the default route list separator.
19061
19062
19063
19064.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19065Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19066optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19067is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19068specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19069by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19070
19071.ilist
19072Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19073the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19074be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19075.code
19076route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19077route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19078.endd
19079.next
19080When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19081colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19082enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19083number follows. For example:
19084.code
19085route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19086.endd
19087.endlist
19088
19089.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19090When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19091the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19092delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19093option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19094transport.
19095
19096Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19097hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19098interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19099records in the DNS. For example:
19100.code
19101route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19102.endd
19103If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19104example:
19105.code
19106route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19107.endd
19108If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19109randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19110that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19111be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19112Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19113happens is controlled by the
19114.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19115&%self%& option of the router.
19116
19117A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19118hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19119lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19120below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19121preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19122randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19123defined by MX preferences.
19124
19125If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19126not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19127preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19128
19129If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19130depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19131is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19132Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19133
19134If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19135most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19136router.
19137
19138DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19139failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19140&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19141
19142The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19143whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19144
19145
19146
19147.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19148The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19149present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19150&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19151other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19152per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19153routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19154
19155.ilist
19156&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19157setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19158.next
19159&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19160overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19161.next
19162&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19163find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19164also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19165.next
19166&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19167no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19168timeout), delivery is deferred.
19169.endlist
19170
19171For example:
19172.code
19173route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19174 domain2 host4:host5
19175.endd
19176If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19177DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19178result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19179or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19180call.
19181
19182&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19183called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19184instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19185lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19186function called.
19187
19188
19189
19190If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19191&%host_find_failed%& option.
19192
19193.vindex "&$host$&"
19194When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19195The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19196
19197
19198
19199.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19200In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19201transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19202
19203.ilist
19204.cindex "smart host" "example router"
19205The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19206&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19207named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19208.code
19209domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19210.endd
19211You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19212your first router something like this:
19213.code
19214smart_route:
19215 driver = manualroute
19216 domains = !+local_domains
19217 transport = remote_smtp
19218 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19219.endd
19220This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19221&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19222they are tried in order
19223(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19224Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19225.code
19226smart_route:
19227 driver = manualroute
19228 transport = remote_smtp
19229 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19230.endd
19231There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19232However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19233example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19234precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19235always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19236would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19237always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19238&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19239
19240.next
19241.cindex "mail hub example"
19242A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19243records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19244the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19245machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19246&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19247to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19248using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19249lookup is easier to manage.
19250
19251If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19252to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19253example:
19254.code
19255hub_route:
19256 driver = manualroute
19257 transport = remote_smtp
19258 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19259.endd
19260This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19261whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19262if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19263that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19264domain can be used to find the host:
19265.code
19266through_firewall:
19267 driver = manualroute
19268 transport = remote_smtp
19269 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19270.endd
19271The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19272hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19273data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19274next router.
19275
19276.next
19277.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19278.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19279You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19280SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19281storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19282can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19283.code
19284save_in_file:
19285 driver = manualroute
19286 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19287 route_list = saved.domain.example
19288.endd
19289though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19290several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19291different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19292.code
19293save_in_file:
19294 driver = manualroute
19295 route_list = \
19296 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19297 *.saved.domain2.example \
19298 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19299 batch_pipe
19300.endd
19301.vindex "&$domain$&"
19302.vindex "&$host$&"
19303The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19304doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19305file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19306the address if the lookup fails.
19307
19308.next
19309.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19310Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19311&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19312one way it can be done:
19313.code
19314# Transport
19315uucp:
19316 driver = pipe
19317 user = nobody
19318 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19319 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19320 return_fail_output = true
19321
19322# Router
19323uucphost:
19324 transport = uucp
19325 driver = manualroute
19326 route_data = \
19327 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19328.endd
19329The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19330.code
19331darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19332.endd
19333It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19334makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19335&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19336.endlist
19337.ecindex IIDmanrou1
19338.ecindex IIDmanrou2
19339
19340
19341
19342
19343
19344
19345
19346
19347. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19348. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19349
19350.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19351.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19352.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19353.cindex "routing" "by external program"
19354The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19355and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19356mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19357However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19358&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19359be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19360options:
19361.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19362
19363.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19364This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19365command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19366expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19367&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19368
19369
19370.option command_group queryprogram string unset
19371.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19372This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19373address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19374uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19375gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19376
19377
19378.option command_user queryprogram string unset
19379.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19380This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19381command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19382it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19383using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19384not set, a value for the gid also.
19385
19386&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19387root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19388However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19389usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19390is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19391the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19392gid.
19393
19394
19395.option current_directory queryprogram string /
19396This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19397before running the command.
19398
19399
19400.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19401If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19402is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19403timeout.
19404
19405
19406The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19407the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19408containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19409the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19410field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19411
19412.ilist
19413&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19414below).
19415.next
19416&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19417&%no_more%& is set.
19418.next
19419&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19420subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19421of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19422included in the SMTP response.
19423.next
19424&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19425subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19426included in any SMTP response.
19427.next
19428&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19429.next
19430&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19431&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19432.next
19433&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19434new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19435or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19436.endlist
19437
19438When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19439number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19440the page):
19441.code
19442ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19443LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19444.endd
19445The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19446is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19447used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19448an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19449
19450The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19451As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19452in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19453&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19454(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19455
19456If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19457find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19458anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19459goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19460result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19461
19462.vindex "&$address_data$&"
19463If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19464variable. For example, this return line
19465.code
19466accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19467.endd
19468routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19469the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19470.ecindex IIDquerou1
19471.ecindex IIDquerou2
19472
19473
19474
19475
19476. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19477. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19478
19479.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19480.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19481.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19482.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19483.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19484The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19485common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19486(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19487files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19488redirected in several different ways:
19489
19490.ilist
19491It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19492independently.
19493.next
19494It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19495.next
19496It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19497.next
19498It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19499.next
19500It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19501.next
19502It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19503.next
19504It can be discarded.
19505.endlist
19506
19507The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19508However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19509files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19510&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19511
19512If success DSNs have been requested
19513.cindex "DSN" "success"
19514.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19515redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19516
19517
19518
19519.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19520The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19521expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19522contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19523options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19524aliases, in a configuration like this:
19525.code
19526system_aliases:
19527 driver = redirect
19528 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19529.endd
19530If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19531expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19532expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19533cause delivery to be deferred.
19534
19535A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19536&_.forward_& files, like this:
19537.code
19538userforward:
19539 driver = redirect
19540 check_local_user
19541 file = $home/.forward
19542 no_verify
19543.endd
19544If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19545empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19546is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19547yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19548comments.
19549
19550
19551
19552.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19553.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19554It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19555&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19556
19557.ilist
19558When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19559running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19560the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19561practice the router may not be able to operate.
19562.next
19563However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19564is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19565local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19566saves some resources.
19567.endlist
19568
19569
19570
19571
19572
19573
19574.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19575.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19576.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19577The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19578can be interpreted in two different ways:
19579
19580.ilist
19581If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19582&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19583&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19584respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19585in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19586document is intended for use by end users.
19587.next
19588Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19589described in the next section.
19590.endlist
19591
19592When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19593in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19594generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19595configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19596for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19597
19598
19599
19600.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19601.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19602When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19603comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19604addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19605&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19606disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19607depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19608commas or newlines.
19609If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19610quotes.
19611
19612Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19613also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19614next newline character is ignored.
19615
19616If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19617double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19618(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19619&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19620removed.
19621
19622.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19623&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19624and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19625of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19626special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19627&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19628setting:
19629.code
19630data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19631.endd
19632
19633
19634.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19635.cindex "routing" "loops in"
19636.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19637.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19638A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19639consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19640automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19641is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19642Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19643as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19644complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19645
19646.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19647Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19648filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19649mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19650&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19651.code
19652cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19653.endd
19654.cindex "backslash in alias file"
19655.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19656For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19657preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19658it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19659synonymously.
19660
19661If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
196622822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19663domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19664addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19665force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19666
19667Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19668Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19669contains:
19670.code
19671Sam.Reman: spqr
19672.endd
19673Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19674messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19675this forward file:
19676.code
19677Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19678.endd
19679With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19680&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19681second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19682and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19683should really contain
19684.code
19685spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19686.endd
19687but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19688below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19689&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19690
19691
19692
19693.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19694In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19695lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19696
19697.ilist
19698.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19699.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19700An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19701as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19702command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19703Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19704which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19705
19706Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19707the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19708the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19709in double quotes, for example:
19710.code
19711"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19712.endd
19713since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19714quote just the command. An item such as
19715.code
19716|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19717.endd
19718is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19719
19720Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19721of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19722redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19723quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19724string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19725are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19726data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19727transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19728an &%accept%& router.
19729
19730.next
19731.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19732.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19733An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19734parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19735.code
19736/home/world/minbari
19737.endd
19738is treated as a file name, but
19739.code
19740/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19741.endd
19742is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19743the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19744forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19745file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19746
19747Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19748which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19749
19750.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19751However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19752bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19753instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19754
19755.next
19756.cindex "included address list"
19757.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19758If an item is of the form
19759.code
19760:include:<path name>
19761.endd
19762a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19763point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19764out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19765by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19766item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19767the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19768.code
19769list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19770.endd
19771It must be given as
19772.code
19773list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19774.endd
19775.next
19776.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19777Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19778&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19779the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19780.cindex "black hole"
19781.cindex "abandoning mail"
19782&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19783done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19784&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19785
19786&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19787delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19788are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19789database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19790&_/dev/null_&.
19791
19792.next
19793.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19794.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19795.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19796.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19797.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19798An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19799redirection items of the form
19800.code
19801:defer:
19802:fail:
19803.endd
19804respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19805to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19806text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19807associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19808.code
19809X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19810.endd
19811In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19812of a
19813.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19814VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19815default.
19816.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19817The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19818the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19819
19820.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19821By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19822&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19823space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19824followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19825code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19826incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19827suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19828&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19829ignored.
19830
19831.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19832In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19833default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19834therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19835
19836Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19837not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19838normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19839as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19840lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19841
19842During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19843containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19844whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19845subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19846deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19847rules still apply.
19848
19849.next
19850.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19851Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19852chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19853for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19854&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19855router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19856results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19857.endlist
19858
19859
19860.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19861.cindex "duplicate addresses"
19862.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19863.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19864Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19865to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19866routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19867aliasing scheme of the type
19868.code
19869pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19870localpart1: pipe
19871localpart2: pipe
19872.endd
19873does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19874when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19875discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19876such as
19877.code
19878localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19879localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19880.endd
19881does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19882the pipes are distinct.
19883
19884
19885
19886.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19887.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19888.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19889When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19890leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19891afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19892delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19893members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19894can be used to avoid this.
19895
19896
19897.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19898.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19899If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19900error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19901for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19902detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19903deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19904
19905
19906
19907.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19908
19909.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19910The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19911
19912
19913.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19914Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19915data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19916
19917
19918.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19919.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19920If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19921and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19922
19923
19924.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19925.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19926.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19927Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19928&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19929are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19930lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19931
19932It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19933the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19934
19935
19936The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19937&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19938&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19939files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19940true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19941
19942
19943
19944.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19945.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19946Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19947This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19948default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19949let ordinary users do.
19950
19951
19952
19953.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19954This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19955as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19956Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19957configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19958for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19959
19960When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19961is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19962the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19963and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19964domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19965&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19966.code
19967\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19968.endd
19969Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19970&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19971originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19972(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19973&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19974&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19975file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19976original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19977
19978
19979.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19980When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19981when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19982&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19983&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19984deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19985is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19986&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19987
19988
19989
19990.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19991When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19992this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19993permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19994option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19995&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19996
19997
19998.option data redirect string&!! unset
19999This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20000set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20001list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20002expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20003has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20004
20005When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20006filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20007terminated with newline characters. For example:
20008.code
20009data = #Exim filter\n\
20010 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20011.endd
20012If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20013you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20014choice into a newline.
20015
20016
20017.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20018A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20019ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20020specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20021configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20022
20023
20024.option file redirect string&!! unset
20025This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20026is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20027use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20028failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20029must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20030data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20031entirely of comments), the router declines.
20032
20033.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20034If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20035runs a check on the containing directory,
20036unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20037If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20038happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20039is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20040not, the router declines.
20041
20042
20043.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20044.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20045A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20046ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20047specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20048configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20049it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20050
20051
20052.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20053When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20054relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20055relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20056relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20057
20058
20059.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20060If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20061redirection list.
20062
20063
20064.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20065If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20066&%allow_filter%& is true.
20067
20068
20069
20070
20071.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20072.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20073.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20074.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20075If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20076specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20077conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20078set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20079locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20080
20081
20082.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20083.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20084If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20085make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20086functions.
20087
20088.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20089.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20090If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20091make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20092
20093.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20094If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20095permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20096under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20097&_.forward_& files).
20098
20099
20100.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20101If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20102to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20103
20104
20105.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20106This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20107it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20108of the embedded Perl support.
20109
20110
20111.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20112If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20113to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20114
20115
20116.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20117If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20118to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20119
20120
20121.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20122If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20123message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20124files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20125&%one_time%& is set.
20126
20127
20128.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20129If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20130to make use of &%run%& items.
20131
20132
20133.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20134If this option is true, items of the form
20135.code
20136:include:<path name>
20137.endd
20138are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20139
20140
20141.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20142.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20143If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20144specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20145forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20146
20147
20148.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20149If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20150&%allow_filter%& is true.
20151
20152
20153.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20154.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20155If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20156of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20157the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20158
20159
20160
20161
20162.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20163.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20164If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20165generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20166generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20167bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20168bounce may well quote the generated address.
20169
20170
20171.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20172.cindex "EACCES"
20173If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20174EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20175file did not exist.
20176
20177
20178.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20179.cindex "ENOTDIR"
20180If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20181ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20182router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20183
20184Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20185router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20186(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20187against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20188is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20189is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20190a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20191that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20192
20193
20194
20195.option include_directory redirect string unset
20196If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20197redirection list must start with this directory.
20198
20199
20200.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20201This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20202&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20203
20204
20205.option one_time redirect boolean false
20206.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20207.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20208.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20209.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20210.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20211Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20212files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20213of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20214is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20215but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20216message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20217lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20218before they subscribed.
20219
20220If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20221deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20222&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20223&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20224attempt.
20225
20226&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20227router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20228reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20229permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20230
20231&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20232to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20233and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20234
20235&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20236&%one_time%&.
20237
20238The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20239addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20240addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20241&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20242typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20243expansion.
20244
20245
20246.option owners redirect "string list" unset
20247.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20248.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20249.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20250.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20251This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20252This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20253See &%check_owner%& above.
20254
20255
20256.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20257This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20258The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20259&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20260
20261
20262.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20263.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20264A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20265starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20266transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20267name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20268When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20269
20270
20271.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20272.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20273If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20274generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20275in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20276expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20277to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20278&$qualify_recipient$&.
20279
20280This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20281but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20282not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20283addresses.
20284
20285.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20286.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20287.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20288.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20289If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20290set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20291without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20292address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20293&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20294this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20295
20296
20297.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20298If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20299any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20300the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20301only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20302&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20303
20304
20305.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20306A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20307&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20308by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20309transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20310are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20311
20312
20313.option rewrite redirect boolean true
20314.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20315If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20316subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20317and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20318
20319
20320.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20321The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20322:subaddress part of an address.
20323
20324.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20325The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20326of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20327(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20328
20329
20330.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20331.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20332To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20333&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20334(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20335&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20336needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20337
20338
20339
20340.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20341.cindex "forward file" "broken"
20342.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20343.cindex "alias file" "broken"
20344.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20345.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20346.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20347.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20348If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20349non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20350&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20351giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20352are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20353&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20354be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20355&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20356
20357If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20358errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20359the following routers.
20360
20361If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20362error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20363taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20364so it is passed to the following routers.
20365
20366.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20367Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20368action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20369&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20370
20371&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20372lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20373option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20374notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20375.code
20376userforward:
20377 driver = redirect
20378 allow_filter
20379 check_local_user
20380 file = $home/.forward
20381 file_transport = address_file
20382 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20383 reply_transport = address_reply
20384 no_verify
20385 skip_syntax_errors
20386 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20387 syntax_errors_text = \
20388 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20389 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20390 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20391 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20392 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20393 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20394 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20395 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20396 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20397 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20398.endd
20399You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20400&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20401put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20402.code
20403real_localuser:
20404 driver = accept
20405 check_local_user
20406 local_part_prefix = real-
20407 transport = local_delivery
20408.endd
20409For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20410router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20411.code
20412 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20413 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20414.endd
20415
20416
20417.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20418See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20419
20420
20421.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20422See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20423.ecindex IIDredrou1
20424.ecindex IIDredrou2
20425
20426
20427
20428
20429
20430
20431. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20432. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20433
20434.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20435 "Environment for local transports"
20436.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20437.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20438.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20439Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20440transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20441in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20442mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20443
20444Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20445some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20446transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20447&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20448
20449The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20450different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20451settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20452or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20453configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20454
20455
20456
20457.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20458.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20459.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20460If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20461simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20462the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20463rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20464time.
20465
20466However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20467locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20468.code
20469my_transport:
20470 driver = pipe
20471 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20472.endd
20473This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20474messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20475&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20476file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20477
20478
20479
20480
20481.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20482.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20483.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20484All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20485overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20486set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20487delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20488group (set by the transport). For example:
20489.code
20490# Routers ...
20491# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20492local_users:
20493 driver = accept
20494 check_local_user
20495 transport = group_delivery
20496
20497# Transports ...
20498# This transport overrides the group
20499group_delivery:
20500 driver = appendfile
20501 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20502 group = mail
20503.endd
20504If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20505address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20506gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20507set.
20508
20509.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20510When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20511function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20512&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20513by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20514for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20515
20516.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20517The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20518is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20519receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20520original gid is also used.
20521
20522This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20523following that is set is used:
20524
20525.ilist
20526A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20527.next
20528A &%group%& setting of the router;
20529.next
20530A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20531&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20532.next
20533The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20534.next
20535In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20536the uid is the creator's uid;
20537.next
20538The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20539.endlist
20540
20541If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20542no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20543This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20544The first of the following that is set is used:
20545
20546.ilist
20547A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20548.next
20549In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20550.next
20551A &%user%& setting of the router;
20552.next
20553A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20554.next
20555The Exim uid.
20556.endlist
20557
20558Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20559&%never_users%& list.
20560
20561
20562
20563
20564
20565.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20566.cindex "current directory for local transport"
20567.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20568.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20569.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20570Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20571the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20572However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20573are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20574for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20575
20576.ilist
20577The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20578.next
20579The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20580.next
20581The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20582.next
20583The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20584.endlist
20585
20586The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20587
20588.ilist
20589The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20590.next
20591The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20592.endlist
20593
20594
20595If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20596value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20597directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20598
20599
20600
20601.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20602.vindex "&$domain$&"
20603.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20604.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20605Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20606variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20607deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20608at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20609other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20610never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20611and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20612.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20613.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20614.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20615
20616
20617
20618
20619
20620
20621
20622. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20623. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20624
20625.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20626.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20627.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20628.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20629The following generic options apply to all transports:
20630
20631
20632.option body_only transports boolean false
20633.cindex "transport" "body only"
20634.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20635.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20636If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20637mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20638or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20639&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20640automatically suppress them.
20641
20642
20643.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20644.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20645This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20646transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20647If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20648logged, and delivery is deferred.
20649
20650
20651.option disable_logging transports boolean false
20652If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20653deliveries by the transport or for any
20654transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20655what you are doing.
20656
20657
20658.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20659.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20660If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20661option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20662transport is run.
20663If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20664output, and Exim carries on processing.
20665This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20666so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20667option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20668variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20669one.
20670The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20671transport and the router that called it.
20672
20673.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20674.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20675If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20676This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20677header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20678requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20679safely be resent to other recipients.
20680
20681
20682.option driver transports string unset
20683This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20684There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20685
20686
20687.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20688.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20689If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20690This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20691delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20692configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20693address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20694header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20695its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20696resent to other recipients.
20697
20698
20699.option event_action transports string&!! unset
20700.cindex events
20701This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
20702For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
20703.wen
20704
20705
20706.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20707.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20708This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20709value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20710&%user%& (see below).
20711
20712
20713.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20714.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20715.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20716This option specifies a list of text headers,
20717newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20718which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20719portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20720&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20721routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20722is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20723errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20724
20725Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20726for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20727
20728
20729.option headers_only transports boolean false
20730.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20731.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20732.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20733If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20734exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20735transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20736checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20737
20738
20739.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20740.cindex "header lines" "removing"
20741.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20742This option specifies a list of header names,
20743colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20744these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20745in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20746routers.
20747Each list item is separately expanded.
20748If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20749is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20750errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20751
20752Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20753for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20754
20755&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20756items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20757To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20758
20759
20760
20761.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20762.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20763.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20764This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20765that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20766option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20767the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20768message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20769example,
20770.code
20771headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20772 x@y w@z
20773.endd
20774changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20775&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20776header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20777only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20778the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20779filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20780affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20781envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20782change envelope recipients at this time.
20783
20784
20785.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20786.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20787.vindex "&$home$&"
20788This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20789overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20790placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20791used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20792&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20793&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20794for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20795deferred.
20796
20797
20798.option initgroups transports boolean false
20799.cindex "additional groups"
20800.cindex "groups" "additional"
20801.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20802If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20803transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20804to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20805
20806
20807.new
20808.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20809.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20810.cindex transport "parallel processes"
20811.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20812.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20813If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20814it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20815The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20816
20817.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20818Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20819incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20820is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20821Obviously there is scope for
20822records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20823guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20824
20825If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20826relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20827start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20828may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20829are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20830.wen
20831
20832
20833.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20834.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20835.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20836.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20837This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20838expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20839digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20840including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20841delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20842message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20843the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20844ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20845&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20846delivered.
20847
20848
20849
20850.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20851.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20852.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20853.cindex "local part" "prefix"
20854.cindex "local part" "suffix"
20855When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20856affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20857form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20858that contains
20859.code
20860local_part_prefix = *-
20861.endd
20862routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20863is delivered with
20864.code
20865RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20866.endd
20867This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20868recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20869whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20870deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20871&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20872
20873
20874.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20875.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20876When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20877in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20878is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20879deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20880part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20881temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20882deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20883
20884However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20885as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20886(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20887this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20888
20889For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20890the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20891on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20892
20893
20894.option return_path transports string&!! unset
20895.cindex "envelope sender"
20896.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20897.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20898If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20899the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20900that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20901designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20902SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20903only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20904header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20905
20906&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20907&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20908
20909.vindex "&$return_path$&"
20910The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20911either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20912&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20913replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20914option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20915section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20916
20917&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20918remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20919the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20920This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20921&%errors_to%& in a router.
20922
20923
20924
20925.option return_path_add transports boolean false
20926.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20927If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20928Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20929mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20930have easy access to it.
20931
20932RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20933the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20934header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20935option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20936incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20937recipients.
20938
20939
20940.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20941See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20942
20943
20944.option shadow_transport transports string unset
20945.cindex "shadow transport"
20946.cindex "transport" "shadow"
20947A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20948another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20949
20950Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20951&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20952string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20953passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20954expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20955cause a log line to be written.
20956
20957The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20958subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20959provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20960is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20961ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20962of the form
20963.code
20964ST=<shadow transport name>
20965.endd
20966If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20967parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20968purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20969provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20970headers that some sites insist on.
20971
20972
20973.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20974.cindex "transport" "filter"
20975.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20976This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20977at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20978individual users or via a system filter.
20979.new
20980If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20981.wen
20982
20983When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20984&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20985the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20986input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20987command must be specified as an absolute path.
20988
20989The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20990terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20991SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20992lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20993settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20994&(pipe)& transports.
20995
20996The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20997standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20998destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20999filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21000are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21001
21002The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21003care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21004test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21005SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21006
21007.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21008A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21009at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21010message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21011a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21012not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21013
21014.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21015A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21016being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21017support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21018at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21019more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21020the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21021additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21022
21023.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21024The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21025the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21026parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21027Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21028section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21029to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21030of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21031an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21032&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21033
21034.vindex "&$host$&"
21035.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21036The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21037transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21038which the message is being sent. For example:
21039.code
21040transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21041 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21042.endd
21043
21044Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21045generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21046command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21047.ilist
21048If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21049part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21050expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21051example:
21052.code
21053transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21054.endd
21055This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21056&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21057stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21058the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21059&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21060Exim tried to expand the first one.
21061.next
21062Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21063expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21064arguments. Consider this example:
21065.code
21066transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21067 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21068.endd
21069The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21070if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21071.code
21072transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21073 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21074.endd
21075.endlist
21076
21077The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21078For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21079normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21080A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21081serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21082the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21083bounced from a transport filter.
21084
21085If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21086passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21087message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21088
21089
21090.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21091.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21092When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21093that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21094temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21095&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21096way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21097error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21098becomes a temporary error.
21099
21100
21101.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21102.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21103.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21104This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21105run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21106given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21107associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21108option is not set.
21109
21110For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21111specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21112&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21113
21114.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21115For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21116sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21117to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21118retry data.
21119.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21120.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21121.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21122
21123
21124
21125
21126
21127
21128. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21129. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21130
21131.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21132 "Address batching"
21133.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21134The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21135one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21136remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21137normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21138transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21139copy of the message is delivered each time.
21140
21141.cindex "batched local delivery"
21142.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21143.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21144In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21145local transport, for example:
21146
21147.ilist
21148In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21149delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21150recipients saves space.
21151.next
21152In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21153a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21154.next
21155In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21156to a scanner program or
21157to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21158acceptable.
21159.endlist
21160
21161These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21162(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21163repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21164
21165The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21166delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21167(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21168&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21169(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21170to certain conditions:
21171
21172.ilist
21173.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21174If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21175batching is possible.
21176.next
21177.vindex "&$domain$&"
21178If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21179addresses with the same domain are batched.
21180.next
21181.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21182If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21183addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21184customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21185including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21186from taking place.
21187.next
21188Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21189delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21190group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21191be the same.
21192.endlist
21193
21194In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21195both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21196is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21197course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21198option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21199&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21200&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21201.code
21202check_string = "."
21203escape_string = ".."
21204.endd
21205when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21206given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21207&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21208
21209.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21210If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21211&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21212that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21213transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21214addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21215
21216.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21217.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21218If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21219transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21220the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21221of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21222argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21223delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21224are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21225
21226
21227
21228
21229. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21230. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21231
21232.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21233.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21234.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21235.cindex "directory creation"
21236.cindex "creating directories"
21237The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21238file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21239files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21240format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21241University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21242being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21243to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21244delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21245supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21246directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21247
21248The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21249default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21250SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21251included.
21252
21253.cindex "quota" "system"
21254Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21255also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21256system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21257
21258If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21259partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21260modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21261creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21262
21263Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21264file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21265private options.
21266
21267The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21268users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21269putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21270&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21271option).
21272
21273
21274
21275.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21276The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21277the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21278the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21279normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21280
21281.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21282.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21283However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21284directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21285forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21286user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21287the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21288name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21289operation. There are two cases:
21290
21291.ilist
21292If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21293must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21294common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21295different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21296default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21297name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21298&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21299.next
21300If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21301used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21302contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21303.endlist
21304
21305
21306.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21307.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21308As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21309have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21310form:
21311.code
21312save folder23
21313.endd
21314or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21315.code
21316require "fileinto";
21317fileinto "folder23";
21318.endd
21319In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21320must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21321case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21322is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21323way of handling this requirement:
21324.code
21325file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21326 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21327 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21328 {$address_file} \
21329 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21330 }} \
21331 }
21332.endd
21333With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21334location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21335&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21336
21337&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21338&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21339the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21340you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21341&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21342path to the transport.
21343
21344&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21345the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21346
21347
21348
21349
21350.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21351.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21352
21353
21354
21355.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21356.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21357.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21358.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21359Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21360regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21361delivery is deferred.
21362
21363
21364.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21365.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21366.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21367By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21368that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21369are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21370what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21371are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21372
21373
21374.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21375See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21376However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21377happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21378file.
21379
21380
21381.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21382See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21383
21384
21385.option check_group appendfile boolean false
21386When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21387option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21388delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21389file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21390
21391
21392.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21393When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21394is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21395process is running.
21396
21397
21398.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21399.cindex "&""From""& line"
21400As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21401matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21402replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21403a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21404contains is significant.
21405
21406If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21407are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21408configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21409&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21410&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21411
21412The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21413suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21414&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21415if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21416.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21417.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21418.code
21419check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21420escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21421message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21422message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21423.endd
21424.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21425.cindex "directory creation"
21426When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21427directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21428is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21429
21430The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21431operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21432example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21433is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21434in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21435
21436
21437
21438.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21439This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21440by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21441directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21442delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21443beneath.
21444
21445The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21446&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21447set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21448given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21449names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21450by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21451&%file_must_exist%&.
21452
21453
21454.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21455This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21456or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21457redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21458
21459When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21460into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21461appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21462(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21463&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21464
21465
21466.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21467.cindex "base62"
21468.vindex "&$inode$&"
21469When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21470&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21471whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21472.code
21473q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21474.endd
21475This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21476inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21477option.
21478
21479
21480.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21481If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21482&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21483
21484
21485.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21486See &%check_string%& above.
21487
21488
21489.option file appendfile string&!! unset
21490This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21491&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21492of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21493specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21494&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21495&%file%&.
21496
21497.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21498.cindex "locking files"
21499.cindex "lock files"
21500If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21501mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21502
21503The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21504path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21505examples:
21506.code
21507file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21508file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21509file = $home/inbox
21510.endd
21511.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21512In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21513is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21514create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21515deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21516run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21517
21518
21519
21520.option file_format appendfile string unset
21521.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21522This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21523before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21524start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21525colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21526second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21527string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21528transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21529this added to it:
21530.code
21531file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21532 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21533.endd
21534Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21535a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21536to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21537to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21538is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21539match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21540delivery is deferred.
21541
21542
21543.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21544If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21545A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21546If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21547
21548
21549.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21550.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21551.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21552.cindex "locking files"
21553By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21554when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21555sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21556Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21557for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21558deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21559mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21560misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21561
21562On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21563not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21564is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21565and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21566
21567If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21568timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21569retries is
21570.code
21571(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21572.endd
21573rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21574which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21575&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21576
21577You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21578local deliveries because of errors of the form
21579.code
21580failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21581.endd
21582
21583.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21584This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21585&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21586&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21587
21588
21589.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21590This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21591for details of locking.
21592
21593
21594.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21595This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21596is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21597
21598
21599.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21600This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21601used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21602
21603
21604.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21605.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21606When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21607exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21608accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21609
21610
21611.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21612.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21613.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21614If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21615number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21616followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21617external source that maintains the data.
21618
21619
21620.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21621.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21622.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21623If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21624size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21625This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21626maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21627it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21628
21629
21630
21631.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21632.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21633If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21634file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21635transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21636&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21637&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21638directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21639SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21640&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21641
21642
21643.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21644.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21645.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21646This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21647a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21648directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21649calculation. The default value is:
21650.code
21651maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21652.endd
21653This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21654(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21655&_Trash_&
21656folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21657.code
21658maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21659.endd
21660This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21661directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21662calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21663directly into that directory.
21664
21665
21666.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21667This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21668&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21669
21670
21671.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21672This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21673section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21674
21675
21676.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21677.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21678The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21679If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21680creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21681quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21682value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21683&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21684
21685.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21686.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21687.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21688The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21689effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21690matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21691containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21692delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21693&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21694See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21695
21696
21697.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21698.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21699If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21700new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21701SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21702below for further details.
21703
21704
21705.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21706This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21707section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21708
21709
21710.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21711This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21712section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21713
21714
21715.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21716.cindex "locking files"
21717.cindex "file" "locking"
21718.cindex "file" "MBX format"
21719.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21720This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21721set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21722the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21723traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21724IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21725
21726&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21727automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21728empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21729combination:
21730.code
21731mbx_format = true
21732message_prefix =
21733message_suffix =
21734.endd
21735If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21736&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21737is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21738&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21739interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21740should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21741going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21742mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21743
21744If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21745the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21746(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21747append messages to it.
21748
21749
21750.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21751.cindex "&""From""& line"
21752The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21753The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21754in which case it is:
21755.code
21756message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21757 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21758.endd
21759&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21760&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21761
21762.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21763The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21764The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21765in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21766setting
21767.code
21768message_suffix =
21769.endd
21770&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21771&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21772
21773.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21774If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21775has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21776permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21777if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21778a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21779value, and this option is ignored.
21780
21781
21782.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21783This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21784mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21785true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21786continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21787
21788
21789.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21790If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21791successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21792on users about incoming mail.
21793
21794
21795.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21796.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21797This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21798or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21799is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21800all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21801individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21802&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21803have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21804
21805As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21806multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21807For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21808
21809A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21810may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21811If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21812become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21813Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21814the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21815
21816The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21817(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21818for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21819large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21820be handled.
21821
21822&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21823
21824The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21825the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21826be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21827fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21828system quota failures.
21829
21830By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21831mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21832last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21833during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21834refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21835message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21836changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21837for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21838continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21839delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21840
21841
21842.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21843This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21844into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21845called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21846delivery directory.
21847
21848
21849.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21850This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21851number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21852can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21853failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21854&"no quota"&.
21855
21856
21857.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21858See &%quota%& above.
21859
21860
21861.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21862This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21863for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21864these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21865If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21866captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21867file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21868
21869This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21870&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21871facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21872the file length to the file name. For example:
21873.code
21874maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21875quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21876.endd
21877An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21878number of lines in the message.
21879
21880The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21881file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21882sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21883
21884Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21885
21886
21887.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21888See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21889&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21890.code
21891quota_warn_message = "\
21892 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21893 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21894 This message is automatically created \
21895 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21896 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21897 a warning threshold that is\n\
21898 set by the system administrator.\n"
21899.endd
21900
21901
21902.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21903.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21904.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21905.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21906This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21907resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21908size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21909threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21910may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21911sign. For example:
21912.code
21913quota = 10M
21914quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21915.endd
21916If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21917percent sign is ignored.
21918
21919The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21920and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21921warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21922the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21923can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21924&'From:'& line, the default is:
21925.code
21926From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21927.endd
21928.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21929If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21930option.
21931
21932The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21933are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21934percentage.
21935
21936
21937.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21938.cindex "envelope sender"
21939If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21940format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21941you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21942so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21943for details of batch SMTP.
21944
21945
21946.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21947.cindex "carriage return"
21948.cindex "linefeed"
21949This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21950(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21951of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21952of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21953
21954&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21955(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21956in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21957carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21958have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21959changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21960
21961
21962.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21963This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21964exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21965&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21966that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21967&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21968
21969
21970.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21971This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21972the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21973&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21974each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21975
21976This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21977&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21978where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21979both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21980
21981.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21982Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21983have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21984&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21985the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21986error.
21987
21988&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21989is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21990
21991
21992.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21993If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21994appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21995&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21996sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21997&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21998delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21999
22000.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22001In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22002necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22003achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22004file corruption.
22005
22006The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22007It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22008except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22009
22010
22011.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22012This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22013set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22014locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22015of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22016are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22017the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22018rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22019does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22020
22021You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22022&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22023MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22024without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22025
22026
22027
22028
22029.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22030.cindex "appending to a file"
22031.cindex "file" "appending"
22032Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22033
22034.ilist
22035If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22036return is given.
22037
22038.next
22039.cindex "directory creation"
22040If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22041&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22042&%directory_mode%& option.
22043
22044.next
22045If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22046indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22047transport.
22048
22049.next
22050.cindex "file" "locking"
22051.cindex "locking files"
22052.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22053If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22054reliably over NFS, as follows:
22055
22056.olist
22057Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22058current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22059as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22060.next
22061Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22062.next
22063If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22064Unlink the hitching post name.
22065.next
22066Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22067then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22068of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22069restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22070.next
22071If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22072up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22073mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22074lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22075existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22076it before trying again.
22077.endlist olist
22078
22079.next
22080A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22081so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22082than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22083
22084.next
22085.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22086.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22087If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22088&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22089checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22090is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22091ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22092directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22093idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22094checked.
22095
22096.next
22097If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22098and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22099different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22100delivery is deferred.
22101
22102.next
22103If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22104If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22105is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22106permissions.
22107
22108.next
22109The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22110If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22111hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22112
22113.next
22114If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22115changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22116have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22117
22118.next
22119If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22120option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22121directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22122open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22123except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22124set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22125the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22126that prevents link following.
22127
22128.next
22129.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22130If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22131existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22132being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22133after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22134
22135.next
22136If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22137
22138.next
22139.cindex "file" "locking"
22140.cindex "locking files"
22141Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22142are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22143&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22144However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22145file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22146.code
22147/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22148.endd
22149using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22150the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22151the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22152
22153If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22154depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22155&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22156
22157If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22158&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22159to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22160delivery is deferred.
22161
22162If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22163&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22164waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22165immediately. It retries up to
22166.code
22167(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22168.endd
22169times (rounded up).
22170.endlist
22171
22172At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22173and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22174
22175
22176.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22177.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22178.cindex "&""From""& line"
22179When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22180delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22181activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22182&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22183router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22184configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22185ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22186
22187No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22188locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22189separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22190of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22191newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22192&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22193any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22194
22195If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22196the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22197different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22198deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22199
22200
22201.cindex "maildir format"
22202.cindex "mailstore format"
22203There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22204done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22205&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22206formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22207SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22208
22209.cindex "directory creation"
22210In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22211sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22212option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22213constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22214the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22215&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22216deferred.
22217
22218
22219
22220.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22221.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22222If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22223it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22224directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22225directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22226&_new_& subdirectory.
22227
22228In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22229<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22230Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22231before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22232file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22233opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22234Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22235
22236Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22237called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22238do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22239path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22240&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22241contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22242&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22243&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22244
22245These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22246and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22247folders. Consider this example:
22248.code
22249maildir_format = true
22250directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22251 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22252 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22253maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22254.endd
22255If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22256delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22257the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22258not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22259&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22260&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22261
22262However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22263delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22264does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22265&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22266directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22267
22268&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22269not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22270&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22271
22272.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22273.cindex "maildir++"
22274If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22275&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22276the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22277Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22278down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22279the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22280amount of space used.
22281
22282One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22283computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22284checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22285needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22286use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22287of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22288
22289
22290
22291
22292.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22293If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22294When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22295tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22296name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22297the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22298
22299
22300.vindex "&$message_size$&"
22301Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22302&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22303happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22304variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22305forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22306be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22307Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22308empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22309colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22310maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22311backwards compatibility).
22312
22313For one common implementation, you might set:
22314.code
22315maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22316.endd
22317but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22318
22319It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22320as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22321&[stat()]& each message file.
22322
22323
22324.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22325.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22326.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22327If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22328storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22329within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22330creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22331the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22332to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22333
22334The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22335messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22336in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22337value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22338is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22339need to know the quota.
22340
22341If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22342file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22343
22344A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22345maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22346See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22347details.
22348
22349
22350.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22351.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22352If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22353files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22354message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22355this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22356contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22357itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22358
22359During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22360&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22361&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22362mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22363file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22364the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22365
22366The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22367option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22368the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22369There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22370greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22371appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22372
22373If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22374failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22375configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22376&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22377
22378
22379.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22380If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22381file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22382messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22383section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22384.code
22385directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22386.endd
22387might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22388then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22389expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22390.ecindex IIDapptra1
22391.ecindex IIDapptra2
22392
22393
22394
22395
22396
22397
22398. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22399. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22400
22401.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22402.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22403.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22404The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22405the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22406automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22407&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22408to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22409
22410If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22411&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22412delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22413that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22414another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22415
22416
22417The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22418&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22419directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22420message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22421empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22422
22423The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22424by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22425passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22426transport is run as a consequence of a
22427&%mail%&
22428or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22429supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22430that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22431case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22432is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22433&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22434
22435&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22436command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22437gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22438&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22439
22440There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22441that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22442&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22443address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22444separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22445the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22446message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22447
22448Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22449message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22450immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22451the transport defers.
22452Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22453controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22454
22455If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22456&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22457of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22458&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22459
22460.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22461If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22462the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22463as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22464is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22465problems. They are just discarded.
22466
22467
22468
22469.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22470.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22471
22472.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22473This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22474message when the message is specified by the transport.
22475
22476
22477.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22478This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22479when the message is specified by the transport.
22480
22481
22482.option file autoreply string&!! unset
22483The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22484is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22485string comes first.
22486
22487
22488.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22489If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22490subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22491
22492
22493.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22494If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22495option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22496
22497
22498.option from autoreply string&!! unset
22499This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22500specified by the transport.
22501
22502
22503.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22504This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22505when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22506&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22507
22508
22509.option log autoreply string&!! unset
22510This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22511the message is specified by the transport.
22512
22513
22514.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22515If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22516used.
22517
22518
22519.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22520If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22521item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22522discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22523generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22524
22525
22526
22527.option once autoreply string&!! unset
22528This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22529recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22530This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22531
22532If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22533By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22534is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22535However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22536message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22537this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22538prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22539infinity.
22540
22541If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22542and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22543greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22544Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22545regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22546
22547In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22548which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22549be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22550means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22551unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22552file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22553
22554
22555.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22556See &%once%& above.
22557
22558
22559.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22560See &%once%& above.
22561After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22562
22563
22564.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22565This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22566specified by the transport.
22567
22568
22569.option return_message autoreply boolean false
22570If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22571message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22572configuration option.
22573
22574
22575.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22576This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22577specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22578automatic responses. For example:
22579.code
22580subject = Re: $h_subject:
22581.endd
22582There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22583subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22584bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22585non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22586small.
22587
22588
22589
22590.option text autoreply string&!! unset
22591This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22592message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22593the text comes first.
22594
22595
22596.option to autoreply string&!! unset
22597This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22598when the message is specified by the transport.
22599.ecindex IIDauttra1
22600.ecindex IIDauttra2
22601
22602
22603
22604
22605. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22606. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22607
22608.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22609.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22610.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22611.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22612.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22613The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22614specified command
22615or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22616This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22617transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22618implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22619to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22620has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22621.code
22622TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22623.endd
22624.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22625is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22626included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22627as follows:
22628
22629.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22630See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22631
22632
22633.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22634This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22635Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22636good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22637batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22638
22639
22640.option command lmtp string&!! unset
22641This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22642is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22643arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22644number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22645is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22646LMTP protocol.
22647
22648.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22649.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22650If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22651commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22652in its response to the LHLO command.
22653
22654.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22655This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22656be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22657delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22658
22659
22660.option timeout lmtp time 5m
22661The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22662respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22663is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22664LMTP transport:
22665.code
22666lmtp:
22667 driver = lmtp
22668 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22669 batch_max = 20
22670 user = exim
22671.endd
22672This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22673necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22674
22675
22676
22677. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22678. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22679
22680.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22681.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22682.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22683The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22684running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22685pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22686(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22687their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22688following ways:
22689
22690.ilist
22691.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22692A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22693transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22694contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22695is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22696.next
22697.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22698If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22699transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22700more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22701(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22702(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22703that are routed to the transport.
22704.next
22705.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22706A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22707alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22708pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22709&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22710(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22711this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22712.endlist
22713
22714
22715The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22716deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22717implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22718
22719In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22720&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22721other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22722transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22723directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22724details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22725for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22726
22727
22728.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22729If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22730delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22731any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22732write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22733.new
22734Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22735of "1" to enforce serialization.
22736.wen
22737
22738
22739
22740
22741.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22742.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22743If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22744have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22745the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22746in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22747later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22748logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22749&"local delivery failed"&.
22750
22751If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22752the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22753will be sent as normal.
22754
22755If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22756script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22757value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22758apply in this case.
22759
22760If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22761return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22762asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22763a non-existent command may be the problem.
22764
22765The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22766set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22767error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22768return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22769included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22770similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22771failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22772&%temp_errors%&.
22773
22774
22775
22776.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22777.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22778The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22779by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22780&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22781run.
22782
22783.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22784Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22785double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22786way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22787
22788String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22789traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22790expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22791For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22792quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22793.code
22794command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22795.endd
22796will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22797arguments. You have to write
22798.code
22799command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22800.endd
22801to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22802argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22803result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22804interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22805generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22806expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22807example:
22808.code
22809command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22810.endd
22811
22812.cindex "transport" "filter"
22813.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22814.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22815Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22816&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22817place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22818transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22819inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22820avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22821&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22822
22823If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22824for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22825is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22826argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22827&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22828the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22829should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22830run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22831
22832After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22833in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22834message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22835standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22836read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22837may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22838control what is done with it.
22839
22840Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22841in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22842taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22843explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22844where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22845under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22846an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22847works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22848as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22849&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22850with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22851
22852
22853
22854.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22855.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22856.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22857The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22858This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22859the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22860environment.
22861.display
22862&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22863&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22864&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22865&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22866&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22867&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22868&`LOGNAME `& see below
22869&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22870&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22871&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22872&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22873&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22874&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22875&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22876&`USER `& see below
22877.endd
22878When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22879router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22880called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22881the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22882removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22883LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22884same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22885
22886.cindex "HOST"
22887HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22888associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22889pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22890the router.
22891
22892.cindex "HOME"
22893If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22894for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22895by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22896user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22897
22898
22899.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22900.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22901
22902
22903
22904.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22905.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22906The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22907permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22908permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22909paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22910&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22911in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22912the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22913&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22914otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22915example, if
22916.code
22917allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22918.endd
22919and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22920&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22921&%use_shell%& is set.
22922
22923
22924.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22925See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22926
22927
22928.option batch_max pipe integer 1
22929This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22930See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22931
22932
22933.option check_string pipe string unset
22934As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22935&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22936by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22937&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22938any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22939of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22940the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22941ignored.
22942
22943
22944.option command pipe string&!! unset
22945This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22946obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22947set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22948the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22949Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22950&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22951
22952
22953.option environment pipe string&!! unset
22954.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22955.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22956This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22957command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22958a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22959environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22960
22961
22962.option escape_string pipe string unset
22963See &%check_string%& above.
22964
22965
22966.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22967.cindex "exec failure"
22968.cindex "failure of exec"
22969.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22970Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22971any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22972is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22973frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22974
22975
22976.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22977.cindex "signal exit"
22978.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22979Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22980a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22981frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22982
22983
22984.option force_command pipe boolean false
22985.cindex "force command"
22986.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22987Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22988the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22989is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22990useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22991command. For example:
22992.code
22993command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22994force_command
22995.endd
22996
22997Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22998&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22999separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23000
23001
23002.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23003If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23004run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23005Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23006from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23007&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23008
23009&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23010See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23011
23012
23013.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23014.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23015If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23016one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23017and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23018written to the main log.
23019
23020
23021.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23022If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23023stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23024the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23025failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23026option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23027be set.
23028
23029
23030.option log_output pipe boolean false
23031If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23032stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23033the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23034exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23035
23036
23037.option max_output pipe integer 20K
23038This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23039standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23040process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23041catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23042the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23043&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23044exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23045
23046
23047.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23048The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23049The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23050.code
23051message_prefix = \
23052 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23053 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23054.endd
23055.cindex "Cyrus"
23056.cindex "&%tmail%&"
23057.cindex "&""From""& line"
23058This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23059However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23060or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23061setting
23062.code
23063message_prefix =
23064.endd
23065&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23066&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23067
23068
23069.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23070The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23071The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23072The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23073.code
23074message_suffix =
23075.endd
23076&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23077&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23078
23079
23080.option path pipe string "see below"
23081This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23082variable of the subprocess. The default is:
23083.code
23084/bin:/usr/bin
23085.endd
23086If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23087sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23088apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23089
23090
23091.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23092Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23093a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23094during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23095It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23096for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23097resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23098installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23099of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23100
23101
23102.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23103.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23104If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23105process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23106to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23107&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23108accept the message is used.
23109
23110
23111.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23112When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23113contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23114in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23115command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23116handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23117
23118
23119.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23120If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23121return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23122is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23123However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23124message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23125&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23126
23127
23128
23129.option return_output pipe boolean false
23130If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23131deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23132is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23133However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23134output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23135option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23136of them may be set.
23137
23138
23139
23140.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23141.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23142This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23143asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23144and &%return_output%& is not set,
23145and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23146temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23147numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23148codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23149defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23150compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23151and 73, respectively.
23152
23153
23154.option timeout pipe time 1h
23155If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23156causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23157specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23158command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23159and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23160if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23161
23162.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23163A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23164runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23165treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23166is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23167delivery to be deferred.
23168
23169.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23170This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23171
23172
23173.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23174.cindex "envelope sender"
23175If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23176SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23177commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23178you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23179&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23180
23181.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23182.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23183This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23184BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23185resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23186limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23187class database.
23188
23189
23190.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23191.cindex "carriage return"
23192.cindex "linefeed"
23193This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23194(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23195of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23196of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23197
23198The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23199written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23200are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23201&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23202values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23203
23204
23205.option use_shell pipe boolean false
23206.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23207If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23208instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23209&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23210where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23211modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23212&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23213command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23214its &%-c%& option.
23215
23216
23217
23218.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23219.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23220.cindex "&'procmail'&"
23221.cindex "external local delivery"
23222.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23223.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23224The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23225delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23226this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23227uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23228by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23229necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23230appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23231configuration for &%procmail%&:
23232.code
23233# transport
23234procmail_pipe:
23235 driver = pipe
23236 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23237 return_path_add
23238 delivery_date_add
23239 envelope_to_add
23240 check_string = "From "
23241 escape_string = ">From "
23242 umask = 077
23243 user = $local_part
23244 group = mail
23245
23246# router
23247procmail:
23248 driver = accept
23249 check_local_user
23250 transport = procmail_pipe
23251.endd
23252In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23253&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23254or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23255user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23256&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23257home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23258
23259&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23260.code
23261IFS=" "
23262.endd
23263as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23264use a shell to run pipe commands.
23265
23266.cindex "Cyrus"
23267The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23268deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23269.code
23270# transport
23271local_delivery_cyrus:
23272 driver = pipe
23273 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23274 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23275 user = cyrus
23276 group = mail
23277 return_output
23278 log_output
23279 message_prefix =
23280 message_suffix =
23281
23282# router
23283local_user_cyrus:
23284 driver = accept
23285 check_local_user
23286 local_part_suffix = .*
23287 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23288.endd
23289Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23290&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23291sender.
23292.ecindex IIDpiptra1
23293.ecindex IIDpiptra2
23294
23295
23296. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23297. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23298
23299.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23300.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23301.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23302The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23303or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23304that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23305explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23306&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23307
23308
23309.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23310The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23311two ways:
23312
23313.ilist
23314If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23315routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23316that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23317the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23318does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23319value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23320section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23321.next
23322.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23323When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23324looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23325connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23326for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23327process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23328process.
23329.endlist
23330
23331
23332For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23333incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23334no further messages are sent over that connection.
23335
23336
23337
23338.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23339.vindex "&$host$&"
23340.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23341At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23342&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23343passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23344specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23345&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23346that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23347&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23348
23349
23350.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23351.vindex &$tls_bits$&
23352.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23353.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23354.vindex &$tls_sni$&
23355At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23356&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23357are the values that were set when the message was received.
23358These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23359SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23360variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23361appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23362are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23363&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23364
23365These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23366and will be removed in a future release.
23367
23368
23369.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23370.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23371The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23372
23373
23374.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23375.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23376When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23377is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23378runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23379reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23380setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23381problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23382
23383.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23384.cindex "local host" "sending to"
23385.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23386When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23387to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23388deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23389the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23390configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23391configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23392
23393
23394.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23395.cindex "Cyrus"
23396When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23397is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23398overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23399forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23400to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23401ignored.
23402
23403The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23404started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23405&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23406particular connection.
23407
23408If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23409&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23410deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23411unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23412
23413This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23414deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23415&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23416.code
23417authenticated_sender = $local_part
23418.endd
23419This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23420allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23421
23422Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23423domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23424value.
23425
23426
23427.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23428If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23429is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23430authenticated as a client.
23431
23432
23433.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23434This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23435sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23436remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23437
23438
23439.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23440This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23441to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23442several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23443less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23444systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23445option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23446
23447
23448.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23449.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23450.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23451.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23452This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23453over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23454For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23455option.
23456
23457
23458.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23459This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23460the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23461of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23462
23463
23464.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
23465.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23466.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23467.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23468.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23469.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
23470DKIM signing options. For details see &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23471
23472
23473.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23474This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23475domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23476cutoff times.
23477
23478In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23479them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23480Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23481retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23482a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23483unhappy at this prospect, so...
23484
23485If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23486addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23487IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23488none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23489delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23490addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23491continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23492&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23493to them.
23494
23495
23496.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23497If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23498and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23499the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23500in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23501
23502
23503.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23504If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23505&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23506See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23507details.
23508
23509
23510.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23511.cindex "MX record" "security"
23512.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23513.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23514.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23515DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23516the dnssec request bit set.
23517This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23518
23519
23520
23521.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23522.cindex "MX record" "security"
23523.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23524.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23525.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23526DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23527the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23528(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23529This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23530
23531
23532
23533.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23534.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23535This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23536of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23537The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23538Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23539&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23540
23541The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23542(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23543that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23544equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23545Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23546
23547
23548.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23549.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23550String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23551colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23552port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23553&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23554item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23555in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23556
23557Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23558addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23559&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23560not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23561&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23562However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23563
23564If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23565the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23566transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23567address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23568list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23569
23570Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23571re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23572addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23573copy of the message is sent.
23574
23575The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23576&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23577both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23578from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23579fails"& facility.
23580
23581
23582.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23583This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23584line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23585zero.
23586
23587.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23588If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23589being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23590(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23591instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23592it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23593
23594.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23595This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23596server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23597implementations of TLS.
23598
23599.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23600.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23601.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23602.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23603The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23604been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23605command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23606option is:
23607.code
23608$primary_hostname
23609.endd
23610During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23611the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23612&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23613used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23614servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23615that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23616interface address, you could use this:
23617.code
23618helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23619 {$primary_hostname}}
23620.endd
23621The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23622callouts.
23623
23624.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23625Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23626finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23627&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23628email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23629all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23630
23631The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23632processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23633&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23634&%hosts_override%& is set.
23635
23636The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23637list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23638separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23639&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23640item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23641in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23642of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23643
23644If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23645the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23646well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23647address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23648&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23649&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23650that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23651address are used.
23652
23653During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23654unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23655
23656
23657.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23658.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23659.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23660.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23661.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23662This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23663example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23664matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23665start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23666facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23667
23668
23669.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23670.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23671Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23672that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23673
23674
23675.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23676.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23677Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23678matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23679
23680.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23681.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23682Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23683or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23684to any host that matches this list.
23685
23686
23687.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23688.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23689.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23690.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23691.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23692This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23693delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23694&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23695
23696
23697.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23698This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23699tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23700why it exists.
23701
23702
23703
23704.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23705.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23706.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23707.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23708For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23709been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23710message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23711explanation of when this might be needed.
23712
23713
23714.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23715If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23716attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23717&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23718&%fallback_hosts%&.
23719
23720
23721.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23722.cindex "randomized host list"
23723.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23724.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23725If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23726&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23727were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23728router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23729is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23730list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23731
23732When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23733order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23734behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23735&`+`& in the host list. For example:
23736.code
23737hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23738.endd
23739The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23740randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23741If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23742
23743.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23744.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23745This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23746before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23747servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23748authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23749temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23750hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23751&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23752
23753
23754.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23755.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23756Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23757TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23758&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23759
23760.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23761.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23762Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23763TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23764&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23765
23766.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23767.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23768Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23769matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23770&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23771incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23772
23773.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23774.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23775This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23776authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23777connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23778unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23779&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23780
23781.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23782.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23783This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23784PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23785for multi-recipient messages.
23786The option can usually be left as default.
23787
23788.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23789.cindex "bind IP address"
23790.cindex "IP address" "binding"
23791.vindex "&$host$&"
23792.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23793This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23794call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23795&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23796message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23797&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23798outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23799interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23800unknown.
23801
23802During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23803&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23804during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23805string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23806string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23807separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23808.code
23809interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23810.endd
23811The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23812connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23813&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23814interface to use if the host has more than one.
23815
23816
23817.option keepalive smtp boolean true
23818.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23819This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23820connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23821periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23822of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23823or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23824that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23825that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23826TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23827unreachable hosts.
23828
23829
23830.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23831.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23832If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23833string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23834has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23835
23836.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23837.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23838This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23839SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23840so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23841permits this.
23842
23843
23844.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23845.vindex "&$domain$&"
23846When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23847addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23848to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23849handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23850&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23851is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23852
23853It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23854&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23855&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23856
23857.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23858.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23859.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23860This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23861&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23862received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23863The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23864variable that contains an outgoing port.
23865
23866If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23867otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23868normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23869&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23870is deferred.
23871
23872
23873
23874.option protocol smtp string smtp
23875.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23876.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23877.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23878.vindex "&$port$&"
23879If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23880the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23881protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23882deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23883over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23884
23885If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23886changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23887connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23888The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23889
23890
23891.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23892Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23893constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23894means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23895tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23896addresses is not affected.
23897
23898However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23899each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23900the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23901Exim to use only the host name.
23902Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23903
23904
23905.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23906.cindex "serializing connections"
23907.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23908Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23909host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23910the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23911slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23912Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23913&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23914
23915.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23916Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23917written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23918is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23919records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23920guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23921
23922If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23923relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23924start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23925may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23926are used for ETRN serialization.
23927
23928.new
23929See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23930.wen
23931
23932
23933.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23934.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23935.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23936.cindex "size" "of message"
23937.cindex "transport" "filter"
23938.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23939If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23940MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23941an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23942sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23943configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23944this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23945
23946Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23947the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23948
23949
23950.new
23951.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
23952.cindex proxy SOCKS
23953This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
23954transport. For details see &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
23955.wen
23956
23957
23958.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23959.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23960.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23961.vindex "&$host$&"
23962.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23963The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23964client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23965connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23966address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23967details of TLS.
23968
23969&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23970certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23971name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23972assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23973client.
23974
23975
23976.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23977.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23978.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23979This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23980be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23981
23982
23983.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23984.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23985When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23986key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23987for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23988If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23989will fail.
23990
23991Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23992
23993
23994.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23995.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23996.vindex "&$host$&"
23997.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23998The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23999client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24000connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24001&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24002expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24003result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24004the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24005
24006
24007.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24008.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24009.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24010.vindex "&$host$&"
24011.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24012The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24013when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24014the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24015&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24016expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24017is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24018&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24019ciphers is a preference order.
24020
24021
24022
24023.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24024.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24025.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24026If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24027TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24028the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24029certificate and private key for the session.
24030
24031See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24032
24033Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24034TLS extensions.
24035
24036
24037
24038
24039.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24040.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24041When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24042setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24043to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24044current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24045option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24046response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24047TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24048unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24049in clear.
24050
24051
24052.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24053.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24054.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24055This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24056certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24057The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24058Note that unless the host is in this list
24059TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24060when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24061The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24062certificate verification succeeds.
24063
24064
24065.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24066.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24067.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24068This option give a list of hosts for which,
24069while verifying the server certificate,
24070checks will be included on the host name
24071(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24072versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24073limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24074
24075There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24076
24077
24078.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24079.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24080.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24081.vindex "&$host$&"
24082.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24083The value of this option must be either the
24084word "system"
24085or the absolute path to
24086a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24087for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24088
24089The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24090This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24091is taken as empty and an explicit location
24092must be specified.
24093
24094The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24095preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24096
24097With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24098explicitly
24099either by file or directory
24100are added to those given by the system default location.
24101
24102The values of &$host$& and
24103&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24104expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24105
24106For back-compatibility,
24107if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24108(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24109and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24110
24111
24112.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24113.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24114.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24115This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24116certificate verification must succeed.
24117The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24118If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24119operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24120
24121
24122
24123
24124.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24125 "SECTvalhosmax"
24126.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24127.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24128There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24129tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24130&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24131
24132
24133The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24134for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24135option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24136multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24137retrying.
24138
24139Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24140multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24141created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24142
24143Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24144several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24145problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24146&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24147delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24148
24149Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24150arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24151limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24152some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24153&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24154that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24155see below for an exception).
24156
24157Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24158list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24159If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24160but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24161that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24162
24163Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24164higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24165hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24166which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24167tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24168reached their retry times.
24169
24170However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24171large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24172Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24173of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24174time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24175without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24176all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24177there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24178the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24179every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24180reached.
24181
24182The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24183particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24184out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24185reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24186been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24187take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24188
24189The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24190Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24191and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24192possible IP addresses have been tried.
24193.ecindex IIDsmttra1
24194.ecindex IIDsmttra2
24195
24196
24197
24198
24199
24200. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24201. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24202
24203.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24204.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24205There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24206addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24207(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24208abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24209
24210Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24211messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24212&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24213appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24214locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24215unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24216lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24217
24218One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24219when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24220such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24221do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24222
24223
24224.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24225This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24226main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24227&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24228
24229Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24230Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24231facility; you do not have to use it.
24232
24233The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24234configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24235addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24236address to which it applies.
24237
24238Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24239the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24240rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24241those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24242by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24243are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24244rules.
24245
24246Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24247applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24248well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24249headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24250
24251
24252In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24253legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24254in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24255used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24256Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24257discouraged.
24258
24259There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24260illustrated by these examples:
24261
24262.ilist
24263The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24264exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24265gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24266&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24267.next
24268A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24269&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24270.endlist
24271
24272
24273
24274.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24275.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24276.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24277Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24278message's processing.
24279
24280.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24281At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24282by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24283ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24284is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24285rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24286rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24287RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24288rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24289
24290.vindex "&$domain$&"
24291.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24292Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24293may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24294rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24295from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24296for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24297value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24298as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24299SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24300
24301As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24302recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24303the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24304any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24305.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24306before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24307
24308When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24309rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24310redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24311
24312.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24313.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24314.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24315At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24316specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24317This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24318section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24319header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24320applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24321
24322The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24323transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24324transport time.
24325
24326
24327
24328
24329.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24330.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24331.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24332Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24333configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24334&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
243352822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24336transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24337appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24338envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24339.code
24340exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24341.endd
24342might produce the output
24343.code
24344sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24345from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24346to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24347cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24348bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24349reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24350env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24351env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24352.endd
24353which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24354the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24355present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24356set for a particular transport.
24357
24358
24359.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24360.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24361The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24362rules in the form
24363.display
24364<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24365.endd
24366Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24367transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24368takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24369any colons must be doubled, of course).
24370
24371The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24372Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24373case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24374characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24375ignored.
24376
24377For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24378order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24379replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24380
24381The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24382releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24383received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24384lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24385address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24386(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24387that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24388
24389.vindex "&$domain$&"
24390.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24391The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24392string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24393rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24394.code
24395*@* ${lookup ...
24396.endd
24397where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24398refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24399
24400
24401.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24402.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24403.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24404The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24405address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24406single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24407against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24408you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24409facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24410
24411Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24412case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24413can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24414
24415.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24416After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24417depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24418replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24419refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24420numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24421of pattern they are set as follows:
24422
24423.ilist
24424If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24425refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24426the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24427pattern
24428.code
24429*queen@*.fict.example
24430.endd
24431is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24432.code
24433$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24434$1 = hearts-
24435$2 = wonderland
24436.endd
24437Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24438does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24439
24440.next
24441If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24442of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24443for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24444rewriting rule of the form
24445.display
24446&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24447.endd
24448and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24449.code
24450$1 = foo
24451$2 = bar
24452$3 = baz.example
24453.endd
24454If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24455wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24456&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24457partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24458whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24459.endlist
24460
24461
24462.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24463.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24464If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24465match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24466rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24467.code
24468hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24469.endd
24470specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24471&'From:'& headers.
24472
24473.vindex "&$domain$&"
24474.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24475If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24476yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24477&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24478Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24479cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24480matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24481the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24482current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24483expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24484entry written to the panic log.
24485
24486
24487
24488.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24489There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24490
24491.ilist
24492Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24493c, f, h, r, s, t.
24494.next
24495A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24496.next
24497Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24498.endlist
24499
24500For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24501E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24502
24503
24504
24505.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24506 "SECID154"
24507.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24508If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24509&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24510and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24511transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24512rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24513.display
24514&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24515&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24516&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24517&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24518&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24519&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24520&`h`& rewrite all headers
24521&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24522&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24523&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24524.endd
24525"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24526individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24527other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24528
24529You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24530restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24531
24532
24533.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24534.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24535.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24536.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24537The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24538SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24539before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24540required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24541data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24542
24543.vindex "&$domain$&"
24544.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24545This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24546compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24547input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24548the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24549expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24550original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24551
24552
24553.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24554There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24555take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24556correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24557
24558.ilist
24559If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24560unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24561absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24562.next
24563If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24564even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24565expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24566(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24567.next
24568The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24569address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24570rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24571.next
24572.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24573When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24574to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24575left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24576.code
24577From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24578.endd
24579into
24580.code
24581From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24582.endd
24583.cindex "RFC 2047"
24584Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24585done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24586causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24587replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
245882822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24589brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24590(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24591is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24592
24593When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24594rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24595.endlist
24596
24597
24598.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24599Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24600.code
24601*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24602*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24603 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24604.endd
24605Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24606the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24607has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24608consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24609present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24610explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24611at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24612error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24613
24614The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24615domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24616.code
24617root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24618.endd
24619were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24620local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24621
24622Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24623&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24624messages that originate outside the local host:
24625.code
24626*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24627 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24628.endd
24629The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24630space.
24631
24632.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24633.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24634Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24635an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24636the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24637remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24638sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24639components. For example, the rule
24640.code
24641\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24642.endd
24643rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24644&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24645a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24646method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24647to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24648use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24649can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24650.ecindex IIDaddrew
24651
24652
24653
24654
24655
24656. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24657. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24658
24659.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24660.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24661.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24662The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24663retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24664be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24665empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24666errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24667general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24668line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24669address, domain and error.
24670
24671The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24672host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24673Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24674address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24675been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24676tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24677log selector is set, the message
24678.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24679&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24680skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24681the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24682
24683Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24684in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24685actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24686failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24687the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24688added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24689same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24690domain are maintained independently.
24691
24692When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24693receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24694always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24695behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24696quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24697suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24698subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24699the local address is reached.
24700
24701.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24702If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24703whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24704files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24705always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24706
24707The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24708rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24709record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24710timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24711and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24712messages that it should now be retaining.
24713
24714
24715
24716.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24717.cindex "retry" "rules"
24718Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24719separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24720addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24721enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24722in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24723present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24724message's sender, respectively.
24725
24726
24727The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24728&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24729which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24730has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24731list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24732which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24733example,
24734.code
24735lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24736.endd
24737provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24738whereas
24739.code
24740alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24741.endd
24742applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24743In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24744part.
24745
24746.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24747&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24748must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24749expressions work in address lists.
24750.display
24751&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24752&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24753.endd
24754
24755
24756.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24757When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24758example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24759against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24760router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24761regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24762A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24763&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24764&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24765
24766Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24767failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24768configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24769&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24770local transports).
24771
24772.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24773However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24774suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24775whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24776rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24777failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24778recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24779reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24780&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24781lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24782commands.
24783
24784
24785
24786.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24787 "SECID160"
24788For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24789example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24790twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24791&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24792the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24793suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24794.code
24795a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24796 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24797 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24798.endd
24799and the retry rules are
24800.code
24801p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24802a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24803.endd
24804and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24805first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24806rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24807to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24808tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24809first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24810
24811In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24812first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24813&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24814routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24815
24816&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24817However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24818host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24819.code
24820route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24821.endd
24822then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24823textual form of the IP address.
24824
24825.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24826.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24827The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24828asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24829
24830.vlist
24831.vitem &%auth_failed%&
24832Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24833&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24834
24835.vitem &%data_4xx%&
24836A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24837after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24838
24839.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24840A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24841
24842.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24843A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24844.endlist
24845
24846For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24847as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24848recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24849and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24850retry rule of this form:
24851.code
24852the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24853.endd
24854These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24855LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24856
24857.vlist
24858.vitem &%lost_connection%&
24859A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24860legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24861for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24862
24863.vitem &%lookup%&
24864A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24865Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24866its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24867Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24868its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24869
24870.vitem &%refused_MX%&
24871A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24872
24873.vitem &%refused_A%&
24874A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24875
24876.vitem &%refused%&
24877A connection was refused.
24878
24879.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24880A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24881
24882.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24883A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24884
24885.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24886A connection attempt timed out.
24887
24888.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24889There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24890obtained from an MX record.
24891
24892.vitem &%timeout_A%&
24893There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24894obtained from an MX record.
24895
24896.vitem &%timeout%&
24897There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24898
24899.vitem &%tls_required%&
24900The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24901&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24902to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24903
24904.vitem &%quota%&
24905A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24906transport.
24907
24908.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24909.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24910.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24911A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24912transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24913&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24914for four days.
24915.endlist
24916
24917.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24918The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24919timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24920it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24921However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24922heuristic rules:
24923
24924.ilist
24925If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24926used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24927quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24928.next
24929.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24930For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24931subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24932the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24933change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24934MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24935time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24936.next
24937For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24938obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24939.endlist
24940
24941The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24942mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24943when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24944error).
24945
24946
24947
24948.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24949.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24950You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24951specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24952apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24953form:
24954.display
24955&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24956.endd
24957The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24958.code
24959* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24960.endd
24961matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24962host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24963For example:
24964.code
24965a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24966.endd
24967&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24968(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24969only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24970its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24971all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24972
24973When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24974&%-f%& command line option, like this:
24975.code
24976exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24977.endd
24978If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24979list is never matched.
24980
24981
24982
24983
24984
24985.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24986.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24987The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24988sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24989.display
24990<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24991.endd
24992The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24993time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24994arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24995time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24996relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24997
24998.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24999.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25000.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25001.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25002The available algorithms are:
25003
25004.ilist
25005&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25006the interval.
25007.next
25008&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25009specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25010is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25011.next
25012&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25013retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25014maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25015the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25016rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25017members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25018queue processing times.
25019.endlist
25020
25021When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25022order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25023used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25024case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25025current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25026computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25027interval is found. The main configuration variable
25028.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25029.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25030.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25031&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25032cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25033
25034A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25035host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25036basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25037for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25038generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25039time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25040time.
25041
25042.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25043Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25044run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25045starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25046new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25047If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25048occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25049messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25050processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25051your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25052number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25053sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25054
25055The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25056&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25057&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25058&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25059are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25060deliveries that have been deferred.
25061
25062
25063.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25064Here are some example retry rules:
25065.code
25066alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25067wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25068wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25069lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25070* refused_A F,2h,20m;
25071* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25072.endd
25073The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25074&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25075mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25076hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25077parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25078effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25079fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25080days.
25081
25082The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25083happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25084intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25085first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25086so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25087
25088The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25089They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25090all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25091were not obtained from an MX record.
25092
25093The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25094first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25095not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25096hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
250971.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25098
25099
25100
25101.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25102.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25103.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25104.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25105.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25106Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25107consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25108set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25109been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25110arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25111failing for the first time.
25112
25113This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25114backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25115Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25116down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25117
25118If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25119every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25120message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25121
25122
25123
25124
25125.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25126.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25127.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25128Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25129that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25130default retry rule:
25131.code
25132* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25133.endd
25134the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25135long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25136failure for the recipient address that counts.
25137
25138When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25139addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25140causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25141In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25142time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25143
25144For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25145messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25146post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25147
25148If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25149.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25150&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25151default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25152reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25153attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25154those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25155the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25156
25157In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25158for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25159times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25160behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25161to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25162notice.
25163
25164If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25165addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25166addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25167no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25168words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25169addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25170If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25171&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25172deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25173true.
25174
25175.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25176.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25177Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25178intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25179its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25180because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25181host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25182failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25183reached.
25184
25185Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25186applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25187Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25188examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25189commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25190time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25191is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25192time out the address.
25193
25194The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25195the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25196given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25197time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25198not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25199considered immediately.
25200.ecindex IIDretconf1
25201.ecindex IIDregconf2
25202
25203
25204
25205
25206
25207
25208. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25209. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25210
25211.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25212.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25213.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25214The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25215with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25216described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25217to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25218permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25219transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25220other.
25221
25222.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25223Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25224
25225.ilist
25226The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25227the client's EHLO command.
25228.next
25229The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25230may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25231.next
25232The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25233appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25234just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25235any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25236with the AUTH command.
25237.next
25238The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25239.next
25240If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25241option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25242mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25243connection.
25244.next
25245If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25246authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25247unauthenticated connection.
25248.endlist
25249
25250If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25251mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25252SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25253includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25254.display
25255&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25256&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25257&`Connected to server.example.`&
25258&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25259&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25260&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25261&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25262&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25263&`250-PIPELINING`&
25264&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25265&`250 HELP`&
25266.endd
25267The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25268authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25269mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25270routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25271controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25272included by setting
25273.code
25274AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25275AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25276AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25277AUTH_GSASL=yes
25278AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25279AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25280AUTH_SPA=yes
25281AUTH_TLS=yes
25282.endd
25283in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25284authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25285the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25286The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25287work via a socket interface.
25288The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25289provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25290The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25291supporting setting a server keytab.
25292The sixth can be configured to support
25293the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25294not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25295supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25296The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25297instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25298
25299The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25300section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25301authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25302authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25303is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25304messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25305options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25306
25307To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25308&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25309either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25310functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25311to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25312both sets of options, is required. For example:
25313.code
25314cram:
25315 driver = cram_md5
25316 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25317 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25318 client_name = ph10
25319 client_secret = secret2
25320.endd
25321The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25322&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25323
25324Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25325The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25326authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25327in Exim.
25328
25329&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25330per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25331account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25332authenticating data.
25333
25334Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25335&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25336and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25337Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25338used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25339second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25340user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25341configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25342&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25343as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25344choose to honour.
25345
25346A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25347to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25348mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25349typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25350
25351
25352
25353.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25354.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25355.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25356
25357.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25358When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25359&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25360used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25361encrypted by a setting such as:
25362.code
25363client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25364.endd
25365
25366
25367.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25368When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25369result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25370Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25371
25372
25373.option driver authenticators string unset
25374This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25375authenticators is to be used.
25376
25377
25378.option public_name authenticators string unset
25379This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25380implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25381contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25382but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25383defaults to the driver's instance name.
25384
25385
25386.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25387When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25388is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25389mechanism is not advertised.
25390If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25391forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25392See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25393
25394
25395.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25396This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25397is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25398for details.
25399
25400For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25401mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25402
25403For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25404authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25405authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25406authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25407to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25408error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25409string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25410expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25411other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25412the error text.
25413
25414
25415.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25416If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25417command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25418output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25419out the values of variables.
25420If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25421output, and Exim carries on processing.
25422
25423
25424.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25425.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25426When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25427expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25428messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25429lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25430configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25431refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25432If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25433
25434
25435.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25436This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25437as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25438driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25439as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25440remembered for later use.
25441How it is used is described in the following section.
25442
25443
25444
25445
25446
25447.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25448.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25449.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25450When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25451the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25452message:
25453
25454.ilist
25455If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25456than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25457.next
25458If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25459.next
25460.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25461If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25462running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25463from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25464&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25465return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25466given for the MAIL command.
25467.next
25468If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25469is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25470authenticated.
25471.next
25472If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25473the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25474&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25475valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25476fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25477&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25478the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25479message.
25480.endlist
25481
25482
25483When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25484hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25485&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25486process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25487
25488.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25489Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25490MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25491therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25492value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25493ACL is run.
25494
25495
25496
25497.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25498.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25499When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25500authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25501conditions:
25502
25503.ilist
25504The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25505.next
25506It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25507yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25508.endlist
25509
25510The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25511the mechanisms are advertised.
25512
25513Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25514provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25515even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25516set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25517You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25518For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25519that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25520.code
25521auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25522.endd
25523so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25524
25525The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25526authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25527advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25528such as:
25529.code
25530server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25531.endd
25532.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25533If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25534yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25535
25536When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25537immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25538command. This is the case if
25539
25540.ilist
25541The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25542.next
25543No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25544.next
25545Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25546server authenticators.
25547.endlist
25548
25549
25550Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25551to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25552AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25553
25554If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25555server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25556that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25557the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25558fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25559rejected with a 504 error.
25560
25561.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25562.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25563When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25564&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25565or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25566public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25567client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25568no successful authentication.
25569
25570
25571
25572
25573.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25574.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25575.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25576.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25577Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25578configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25579encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25580script:
25581.code
25582use MIME::Base64;
25583printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25584.endd
25585.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25586This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25587interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25588some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25589command line to run this script on such data might be
25590.code
25591encode '\0user\0password'
25592.endd
25593Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25594backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25595whose code value is zero.
25596
25597&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25598digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25599you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25600interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25601
25602&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25603specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25604example, a command such as
25605.code
25606encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25607.endd
25608gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25609
25610If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25611base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25612.code
25613echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25614.endd
25615The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25616in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25617output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25618should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25619
25620
25621
25622.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25623.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25624The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25625&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25626announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25627of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25628
25629.ilist
25630For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25631they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25632mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25633of the authenticator.
25634.next
25635.vindex "&$host$&"
25636.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25637When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25638variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25639that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25640any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25641Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25642delivery to be deferred.
25643.next
25644If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25645Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25646try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25647usual way.
25648.next
25649If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25650carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25651possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25652no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25653what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25654&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25655delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25656turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25657deliver the message unauthenticated.
25658.endlist
25659
25660.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25661When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25662parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25663the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25664is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25665incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25666allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25667to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25668&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25669&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25670the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25671.ecindex IIDauthconf1
25672.ecindex IIDauthconf2
25673
25674
25675
25676
25677
25678
25679. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25680. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25681
25682.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25683.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25684.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25685The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25686LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25687plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25688security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25689(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25690use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25691connections as you do for login accounts.
25692
25693.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25694.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25695When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25696
25697.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25698This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25699configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25700
25701.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25702The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25703prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25704given.
25705
25706.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25707.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25708.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25709.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25710 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25711.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25712.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25713
25714When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25715expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25716response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25717values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25718a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25719are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25720(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25721
25722For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25723the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25724variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25725string expansions that also use them for other things.
25726
25727If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25728supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25729data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25730
25731.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25732Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25733&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25734authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25735to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25736&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25737expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25738generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25739For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25740string as the error text
25741
25742&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25743password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25744There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25745
25746
25747
25748.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25749.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25750.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25751.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25752The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25753sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25754separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25755subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25756
25757The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25758Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25759configured as follows:
25760.code
25761fixed_plain:
25762 driver = plaintext
25763 public_name = PLAIN
25764 server_prompts = :
25765 server_condition = \
25766 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25767 server_set_id = $auth2
25768.endd
25769Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25770are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25771password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25772or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25773
25774The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25775the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25776AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25777authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25778.code
25779250-AUTH PLAIN
25780.endd
25781and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25782.code
25783AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25784.endd
25785As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25786data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25787.code
25788AUTH PLAIN
25789.endd
25790to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25791prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25792
25793The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25794when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25795represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25796is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25797second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25798
25799Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25800realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25801authenticating clients it could make sense.
25802
25803A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25804&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25805comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25806this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25807This is an incorrect example:
25808.code
25809server_condition = \
25810 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25811.endd
25812The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25813which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25814incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25815non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25816strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25817the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25818name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25819.code
25820server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25821 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25822.endd
25823In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25824fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25825used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25826always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25827writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25828
25829
25830.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25831.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25832.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25833The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25834in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25835user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25836plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25837.code
25838fixed_login:
25839 driver = plaintext
25840 public_name = LOGIN
25841 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25842 server_condition = \
25843 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25844 server_set_id = $auth1
25845.endd
25846Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25847with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25848if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25849strings are used to obtain two data items.
25850
25851Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25852example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25853&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25854strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25855name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25856.code
25857login:
25858 driver = plaintext
25859 public_name = LOGIN
25860 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25861 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25862 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25863 ldapauth{\
25864 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25865 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25866 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25867 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25868.endd
25869We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25870does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25871operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25872&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25873correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25874the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25875uninterpreted string.
25876
25877
25878.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25879A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25880interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25881traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25882Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25883&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25884
25885
25886
25887
25888.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25889.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25890The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25891
25892.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25893If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25894authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25895the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25896usual.
25897
25898.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25899The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25900string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25901string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25902to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25903most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25904with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25905way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25906(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25907so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25908&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25909&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25910
25911&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25912splitting takes priority and happens first.
25913
25914Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25915the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25916there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25917NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25918the string.
25919
25920This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25921authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25922.code
25923fixed_plain:
25924 driver = plaintext
25925 public_name = PLAIN
25926 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25927.endd
25928The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25929command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25930that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25931.code
25932fixed_login:
25933 driver = plaintext
25934 public_name = LOGIN
25935 client_send = : username : mysecret
25936.endd
25937The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25938the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25939prompts.
25940.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25941.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25942
25943
25944
25945
25946. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25947. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25948
25949.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25950.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25951.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25952.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25953.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25954The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25955sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25956name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25957string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25958is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25959secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25960available in plain text at either end.
25961
25962
25963.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25964.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25965This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25966authenticator as a server:
25967
25968.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25969.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25970When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25971the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25972obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25973that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25974string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25975fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25976returned to the client.
25977
25978For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25979in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25980deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25981numeric variables for other things.
25982
25983For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25984client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25985user name, authentication fails.
25986.code
25987fixed_cram:
25988 driver = cram_md5
25989 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25990 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25991 server_set_id = $auth1
25992.endd
25993.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25994If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25995name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25996secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25997.code
25998lookup_cram:
25999 driver = cram_md5
26000 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26001 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26002 {$value}fail}
26003 server_set_id = $auth1
26004.endd
26005Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26006because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26007
26008As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26009using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26010lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26011realm, with:
26012.code
26013cyrusless_crammd5:
26014 driver = cram_md5
26015 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26016 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26017 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26018 server_set_id = $auth1
26019.endd
26020
26021.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26022.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26023When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26024
26025
26026
26027.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26028This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26029computing the response to the server's challenge.
26030
26031
26032.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26033This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26034expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26035
26036
26037.vindex "&$host$&"
26038.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26039Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26040to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26041expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26042prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26043authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26044send the message to the current server.
26045
26046A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26047strings, is:
26048.code
26049fixed_cram:
26050 driver = cram_md5
26051 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26052 client_name = ph10
26053 client_secret = secret
26054.endd
26055.ecindex IIDcramauth1
26056.ecindex IIDcramauth2
26057
26058
26059
26060. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26061. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26062
26063.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26064.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26065.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26066.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26067.cindex "Kerberos"
26068The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26069Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26070
26071The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26072library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26073Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26074including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26075directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26076
26077The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26078the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26079then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26080name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26081
26082Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26083or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26084user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26085by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26086depending on the driver you are using.
26087
26088The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26089be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26090Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26091changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26092layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26093implementation.
26094
26095For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26096may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26097variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26098Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26099With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26100environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26101is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26102the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26103
26104
26105.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26106The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26107(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26108previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26109use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26110confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26111things.
26112
26113
26114.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26115This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26116library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26117SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26118
26119
26120.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26121This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26122default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26123you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26124example:
26125.code
26126sasl:
26127 driver = cyrus_sasl
26128 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26129 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26130 server_set_id = $auth1
26131.endd
26132
26133.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26134This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26135
26136
26137.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26138This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26139
26140
26141For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26142private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26143the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26144PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26145.code
26146sasl_cram_md5:
26147 driver = cyrus_sasl
26148 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26149 server_set_id = $auth1
26150
26151sasl_plain:
26152 driver = cyrus_sasl
26153 public_name = PLAIN
26154 server_set_id = $auth2
26155.endd
26156Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26157not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26158but it is present in many binary distributions.
26159.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26160.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26161
26162
26163
26164
26165. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26166. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26167.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26168.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26169.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26170This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26171Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26172Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26173If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26174to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26175authenticator only. There is only one option:
26176
26177.option server_socket dovecot string unset
26178
26179This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26180authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26181mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26182authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26183.code
26184dovecot_plain:
26185 driver = dovecot
26186 public_name = PLAIN
26187 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26188 server_set_id = $auth1
26189
26190dovecot_ntlm:
26191 driver = dovecot
26192 public_name = NTLM
26193 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26194 server_set_id = $auth1
26195.endd
26196If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26197&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26198option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26199connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26200option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26201who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26202.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26203.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26204
26205
26206. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26207. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26208.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26209.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26210.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26211.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26212.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26213.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26214.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26215.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26216.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26217.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26218.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26219.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26220The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26221library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26222and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26223scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26224made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26225without code changes in Exim.
26226
26227
26228.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26229Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26230of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26231authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26232ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26233context.
26234
26235This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26236as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26237see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26238
26239This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26240only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26241writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26242
26243This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26244this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26245of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26246
26247
26248.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26249This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26250library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26251Some mechanisms will use this data.
26252
26253
26254.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26255This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26256default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26257you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26258example:
26259.code
26260sasl:
26261 driver = gsasl
26262 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26263 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26264 server_set_id = $auth1
26265.endd
26266
26267
26268.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26269Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26270that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26271the password itself.
26272
26273The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26274In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26275The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26276if available, else the empty string.
26277The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26278else the empty string.
26279
26280A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26281
26282If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26283option to be simply "true".
26284
26285
26286.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26287This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26288Some mechanisms will use this data.
26289
26290
26291.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26292This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26293&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26294(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26295
26296
26297.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26298This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26299&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26300(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26301
26302
26303.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26304This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26305Some mechanisms will use this data.
26306
26307
26308.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26309.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26310These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26311They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26312
26313Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26314meanings for these variables:
26315
26316.ilist
26317.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26318&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26319.next
26320.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26321&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26322.next
26323.vindex "&$auth3$&"
26324&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26325.endlist
26326
26327On a per-mechanism basis:
26328
26329.ilist
26330.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26331EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26332the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26333.next
26334.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26335ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26336the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26337.next
26338.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26339GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26340&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26341the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26342.endlist
26343
26344An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26345identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26346email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26347
26348
26349An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26350and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26351.code
26352gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26353 driver = gsasl
26354 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26355 server_realm = imap.example.org
26356 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26357 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26358 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26359 server_condition = yes
26360.endd
26361
26362
26363. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26364. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26365
26366.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26367.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26368.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26369.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26370.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26371The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26372Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26373reliably.
26374
26375.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26376This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26377for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26378identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26379
26380.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26381If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26382&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26383The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26384
26385.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26386This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26387&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26388from the keytab.
26389
26390
26391.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26392Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26393to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26394not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26395
26396The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26397Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26398Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26399role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26400
26401.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26402.ilist
26403.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26404&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26405.next
26406.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26407&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26408authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26409GSS Display Name.
26410.endlist
26411
26412
26413. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26414. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26415
26416.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26417.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26418.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26419.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26420.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26421.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26422.cindex "NTLM authentication"
26423The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26424Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26425which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26426this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26427taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26428server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26429follows:
26430
26431.ilist
26432After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26433authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26434.next
26435The server sends back a challenge.
26436.next
26437The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26438and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26439.endlist
26440
26441Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26442
26443
26444
26445.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26446.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26447The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26448
26449.option server_password spa string&!! unset
26450.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26451This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26452authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26453compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26454&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26455it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26456for other things. For example:
26457.code
26458spa:
26459 driver = spa
26460 public_name = NTLM
26461 server_password = \
26462 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26463.endd
26464If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26465failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26466
26467
26468
26469
26470
26471.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26472.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26473The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26474
26475
26476
26477.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26478This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26479
26480
26481.option client_password spa string&!! unset
26482This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26483
26484
26485.option client_username spa string&!! unset
26486This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26487configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26488&'msn.com'&:
26489.code
26490msn:
26491 driver = spa
26492 public_name = MSN
26493 client_username = msn/msn_username
26494 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26495 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26496.endd
26497.ecindex IIDspaauth1
26498.ecindex IIDspaauth2
26499
26500
26501
26502
26503
26504. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26505. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26506
26507.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26508.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26509.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26510.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26511.cindex "authentication" "X509"
26512.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26513The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26514authentication based on client certificates.
26515
26516It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26517advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26518It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26519the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26520by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26521the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26522
26523The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26524for which it must have been requested via the
26525&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26526(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26527
26528If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26529run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26530and can authenticate the connection.
26531If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26532
26533A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26534
26535
26536.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26537The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26538
26539.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26540.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26541This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26542the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26543If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26544failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26545
26546.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26547.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26548As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26549
26550&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26551
26552
26553Example:
26554.code
26555tls:
26556 driver = tls
26557 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26558 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26559 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26560 {!= {0} \
26561 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26562 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26563 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26564 } } } }
26565 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26566.endd
26567This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26568of your configured trust-anchors
26569which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26570and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26571Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26572whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26573
26574. An alternative might use
26575. .code
26576. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26577. .endd
26578. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26579. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26580. This would help for per-device use.
26581.
26582. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26583. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26584
26585.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26586.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26587
26588
26589Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26590the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26591a connect- or helo-ACL.
26592
26593
26594
26595. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26596. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26597
26598.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26599 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26600.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26601.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26602.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26603.cindex "OpenSSL"
26604.cindex "GnuTLS"
26605Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26606Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26607GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26608cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26609order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26610version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26611You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26612level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26613certificates are used.
26614
26615RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26616connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26617server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26618mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26619between them is encrypted.
26620
26621Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26622and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26623certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26624possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26625encryption state.
26626
26627&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26628disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26629in order to get TLS to work.
26630
26631
26632
26633.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26634 "SECID284"
26635.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26636.cindex "smtps protocol"
26637.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26638.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26639Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26640SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26641waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26642port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26643allocated for this purpose.
26644
26645This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26646still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26647the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26648numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26649.code
26650tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26651.endd
26652The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26653via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26654the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26655the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26656an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26657defined elsewhere.
26658
26659There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26660&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26661
26662
26663
26664
26665
26666
26667.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26668.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26669The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26670followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26671to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26672.code
26673USE_GNUTLS=yes
26674.endd
26675in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26676.code
26677SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26678.endd
26679You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26680include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26681
26682There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26683
26684.ilist
26685The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26686cannot be the path of a directory
26687for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26688(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26689.next
26690The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26691.next
26692.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26693.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26694Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26695separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26696affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26697.next
26698OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26699DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26700RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26701in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26702for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26703to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26704&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26705option).
26706.next
26707The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26708sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26709.next
26710The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26711When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26712(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26713let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26714.next
26715Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26716This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26717explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26718implementation, then patches are welcome.
26719.endlist
26720
26721
26722.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26723This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26724an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26725but not the chosen filename.
26726By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26727See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26728
26729GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26730to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26731Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26732&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26733of bits requested.
26734The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26735its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26736parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26737that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26738renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26739this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26740place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26741
26742For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26743recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26744If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26745are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26746not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26747
26748Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26749values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26750parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26751If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26752until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26753a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26754
26755The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26756in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26757generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26758
26759To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26760and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26761&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26762renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26763.code
26764# ls
26765[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26766# rm -f new-params
26767# touch new-params
26768# chown exim:exim new-params
26769# chmod 0600 new-params
26770# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26771# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26772[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26773 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26774 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26775# chmod 0400 new-params
26776# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26777.endd
26778If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26779stalling is removed.
26780
26781The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26782Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26783the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26784a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26785and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26786failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26787of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26788which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26789GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26790to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26791limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26792
26793The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26794value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26795&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
267962432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26797
26798In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26799increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26800bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26801procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26802the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26803
26804
26805.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26806.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26807.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26808There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26809suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26810are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26811DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26812directly to this function call.
26813Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26814&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26815The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26816documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26817
26818.ilist
26819It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26820.next
26821It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26822or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26823ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26824SSL v3 algorithms.
26825.next
26826Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26827the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26828SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26829algorithms.
26830.endlist
26831
26832Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26833&`-`& or &`+`&.
26834.ilist
26835If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26836ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26837stated.
26838.next
26839If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26840of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26841.next
26842If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26843option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26844.endlist
26845
26846If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26847a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26848includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26849not be moved to the end of the list.
26850.endlist
26851
26852The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26853string:
26854.code
26855# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26856$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26857.endd
26858
26859This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26860there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26861submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26862choice of clients used:
26863.code
26864# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26865tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26866 {DEFAULT}\
26867 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26868.endd
26869
26870
26871
26872.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26873 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26874.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26875.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26876.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26877.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26878.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26879.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26880.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26881The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26882as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26883ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26884
26885The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26886and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26887
26888The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26889controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26890&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26891the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26892the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26893aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26894
26895Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26896"Priority strings". This is online as
26897&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26898but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26899installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26900&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26901on that site can be used to test a given string.
26902
26903For example:
26904.code
26905# Disable older versions of protocols
26906tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26907.endd
26908
26909Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26910additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26911"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26912
26913This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26914there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26915by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26916where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26917used:
26918.code
26919# GnuTLS variant
26920tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26921 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26922 {SECURE128}}
26923.endd
26924
26925
26926.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26927.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26928When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26929the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26930but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26931that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26932need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26933sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26934
26935If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26936problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26937persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26938with the error
26939.code
26940554 Security failure
26941.endd
26942If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26943rejected with a 554 error code.
26944
26945To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26946match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26947However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26948without some further configuration at the server end.
26949
26950It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26951encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26952.code
26953tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26954tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26955.endd
26956These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26957the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26958contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26959that goes with it. These files need to be
26960PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26961always be given as full path names.
26962The key must not be password-protected.
26963They can be the same file if both the
26964certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26965set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26966is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26967certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26968the server's certificate.
26969
26970If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26971source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26972few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26973
26974&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26975they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26976Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26977transport.
26978
26979With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26980require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26981this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26982.code
26983tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26984.endd
26985is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26986with the parameters contained in the file.
26987Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26988available:
26989.code
26990tls_dhparam = none
26991.endd
26992This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26993DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26994used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26995documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26996
26997See the command
26998.code
26999openssl dhparam
27000.endd
27001for a way of generating file data.
27002
27003The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27004host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27005for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27006in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27007forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27008
27009.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27010.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27011.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27012The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27013an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27014incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27015also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27016&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27017condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27018
27019Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27020can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27021cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27022example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27023contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27024documentation for more details.
27025
27026For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27027(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27028
27029
27030.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27031.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27032.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27033If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27034session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27035&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27036apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27037Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27038contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27039expected certificates.
27040These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27041an explicit file or,
27042depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27043&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27044
27045A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27046directory is used
27047(OpenSSL only),
27048each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27049of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27050certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27051.code
27052openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27053.endd
27054where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27055
27056The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27057what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27058does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27059&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27060attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27061dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27062session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27063fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27064example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27065relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27066
27067.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27068When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27069the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27070&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27071
27072.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27073Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27074&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27075&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27076&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27077certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27078
27079
27080.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27081.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27082.cindex "revocation list"
27083.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27084.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27085Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27086certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27087server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27088an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27089of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27090CRL in PEM format.
27091The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27092file from every certificate authority they know of.
27093
27094The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27095Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27096against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27097usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27098private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27099is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27100
27101The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27102comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27103connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27104re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27105
27106The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27107issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27108the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27109negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27110CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27111resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27112starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27113proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27114
27115Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27116.new
27117or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27118.wen
27119support for OCSP stapling is included.
27120
27121There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27122The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27123an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27124option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27125contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27126
27127Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27128proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27129Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27130contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27131on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27132next connection.
27133
27134When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27135in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27136ignored.
27137
27138For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27139also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27140certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27141of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27142intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27143file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27144
27145Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27146not any of the chain from CA to it.
27147
27148There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27149
27150.code
27151 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27152 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27153 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27154
27155 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27156 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27157 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27158.endd
27159
27160
27161
27162
27163.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27164.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27165.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27166.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27167.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27168The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27169deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27170server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27171within the &(smtp)& transport.
27172
27173It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27174transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27175server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27176this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27177transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27178
27179If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27180to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27181&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27182those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27183set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27184usual way.
27185
27186When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27187the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27188a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27189session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27190&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27191delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27192it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27193STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27194negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27195unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27196unencrypted.
27197
27198The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27199transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27200if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27201&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27202
27203If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27204specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27205These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27206a file or,
27207depending on library version, a directory,
27208must name a file or,
27209for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27210The client verifies the server's certificate
27211against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27212in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27213Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27214&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27215
27216The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27217certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27218or need not succeed respectively.
27219
27220The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27221&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27222is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27223value is empty.
27224&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27225a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27226value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27227otherwise.
27228
27229The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27230&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27231for OCSP to be relevant.
27232
27233If
27234&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27235list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27236the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27237alternative hosts, if any.
27238
27239 &*Note*&:
27240These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27241is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27242by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27243client.
27244
27245.vindex "&$host$&"
27246.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27247All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27248&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27249which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27250behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27251
27252.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27253.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27254.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27255.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27256Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27257&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27258variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27259that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27260successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27261outgoing connection.
27262
27263
27264
27265.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27266.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27267.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27268.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27269With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27270information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27271extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27272&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27273client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27274within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27275for this session.
27276
27277This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27278which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27279address.
27280
27281With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27282against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27283provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27284be of limited use in that environment.
27285
27286With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27287connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27288choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27289wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27290different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27291
27292The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27293if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27294nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27295only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27296for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27297
27298Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27299received from a client.
27300It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27301
27302If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27303option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27304during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27305
27306.ilist
27307.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27308&%tls_certificate%&
27309.next
27310.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27311&%tls_crl%&
27312.next
27313.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27314&%tls_privatekey%&
27315.next
27316.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27317&%tls_verify_certificates%&
27318.next
27319.vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27320&%tls_ocsp_file%&
27321.endlist
27322
27323Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27324attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27325can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27326arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27327
27328The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27329are re-expanded.
27330
27331When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27332for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27333enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27334see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27335
27336When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
273370.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27338built, then you have SNI support).
27339
27340
27341
27342.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27343 "SECTmulmessam"
27344.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27345.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27346Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27347an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27348one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27349of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27350connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27351to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27352session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27353try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27354if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27355
27356The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27357after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27358just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27359reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27360successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27361SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27362should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27363subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27364and delay other deliveries to that host.
27365
27366To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27367closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27368closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27369information is recorded.
27370
27371There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27372&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27373connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27374
27375
27376
27377
27378.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27379.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27380In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27381certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27382place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27383myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27384to Apache, currently at
27385.display
27386&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27387.endd
27388Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27389links to further files.
27390Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
273910-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27392Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27393.display
27394&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27395.endd
27396
27397
27398.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27399The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27400certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27401sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27402not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27403First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27404certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27405intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27406certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27407The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27408validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27409root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27410install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27411
27412Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27413even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27414server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27415diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27416
27417
27418
27419.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27420.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27421You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27422with OpenSSL, like this:
27423. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27424. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27425.code
27426openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27427 -days 9999 -nodes
27428.endd
27429&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27430delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27431specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27432important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27433that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27434prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27435this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27436
27437. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27438. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27439. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27440. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27441. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27442. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27443. ==== -pdp, 2012
27444NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27445epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27446the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27447the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27448of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27449writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27450progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27451be a sensible resolution).
27452
27453A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27454may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27455encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27456
27457However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27458user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27459certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27460must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27461authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27462signed with that self-signed certificate.
27463
27464For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27465user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27466Open-source PKI book, available online at
27467&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27468.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27469.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27470
27471
27472
27473. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27474. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27475
27476.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27477.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27478.cindex "control of incoming mail"
27479.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27480.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27481Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27482configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27483name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27484one very small ACL:
27485.code
27486begin acl
27487small_acl:
27488 accept hosts = one.host.only
27489.endd
27490You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27491which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27492
27493The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27494certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27495when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27496option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27497in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27498local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27499a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27500&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27501
27502
27503.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27504The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27505configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27506
27507
27508.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27509.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27510In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27511options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27512.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27513.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27514.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27515.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27516.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27517.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27518.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27519.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27520.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27521.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27522.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27523.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27524.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27525.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27526.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27527.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27528
27529.table2 140pt
27530.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27531.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27532.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27533.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27534.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27535.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27536.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27537.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27538.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27539.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27540.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27541.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27542.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27543.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27544.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27545.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27546.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27547.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27548.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27549.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27550.endtable
27551
27552For example, if you set
27553.code
27554acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27555.endd
27556the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27557in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27558done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27559sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27560command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27561trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27562testing as possible at RCPT time.
27563
27564
27565.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27566.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27567The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27568apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27569really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27570the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27571relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27572are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27573&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27574&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27575in any of these ACLs.
27576
27577The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27578non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27579analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27580batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27581result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27582really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27583on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27584controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27585.code
27586control = suppress_local_fixups
27587.endd
27588This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27589run, it is too late.
27590
27591The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27592content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27593
27594The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27595kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27596temporary error for these kinds of message.
27597
27598
27599.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27600.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27601.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27602The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27603session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27604an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27605accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27606the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27607&%smtp_banner%& option.
27608
27609
27610.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27611.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27612.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27613The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27614EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27615&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27616Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27617session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27618setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27619
27620.new
27621Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
27622mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
27623&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
27624.wen
27625
27626If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27627modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27628at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27629affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27630an EHLO response.
27631
27632
27633.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27634.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27635Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27636command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27637When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27638is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27639the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27640response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27641added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27642are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27643
27644You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27645in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27646tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27647received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27648the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27649associated with the DATA command.
27650
27651For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27652error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27653MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27654before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27655and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27656your resources.
27657
27658The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27659the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27660the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27661and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27662
27663.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27664The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27665enabled (which is the default).
27666
27667The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27668received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27669otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27670
27671This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27672
27673For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27674
27675
27676.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27677The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27678content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27679
27680This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27681
27682
27683.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27684.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27685.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27686The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27687with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27688It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27689client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27690has been accepted.
27691
27692The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27693has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27694with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27695The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27696The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27697can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27698for some or all recipients.
27699
27700PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27701one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27702content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27703.new
27704.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27705for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27706is &"yes"&.
27707.wen
27708Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27709ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27710will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27711
27712See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27713and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27714
27715This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27716If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27717the feature was not requested by the client.
27718
27719.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27720.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27721The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27722does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27723does not in fact control any access.
27724For this reason, it may only accept
27725or warn as its final result.
27726
27727This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27728session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27729messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27730more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27731
27732&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27733the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27734
27735You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27736&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27737response to QUIT.
27738
27739This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27740failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27741because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27742client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27743connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27744
27745
27746.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27747.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27748The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27749an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27750trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27751because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27752situation even worse.
27753
27754Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27755logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27756modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27757and &%warn%&.
27758
27759.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27760When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27761to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27762connection. The possible values are:
27763.table2
27764.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27765.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27766.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27767.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27768.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27769.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27770.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27771.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27772.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27773.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27774.endtable
27775In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27776Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27777With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27778overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27779&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27780used.
27781
27782
27783.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27784.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27785The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27786you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27787.code
27788acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27789 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27790.endd
27791In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27792providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27793non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27794expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27795more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27796
27797The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27798configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27799string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27800
27801.ilist
27802If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27803contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27804Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27805lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27806If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27807causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27808.code
27809acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27810 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27811 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27812.endd
27813This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27814back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27815file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27816can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27817.next
27818If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27819Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27820matches the string.
27821.next
27822If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27823the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27824want to have something like
27825.code
27826acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27827.endd
27828in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27829newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27830.endlist
27831
27832
27833
27834
27835.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27836.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27837Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27838section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27839&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27840database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27841return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27842&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27843This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27844
27845For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27846&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27847submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27848
27849
27850ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27851has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27852individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27853blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27854
27855If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27856ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27857RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27858recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27859run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27860remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27861&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27862
27863
27864.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27865The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27866recipients; it may create new recipients.
27867
27868
27869
27870.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27871.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27872The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27873all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27874not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27875reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27876
27877For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27878these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27879used to accept or reject anything.
27880
27881For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27882&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27883&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27884when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27885
27886For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27887&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27888This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27889messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27890configuration file.
27891
27892
27893
27894
27895.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27896.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27897.vindex &$domain$&
27898.vindex &$local_part$&
27899.vindex &$sender_address$&
27900.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27901.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27902When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27903that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27904&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27905statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27906&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27907is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27908
27909When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27910contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27911set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27912how it is used.
27913
27914.vindex "&$message_size$&"
27915The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27916the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27917that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27918the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27919received).
27920
27921.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27922.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27923The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27924The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27925accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27926of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27927&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27928&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27929
27930
27931
27932
27933
27934.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27935.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27936.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27937.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27938When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27939the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27940and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27941These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27942here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27943encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27944does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27945unencrypted connections.
27946.code
27947acl_check_auth:
27948 accept encrypted = *
27949 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27950 {CRAM-MD5}}
27951 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27952.endd
27953(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27954that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27955encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27956option to do this.)
27957
27958
27959
27960.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27961.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27962.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27963An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27964with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27965Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27966set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27967
27968If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27969used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27970provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27971example:
27972.code
27973deny dnslists = list1.example
27974dnslists = list2.example
27975.endd
27976If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27977the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27978happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27979all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27980test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27981
27982
27983.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27984The ACL verbs are as follows:
27985
27986.ilist
27987.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27988&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27989of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27990appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27991is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27992after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27993check a RCPT command:
27994.code
27995accept domains = +local_domains
27996endpass
27997verify = recipient
27998.endd
27999If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28000passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28001the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28002fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28003&%endpass%&.
28004
28005The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28006use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28007that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28008configuration.
28009
28010.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28011If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28012depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28013(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28014statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28015SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28016.display
28017&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28018&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28019.endd
28020You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28021response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28022same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28023
28024If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28025an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28026for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28027of &%endpass%&.
28028
28029
28030.next
28031.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28032&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28033an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28034&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28035temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28036&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28037be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28038
28039
28040.next
28041.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28042&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28043the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28044example,
28045.code
28046deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28047.endd
28048rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28049
28050
28051.next
28052.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28053&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28054&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28055that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28056the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28057recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28058recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28059message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28060do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28061
28062If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28063its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28064The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28065
28066
28067.next
28068.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28069&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28070forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28071.code
28072drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28073 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28074.endd
28075There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28076The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28077
28078.next
28079.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28080&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28081statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28082example, when checking a RCPT command,
28083.code
28084require message = Sender did not verify
28085 verify = sender
28086.endd
28087passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28088verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28089&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28090discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28091
28092.next
28093.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28094&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28095&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28096to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28097written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28098message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28099duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28100
28101If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28102and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28103&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28104first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28105&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28106
28107If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28108some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28109This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28110is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28111conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28112is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28113onwards.
28114
28115
28116.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28117When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28118text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28119want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28120.code
28121warn !verify = sender
28122 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28123.endd
28124.endlist
28125
28126At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28127
28128As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28129written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28130subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28131continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28132mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28133
28134
28135
28136.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28137.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28138There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28139can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28140of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28141transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28142variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28143an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28144alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28145the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28146.ilist
28147The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28148throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28149while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28150on the same SMTP connection.
28151.next
28152The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28153while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28154reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28155.endlist
28156
28157When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28158preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28159time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28160.code
28161accept hosts = whatever
28162 set acl_m4 = some value
28163accept authenticated = *
28164 set acl_c_auth = yes
28165.endd
28166&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28167be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28168&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28169
28170.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28171What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28172referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28173false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28174error is generated.
28175
28176Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28177their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28178
28179
28180.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28181.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28182.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28183An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28184.code
28185deny domains = *.dom.example
28186 !verify = recipient
28187.endd
28188causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28189&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28190negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28191two statements are equivalent:
28192.code
28193deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28194deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28195.endd
28196However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28197side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28198
28199The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28200of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28201condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28202.code
28203accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28204 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28205accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28206 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28207.endd
28208Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28209the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28210different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28211condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28212therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28213the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28214and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28215
28216ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28217specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28218others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28219warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28220message is handled.
28221
28222The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28223processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28224modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28225consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28226.code
28227require message = Can't verify sender
28228 verify = sender
28229 message = Can't verify recipient
28230 verify = recipient
28231 message = This message cannot be used
28232.endd
28233If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28234&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28235so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28236recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28237verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28238because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28239
28240For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28241modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28242happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28243the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28244.code
28245deny hosts = ...
28246 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28247 message = Invalid sender from client host
28248.endd
28249The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28250by which time Exim has set up the message.
28251
28252
28253
28254.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28255.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28256The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28257
28258.vlist
28259.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28260This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28261incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28262accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28263
28264.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28265.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28266.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28267This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28268continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28269the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28270update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28271write rather ugly lines like this:
28272.display
28273&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28274.endd
28275Instead, all you need is
28276.display
28277&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28278.endd
28279
28280.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28281.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28282This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28283incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28284lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28285lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28286controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28287even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28288
28289As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28290separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28291in several different ways. For example:
28292
28293. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28294. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28295. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28296. ==== way.
28297
28298.ilist
28299It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28300.code
28301 accept ...some conditions
28302 control = queue_only
28303.endd
28304In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28305other words, when the conditions are all true.
28306
28307.next
28308It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28309.code
28310 accept ...some conditions...
28311 control = queue_only
28312 ...some more conditions...
28313.endd
28314If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28315statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28316In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28317to be relevant.
28318
28319.next
28320It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28321decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28322example:
28323.code
28324 warn ...some conditions...
28325 control = freeze
28326 accept ...
28327.endd
28328This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28329&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28330log entry.
28331
28332.next
28333If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28334&%require%& verb. For example:
28335.code
28336 require control = no_multiline_responses
28337.endd
28338.endlist
28339
28340.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28341.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28342.oindex "&%-bh%&"
28343This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28344the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28345&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28346output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28347happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28348output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28349
28350Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28351example:
28352.code
28353deny ...some conditions...
28354 delay = 30s
28355.endd
28356The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28357&"deny"&. Compare this with:
28358.code
28359deny delay = 30s
28360 ...some conditions...
28361.endd
28362which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28363can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28364.code
28365warn ...some conditions...
28366 delay = 2m
28367 control = freeze
28368accept ...
28369.endd
28370
28371If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28372responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28373they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28374delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28375appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28376unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28377using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28378
28379
28380.vitem &*endpass*&
28381.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28382This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28383&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28384failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28385failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28386confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28387&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28388
28389
28390.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28391.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28392This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28393ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28394.code
28395require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28396 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28397.endd
28398&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28399example:
28400.display
28401&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28402&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28403.endd
28404When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28405that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28406recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28407message.
28408
28409The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28410the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28411denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28412available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28413variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28414&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28415ignored.
28416
28417.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28418If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28419verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28420error message.
28421
28422If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28423the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28424more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28425actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28426of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28427is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28428
28429If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28430example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28431the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28432logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28433both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28434logging rejections.
28435
28436
28437.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28438.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28439.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28440This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28441about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28442be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28443may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28444ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28445.display
28446&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28447&` log_reject_target =`&
28448.endd
28449This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28450permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28451current ACL.
28452
28453
28454.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28455.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28456.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28457This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28458processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28459&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28460access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28461ACLs. For example:
28462.display
28463&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28464&` control = freeze`&
28465&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28466.endd
28467By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28468with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28469another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28470example:
28471.code
28472logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28473logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28474.endd
28475
28476
28477.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28478.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28479This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28480message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28481or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28482there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28483&%accept%& for details.)
28484
28485The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28486to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28487generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28488&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28489the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28490.code
28491require message = Host not recognized
28492 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28493.endd
28494(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28495processed.)
28496
28497.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28498.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28499For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28500of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28501is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28502is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28503overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28504accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28505truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28506EHLO options.
28507
28508When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28509consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28510of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28511.code
28512deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28513 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28514.endd
28515The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28516by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28517access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
285182&'xx'&.
28519
28520Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28521the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28522
28523The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28524literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28525anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28526response.
28527
28528.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28529For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28530stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28531
28532If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28533specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28534However, the original message is available in the variable
28535&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28536wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28537routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28538use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28539
28540For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28541is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28542modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28543all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28544&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28545&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28546effect.
28547
28548
28549.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28550This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28551 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28552the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28553
28554
28555.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28556.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28557This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28558&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28559
28560
28561.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28562This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28563collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28564the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28565of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28566server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28567separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28568example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28569when:
28570.code
28571udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28572 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28573.endd
28574.endlist
28575
28576
28577
28578
28579.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28580.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28581The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28582
28583.vlist
28584.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28585This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28586has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28587apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28588HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28589really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28590not work without it. For example:
28591.code
28592warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28593 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28594.endd
28595Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28596the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28597matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28598mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28599by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28600
28601
28602.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28603 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28604.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28605.cindex "case of local parts"
28606.vindex "&$local_part$&"
28607These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28608(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28609are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28610any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28611for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28612is encountered.
28613
28614These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28615local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28616in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28617handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28618configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28619
28620This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28621containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28622spam score:
28623.code
28624warn control = caseful_local_part
28625 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28626 $acl_m4 + \
28627 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28628 }
28629 control = caselower_local_part
28630.endd
28631Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28632is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28633
28634
28635.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28636.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28637.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28638This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28639
28640The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28641If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28642and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28643is used for all recipients of the message,
28644then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28645and data is copied from one to the other.
28646
28647An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28648for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28649If a recipient-verify callout
28650.new
28651(with use_sender)
28652.wen
28653connection is subsequently
28654requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28655any subsequent recipients and the data,
28656otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28657
28658Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28659and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28660Note also that headers cannot be
28661modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28662Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28663
28664.new
28665All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
28666rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
28667the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
28668Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
28669message body.
28670.wen
28671
28672Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28673of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28674before the entire message has been received from the source.
28675It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28676
28677Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28678a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28679If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28680usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28681the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28682before the acceptance "<=" line.
28683
28684Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28685(possibly faked)
28686sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28687
28688
28689.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28690.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28691.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28692This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28693with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28694&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28695may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28696the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28697option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28698contexts):
28699.code
28700 control = debug
28701 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28702 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28703 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28704.endd
28705
28706
28707.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28708.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28709.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28710This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28711the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28712
28713
28714.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28715.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28716.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28717This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28718connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28719strings or to numeric value.
28720The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28721Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28722&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28723
28724The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28725(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28726that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28727equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28728Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28729
28730
28731.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28732 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28733.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28734.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28735These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28736is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28737state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28738in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28739
28740The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28741connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28742messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28743&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28744before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28745synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28746work with.
28747
28748
28749.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28750.cindex "fake defer"
28751.cindex "defer, fake"
28752This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28753except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28754550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28755messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28756use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28757
28758.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28759.cindex "fake rejection"
28760.cindex "rejection, fake"
28761This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28762words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28763message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28764However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28765only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28766the same SMTP connection.
28767
28768The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28769message is supplied, the following is used:
28770.code
28771550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28772550-kept for evaluation.
28773550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28774550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28775.endd
28776This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28777
28778.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28779.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28780This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28781other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28782it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28783current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28784SMTP connection.
28785
28786This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28787&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28788is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28789are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28790
28791.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28792.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28793Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28794avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28795use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28796disables such output flushing.
28797
28798.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28799.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28800Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28801avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28802use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28803that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28804
28805.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28806This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28807extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28808of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28809or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28810needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28811only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28812the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28813to be useful in production.
28814
28815.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28816.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28817This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28818It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28819SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28820
28821If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28822suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28823one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28824(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28825responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28826sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28827
28828.ilist
28829Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28830sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28831verification failed"&) is sent.
28832.next
28833If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28834line is output.
28835.endlist
28836
28837The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28838calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28839
28840.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28841.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28842This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28843the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28844response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28845controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28846&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28847
28848.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28849.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28850.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28851This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28852other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28853it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28854runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28855effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28856to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28857same SMTP connection.
28858
28859.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28860.cindex "message" "submission"
28861.cindex "submission mode"
28862This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28863latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28864the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28865operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28866necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28867This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28868late (the message has already been created).
28869
28870Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28871messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28872submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28873The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28874that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28875
28876.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28877.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28878This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28879complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28880normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28881
28882.ilist
28883Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28884dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28885.next
28886No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28887.next
28888There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28889.endlist ilist
28890
28891This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28892passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28893used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28894and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28895data is read.
28896
28897&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28898that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28899
28900.new
28901.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
28902This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
28903to a-label form.
28904For details see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
28905.wen
28906.endlist vlist
28907
28908
28909.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28910All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28911
28912.ilist
28913Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28914.next
28915Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28916&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28917.next
28918Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28919.next
28920Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28921.endlist
28922
28923
28924
28925.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28926.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28927.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28928.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28929The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28930to an incoming message, as in this example:
28931.code
28932warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28933 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28934 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28935.endd
28936The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28937MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28938receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28939&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28940any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28941RCPT ACL).
28942
28943Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28944DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28945
28946Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28947the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28948contains one or more newlines that
28949are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28950lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28951front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28952
28953Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28954They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28955However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28956is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28957during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28958with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28959lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28960In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28961non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28962message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28963are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28964
28965.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28966Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28967of message headers
28968until they are added to the
28969message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28970ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28971header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28972ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28973passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28974this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28975&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28976
28977The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28978
28979The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28980processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28981.display
28982&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28983&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28984
28985&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28986&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28987.endd
28988In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28989condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28990condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28991ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28992honoured.
28993
28994.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28995For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28996&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28997effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28998them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28999usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29000are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29001specifications.
29002
29003By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29004header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29005be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29006after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29007that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29008
29009This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29010&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29011header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29012to be a header name first.) For example:
29013.code
29014warn add_header = \
29015 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29016.endd
29017If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29018each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29019you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29020up in reverse order.
29021
29022&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29023added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29024system filter or in a router or transport.
29025
29026
29027
29028.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29029.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29030.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29031.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29032The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29033from an incoming message, as in this example:
29034.code
29035warn message = Remove internal headers
29036 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29037.endd
29038The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29039MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29040receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29041&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29042with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29043any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29044
29045Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
29046DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
29047
29048More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29049list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29050not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29051create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29052are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29053.code
29054warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29055 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29056warn message = Remove internal headers
29057 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29058.endd
29059Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29060They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29061There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29062a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29063during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29064if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29065accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29066all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29067ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29068would have been removed.
29069
29070.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29071Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29072is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29073not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29074removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29075this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29076passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29077you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29078&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29079
29080The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29081processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29082.display
29083&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29084&` `&<&'some condition'&>
29085
29086&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29087&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29088.endd
29089In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29090condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29091condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29092same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29093are honoured.
29094
29095&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29096present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29097in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29098
29099
29100
29101
29102.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29103.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29104Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29105compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29106for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29107content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29108
29109Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29110senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29111result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29112done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29113can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29114same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29115The conditions are as follows:
29116
29117
29118.vlist
29119.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29120.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29121.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29122.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29123.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29124The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29125&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29126&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29127false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29128condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29129condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29130ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29131
29132If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29133can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29134and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29135Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29136The name and values are expanded separately.
29137Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29138will act as argument separators.
29139
29140If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29141the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29142&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29143conditions are tested.
29144
29145ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29146loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29147circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29148for different local users or different local domains.
29149
29150.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29151.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29152.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29153.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29154If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29155the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29156authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29157.code
29158authenticated = *
29159.endd
29160
29161.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29162.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29163.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29164.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29165.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29166This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29167expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29168&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29169number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29170any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29171&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29172ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29173negative.
29174
29175.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29176.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29177This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29178content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29179&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29180If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29181problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29182chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29183
29184.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
29185.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
29186This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29187content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
29188&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
29189
29190.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29191.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29192.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29193.cindex "black list (DNS)"
29194.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29195This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29196&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29197use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29198different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29199&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29200
29201.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29202.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29203.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29204.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29205.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29206This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29207of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29208enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29209lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29210&%domains%& test.
29211
29212&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29213use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29214
29215
29216.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29217.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29218.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29219.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29220If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29221name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29222encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29223.code
29224encrypted = *
29225.endd
29226
29227
29228.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29229.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29230.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29231.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29232This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29233name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29234you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29235.code
29236accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29237.endd
29238The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29239the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29240and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29241
29242The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29243Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29244but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29245find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29246opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29247found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29248
29249If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29250address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29251.code
29252accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29253accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29254.endd
29255The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29256is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29257statement can then check the IP address.
29258
29259.vindex "&$host_data$&"
29260If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29261of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29262allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29263.code
29264deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29265message = $host_data
29266.endd
29267which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29268
29269.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29270.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29271.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29272.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29273.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29274This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29275part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29276enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29277result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29278the next &%local_parts%& test.
29279
29280.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29281.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29282.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29283.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29284This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29285content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29286viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29287
29288.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29289.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29290.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29291This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29292content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29293&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29294with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29295&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29296
29297.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29298.cindex "rate limiting"
29299This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29300messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29301
29302.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29303.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29304.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29305.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29306This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29307recipient address against a list of recipients.
29308
29309.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29310.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29311.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29312This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29313content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29314non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29315any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29316
29317.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29318.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29319.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29320.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29321.vindex "&$domain$&"
29322.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29323This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29324domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29325&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29326of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29327lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29328RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29329influence the sender checking.
29330
29331&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29332relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29333
29334.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29335.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29336.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29337.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29338This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29339for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29340.code
29341senders = :
29342.endd
29343&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29344relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29345
29346.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29347.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29348.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29349This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29350content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29351SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29352
29353.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29354.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29355.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29356.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29357.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29358.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29359This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29360certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29361server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29362or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29363
29364.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29365.cindex "CSA verification"
29366This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29367send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29368&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29369
29370.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29371.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29372.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29373.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29374.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29375This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29376received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29377&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29378there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29379allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29380
29381Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29382problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29383detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29384
29385.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29386.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29387.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29388.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29389.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29390.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29391This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29392received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29393&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29394of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29395is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29396However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29397that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29398to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29399might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29400
29401Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29402section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29403&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29404condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29405.code
29406deny senders = :
29407 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29408 !verify = header_sender
29409.endd
29410
29411.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29412.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29413.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29414.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29415.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29416This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29417received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29418&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29419lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29420and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29421Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29422permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29423&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29424appropriate.
29425
29426Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29427ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29428.code
29429To: @
29430.endd
29431and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29432common as they used to be.
29433
29434.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29435.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29436.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29437.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29438.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29439.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29440.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29441This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29442client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29443attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29444condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29445&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29446independently of this condition.
29447
29448For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29449option), this condition is always true.
29450
29451
29452.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29453.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29454.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29455This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29456Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29457&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29458case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29459&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29460used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29461
29462There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29463recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29464
29465
29466.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29467.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29468.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29469.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29470.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29471.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29472This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29473recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29474&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29475of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29476This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29477verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29478address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29479value for the child address.
29480
29481.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29482.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29483.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29484.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29485This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29486address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29487was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29488Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29489one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29490original IP address.
29491
29492There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29493DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29494
29495If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29496is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29497
29498.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29499.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29500.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29501.cindex "sender" "verifying"
29502.cindex "verifying" "sender"
29503This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29504message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29505the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29506condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29507
29508.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29509.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29510If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29511value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29512value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29513statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29514want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29515
29516Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29517&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29518to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29519
29520.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29521.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29522This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29523verified as a sender.
29524.endlist
29525
29526
29527
29528.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29529.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29530.cindex "black list (DNS)"
29531.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29532In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29533is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29534address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29535domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29536special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29537address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29538.code
29539deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29540 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29541.endd
29542the following records are looked up:
29543.code
2954443.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2954543.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29546.endd
29547As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29548Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29549to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29550use two separate conditions:
29551.code
29552deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29553 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29554.endd
29555If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29556behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29557record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29558processed.
29559
29560This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29561(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29562blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29563following special items in the list:
29564.display
29565&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29566&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29567&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29568.endd
29569.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29570.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29571.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29572Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29573.code
29574deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29575.endd
29576Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29577warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29578.code
29579deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29580warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29581 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29582.endd
29583.cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29584.cindex DNS TTL
29585DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29586.new
29587(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29588.wen
29589so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29590connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29591Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29592connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29593
29594
29595
29596.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29597.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29598By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29599of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29600after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29601.code
29602deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29603.endd
29604This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29605use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29606MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29607&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29608
29609
29610
29611
29612.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29613.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29614There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29615addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29616&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29617with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29618listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29619.code
29620deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29621 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29622.endd
29623This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29624RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29625example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29626up by this example is
29627.code
29628tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29629.endd
29630A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29631addresses. For example:
29632.code
29633deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29634 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29635.endd
29636The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29637name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29638
29639
29640
29641
29642.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29643.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29644The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29645names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29646name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29647As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29648this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29649either to double the separators like this:
29650.code
29651dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29652.endd
29653or to change the separator character, like this:
29654.code
29655dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29656.endd
29657If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29658blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29659occurs. Consider this condition:
29660.code
29661dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29662.endd
29663The DNS lookups that occur are:
29664.code
296652.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29666a.domain.black.list.tld
29667.endd
29668Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29669address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29670are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29671or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29672only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29673successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29674error for a previous item.
29675
29676The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29677syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29678.code
29679dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29680dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29681.endd
29682However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29683is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29684.code
29685deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29686 $sender_address_domain \
29687 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29688 see $dnslist_text.
29689 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29690 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29691 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29692.endd
29693Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29694multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29695and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29696of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29697.code
29698dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29699.endd
29700Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29701domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29702
29703The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29704&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29705
29706
29707
29708
29709.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29710.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29711DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29712just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29713RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29714The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29715.display
29716127.1.0.1 RBL
29717127.1.0.2 DUL
29718127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29719127.1.0.4 RSS
29720127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29721127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29722127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29723.endd
29724Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29725different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29726see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29727
29728
29729.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29730.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29731.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29732.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29733.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29734.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29735.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29736When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29737the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29738&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29739(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29740the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29741&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29742cases, for example:
29743.code
29744deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29745.endd
29746the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29747&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29748For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29749might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29750.code
29751deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29752.endd
29753If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29754&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29755
29756If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29757addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29758The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29759record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29760very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29761information.
29762
29763You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29764&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29765expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29766.code
29767deny hosts = !+local_networks
29768 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29769 at $dnslist_domain
29770 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29771.endd
29772
29773
29774
29775.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29776.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29777You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29778in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29779For example,
29780.code
29781deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29782.endd
29783rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29784any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29785that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29786describes how multiple records are handled.
29787
29788More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29789separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29790&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29791.code
29792deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29793.endd
29794If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29795addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29796first. For example:
29797.code
29798deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29799 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29800.endd
29801
29802If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29803listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29804In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29805true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29806tested. For example:
29807.code
29808dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29809.endd
29810matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29811want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29812being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29813.code
29814dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29815.endd
29816matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29817an odd number.
29818
29819
29820
29821.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29822You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29823condition. Whereas
29824.code
29825deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29826.endd
29827means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29828IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29829.code
29830deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29831.endd
29832means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29833IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29834words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29835the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29836
29837&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29838host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29839
29840If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29841previous example is precisely equivalent to
29842.code
29843deny dnslists = a.b.c
29844 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29845.endd
29846However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29847Consider this example:
29848.code
29849deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29850 list.dsbl.org : \
29851 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29852 relays.ordb.org
29853.endd
29854Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29855.code
29856deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29857 list.dsbl.org
29858deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29859 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29860deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29861.endd
29862which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29863
29864
29865
29866
29867.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29868A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29869thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29870is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29871the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29872the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29873.code
29874dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29875.endd
29876What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29877127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29878condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29879because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29880affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29881additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29882
29883.ilist
29884If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29885IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29886condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29887.next
29888If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29889looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29890changed to:
29891.code
29892dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29893.endd
29894and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29895false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29896.code
29897dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29898.endd
29899for the condition to be true.
29900.endlist
29901
29902When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29903the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29904.ilist
29905If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29906addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29907.code
29908dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29909.endd
29910If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29911false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29912.next
29913If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29914looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29915.code
29916dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29917.endd
29918If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29919true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29920.code
29921dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29922.endd
29923for the condition to be false.
29924.endlist
29925When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29926between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29927
29928
29929
29930
29931.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29932.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29933When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29934the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29935the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29936address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29937only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29938can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29939in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29940lists.
29941
29942A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29943two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29944do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29945If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29946restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29947a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29948domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29949.code
29950reject message = \
29951 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29952 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29953 dnslists = \
29954 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29955 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29956.endd
29957For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29958&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29959match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29960value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29961record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29962The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29963
29964If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29965given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29966the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29967.code
29968reject dnslists = \
29969 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29970 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29971 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29972 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29973.endd
29974In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29975values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29976done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29977
29978
29979
29980.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29981.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29982.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29983If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29984nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
299853ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29986.code
299871.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29988 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29989.endd
29990(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29991lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29992IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29993.code
29994*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29995.endd
29996is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29997Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29998
29999You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30000&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30001.code
30002deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30003 dnslists = some.list.example
30004.endd
30005
30006If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30007address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30008(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30009.code
30010 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30011.endd
30012
30013.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30014.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30015.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30016.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30017The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30018which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30019&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30020commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30021works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30022host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30023.display
30024&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30025.endd
30026If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30027period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30028
30029As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30030&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30031configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30032of &'p'&.
30033
30034The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30035time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30036means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30037parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30038send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30039in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30040constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30041changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30042both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30043
30044There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30045log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30046when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30047instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30048
30049The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30050sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30051retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30052which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30053By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30054of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30055user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30056&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30057example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30058authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30059
30060The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30061rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30062&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30063ACL.
30064
30065Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30066specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30067or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30068&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30069using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30070separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30071
30072Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30073any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30074stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30075remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30076remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30077behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30078the &%count=%& option.
30079
30080
30081.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30082.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30083The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30084normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30085&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30086
30087The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30088the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30089&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30090&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30091
30092The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30093the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30094in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30095used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30096in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30097follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30098in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30099
30100The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30101accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30102&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30103&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30104ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30105in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30106recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30107
30108The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30109number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30110last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30111recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30112&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30113
30114The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30115condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30116command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30117multiple different commands.
30118
30119The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30120measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30121&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30122increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30123other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30124
30125The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30126
30127
30128.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30129.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30130You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30131control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30132mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30133
30134If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30135previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30136
30137For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30138it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30139can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30140in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30141new rate.
30142.code
30143acl_check_connect:
30144 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30145 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30146 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30147# ...
30148acl_check_mail:
30149 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30150 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30151 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30152.endd
30153
30154If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30155processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30156it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30157in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30158same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30159multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30160checks.
30161
30162The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30163use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30164update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30165&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30166next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30167
30168
30169.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30170.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30171If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30172engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30173&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30174counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30175rest of the ACL.
30176
30177The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30178updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30179client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30180the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30181counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30182email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30183is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30184For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30185from getting any email through.
30186
30187The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30188updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30189of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30190actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30191counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30192pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30193again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30194attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30195.code
30196 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30197.endd
30198
30199
30200.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30201.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30202The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30203rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30204mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30205sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30206&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30207measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30208options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30209
30210For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30211has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30212rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30213per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30214go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30215recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30216
30217When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30218&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30219rate.
30220
30221The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30222other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30223unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30224required increases with larger limits.
30225
30226The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30227will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30228the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30229the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30230events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30231times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30232throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30233limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30234are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30235as intended.
30236
30237
30238.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30239Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30240when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30241(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30242policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30243message. For example:
30244.code
30245# Log all senders' rates
30246warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30247 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30248
30249# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30250# at the decimal point.
30251warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30252 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30253 $sender_rate_limit }s
30254
30255# Keep authenticated users under control
30256deny authenticated = *
30257 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30258
30259# System-wide rate limit
30260defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30261 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30262
30263# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30264# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30265defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30266 messages per $sender_rate_period
30267 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30268 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30269 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30270.endd
30271&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30272especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30273bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30274making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30275RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30276this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30277hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30278
30279
30280
30281.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30282.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30283.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30284Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30285&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30286&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30287The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30288verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30289other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30290.code
30291verify = sender/callout
30292verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30293.endd
30294The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30295address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30296difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30297be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30298(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30299The available options are as follows:
30300
30301.ilist
30302If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30303remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30304check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30305.next
30306If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30307normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30308options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30309verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30310.next
30311The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30312discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30313.next
30314The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30315immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30316generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30317discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30318.endlist
30319
30320.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30321.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30322.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30323.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30324After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30325error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30326coding like this:
30327.code
30328warn !verify = sender
30329 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30330.endd
30331If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30332denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30333verification failure.
30334
30335In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30336appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30337
30338.ilist
30339&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30340was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30341.next
30342&%route%&: Routing failed.
30343.next
30344&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30345occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30346connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30347.next
30348&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30349.next
30350&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30351.endlist
30352
30353The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30354rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30355
30356
30357
30358
30359.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30360.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30361.cindex "callout" "verification"
30362.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30363For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30364checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30365the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30366&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30367a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30368address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30369sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30370deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30371sender's domain.
30372
30373Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30374request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30375described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30376lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30377cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30378caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30379
30380Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30381the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30382callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30383callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30384on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30385
30386If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30387second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30388one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30389&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30390router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30391&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30392&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30393supplies a host list.
30394Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30395
30396The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30397remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30398specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30399specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30400specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30401the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30402&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30403
30404For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30405test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30406following SMTP commands are sent:
30407.display
30408&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30409&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30410&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30411&`QUIT`&
30412.endd
30413LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30414set to &"lmtp"&.
30415
30416The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30417settings.
30418
30419A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30420for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30421the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30422that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30423do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30424&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30425
30426If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30427succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30428Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30429hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30430&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30431
30432.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30433A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30434output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30435clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30436disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30437
30438
30439
30440
30441.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30442.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30443The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30444optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30445.code
30446verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30447.endd
30448The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30449separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30450deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30451
30452
30453.vlist
30454.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30455.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30456This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30457For example:
30458.code
30459verify = sender/callout=5s
30460.endd
30461The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30462remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30463the &%connect%& parameter.
30464
30465
30466.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30467.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30468This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30469for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30470.code
30471verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30472.endd
30473If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30474
30475.vitem &*defer_ok*&
30476.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30477When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30478of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30479updated in this circumstance.
30480
30481.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30482.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30483This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30484&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30485accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30486unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30487
30488
30489.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30490.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30491When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30492verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30493sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30494whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30495MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30496as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30497(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30498address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30499.code
30500require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30501.endd
30502This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30503
30504
30505.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30506.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30507This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30508For example:
30509.code
30510verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30511.endd
30512This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30513commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30514be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30515very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30516(for example, when network connections are timing out).
30517
30518
30519.vitem &*no_cache*&
30520.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30521.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30522When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30523
30524.vitem &*postmaster*&
30525.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30526When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30527check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30528rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30529the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30530used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30531made, until the cache record expires.
30532
30533.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30534The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30535You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30536For example:
30537.code
30538require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30539.endd
30540If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30541one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30542.code
30543require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30544.endd
30545&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30546account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30547a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30548postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30549
30550
30551.vitem &*random*&
30552.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30553When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30554check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30555really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30556&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30557.code
30558$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30559.endd
30560The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30561parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30562specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30563a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30564succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30565
30566.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30567.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30568This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30569.code
30570deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30571.endd
30572.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30573It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30574performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30575that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30576domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30577
30578.vitem &*use_sender*&
30579This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30580.code
30581require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30582.endd
30583It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30584command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30585need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30586sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30587usefulness of callout caching.
30588.endlist
30589
30590If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30591command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30592&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30593usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30594that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30595Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30596these circumstances.
30597
30598However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30599host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30600callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30601sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30602callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30603own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30604is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30605
30606Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30607caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30608by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30609actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30610
30611
30612
30613
30614.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30615.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30616.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30617.cindex "caching" "callout"
30618Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30619used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30620option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30621different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30622a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30623entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30624
30625When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30626the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30627is not available.
30628
30629The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30630independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30631(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30632
30633If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30634commands up to and including
30635.code
30636MAIL FROM:<>
30637.endd
30638(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30639any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30640domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30641making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30642separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30643&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30644&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30645
30646Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30647cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30648Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30649ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30650will eventually be noticed.
30651
30652The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30653being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30654behaviour will be the same.
30655
30656
30657
30658.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30659.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30660See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30661verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30662failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30663relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30664you might see:
30665.code
30666MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30667250 OK
30668RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30669550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30670550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30671550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30672550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30673550 Sender verification failed
30674.endd
30675If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30676only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30677out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30678&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30679example:
30680.code
30681verify = sender/no_details
30682.endd
30683
30684.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30685.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30686.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30687A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30688during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30689or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30690it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30691
30692.ilist
30693When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30694continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30695verification also fails.
30696.next
30697When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30698verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30699.endlist
30700
30701This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30702way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30703example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30704.code
30705A.Wol: aw123
30706aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30707.endd
30708work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30709redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30710mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30711verification to succeed.
30712
30713It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30714redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30715generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30716option. For example:
30717.code
30718require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30719.endd
30720In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30721the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30722
30723When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30724redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30725also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30726address and a report is output for each of them.
30727
30728
30729
30730.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30731.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30732Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30733which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30734special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30735domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30736Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30737.code
30738verify = csa
30739.endd
30740This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30741valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30742succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30743&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30744&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30745be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30746
30747The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30748detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30749looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30750address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30751
30752.ilist
30753The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30754.next
30755The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30756.next
30757The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30758(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30759.next
30760The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30761that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30762.endlist
30763
30764The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30765use for the DNS query. The default is:
30766.code
30767verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30768.endd
30769This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30770is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30771address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30772the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30773meaningful to say:
30774.code
30775verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30776.endd
30777In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30778This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30779&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30780
30781If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30782is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30783making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30784using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30785default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30786default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30787(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30788of legitimate HELO domains.
30789
30790The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30791direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30792search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30793addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30794lookup such as:
30795.code
30796${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30797.endd
30798has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30799The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30800authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30801
30802
30803
30804
30805.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30806.cindex "BATV, verifying"
30807Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30808of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30809Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30810recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30811bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30812spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30813
30814There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30815&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30816the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30817address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30818item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30819The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30820&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30821
30822As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30823database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30824like this:
30825.code
30826PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30827 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30828 }{$value}}
30829.endd
30830Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30831list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30832use this:
30833.code
30834# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30835deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30836 senders = :
30837 recipients = +batv_senders
30838
30839# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30840deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30841 senders = :
30842 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30843 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30844 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30845.endd
30846The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30847to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30848send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30849recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30850the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30851
30852A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30853&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30854prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30855the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30856the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30857timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30858of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30859
30860There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30861you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30862deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30863router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30864.code
30865batv_redirect:
30866 driver = redirect
30867 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30868.endd
30869This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30870of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30871address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30872local addresses.
30873
30874To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30875can be used:
30876.code
30877external_smtp_batv:
30878 driver = smtp
30879 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30880 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30881 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30882 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30883 {$value}fail}}}
30884.endd
30885If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30886
30887
30888
30889.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30890.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30891.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30892.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30893An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30894delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30895within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30896passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30897.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30898but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30899
30900Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30901A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30902relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30903a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30904with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30905same host is fulfilling both functions,
30906. ///
30907. as illustrated in the diagram below,
30908. ///
30909but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30910not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30911system to arbitrary domains.
30912
30913
30914You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30915runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30916Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30917example, suppose you want to do the following:
30918
30919.ilist
30920Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30921locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30922&'my.dom2.example'&.
30923.next
30924Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30925These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30926.next
30927Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30928Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30929.endlist
30930
30931
30932In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30933.code
30934domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30935domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30936hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30937.endd
30938Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30939command:
30940.code
30941acl_check_rcpt:
30942 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30943 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30944.endd
30945The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30946the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30947statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30948hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30949than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30950default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30951in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30952
30953
30954
30955.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30956.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30957You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30958that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30959the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30960.ecindex IIDacl
30961
30962
30963
30964. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30965. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30966
30967.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30968.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30969The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30970as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30971was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30972maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30973specification.
30974
30975It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30976&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30977scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30978messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30979chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30980
30981If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30982Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30983&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30984
30985.ilist
30986Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30987for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30988.next
30989Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30990&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30991run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30992.next
30993An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30994of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30995.next
30996Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30997conditions.
30998.next
30999Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31000.endlist
31001
31002There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
31003called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
31004condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
31005
31006Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31007added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31008changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31009EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31010this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31011&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31012
31013All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31014temporarily created in a file called:
31015.display
31016<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31017.endd
31018The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31019expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31020first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31021scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31022removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31023.code
31024control = no_mbox_unspool
31025.endd
31026has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31027same directory by default.
31028
31029
31030
31031.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31032.cindex "virus scanning"
31033.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31034.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31035The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31036It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31037specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31038in memory and thus are much faster.
31039
31040A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31041if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31042
31043.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31044You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31045to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31046are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31047.display
31048&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31049.endd
31050If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31051.code
31052av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31053.endd
31054If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31055before use.
31056The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31057The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31058
31059.vlist
31060.vitem &%avast%&
31061.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31062This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31063Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31064You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31065at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31066This scanner type takes one option,
31067which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31068or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31069The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31070single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31071Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31072to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31073For example:
31074.code
31075av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31076av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31077.endd
31078If you omit the argument, the default path
31079&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31080is used.
31081If you use a remote host,
31082you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31083as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31084For information about available commands and their options you may use
31085.code
31086$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31087 FLAGS
31088 SENSITIVITY
31089 PACK
31090.endd
31091
31092
31093.vitem &%aveserver%&
31094.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31095This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31096at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31097which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31098example:
31099.code
31100av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31101.endd
31102
31103
31104.vitem &%clamd%&
31105.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31106This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31107&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31108unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31109in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31110
31111The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31112a UNIX socket specification,
31113a TCP socket specification,
31114or a (global) option.
31115
31116A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31117For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31118for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31119and the second a port number,
31120Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31121These per-server options are supported:
31122.code
31123retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31124.endd
31125
31126The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31127a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31128
31129If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31130
31131Examples:
31132.code
31133av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31134av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31135av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31136av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31137av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31138.endd
31139If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31140&`local`&
31141option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31142to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31143more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31144Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31145There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31146you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31147
31148The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31149randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31150that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31151socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31152unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31153When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31154not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31155selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31156email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31157.code
311582013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31159 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31160 (Connection refused)
31161.endd
31162
31163If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31164contributing the code for this scanner.
31165
31166.vitem &%cmdline%&
31167.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31168This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31169used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31170type takes 3 mandatory options:
31171
31172.olist
31173The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31174and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31175
31176.next
31177A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31178virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31179absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31180the &"trigger"& expression.
31181
31182.next
31183Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31184match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31185&"name"& expression.
31186.endlist olist
31187
31188For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31189.code
31190Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31191.endd
31192For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31193name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31194for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31195configuration setting:
31196.code
31197av_scanner = cmdline:\
31198 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31199 found in file:'(.+)'
31200.endd
31201.vitem &%drweb%&
31202.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31203The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31204takes one option,
31205either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31206or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31207The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31208single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31209For example:
31210.code
31211av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31212av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31213.endd
31214If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31215is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31216
31217.vitem &%f-protd%&
31218.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31219The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31220One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31221(or port-range).
31222For example:
31223.code
31224av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31225.endd
31226If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31227
31228.vitem &%fsecure%&
31229.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31230The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31231argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31232.code
31233av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31234.endd
31235If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31236Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31237
31238.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31239.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31240This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31241Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31242scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31243For example:
31244.code
31245av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31246.endd
31247The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31248
31249.vitem &%mksd%&
31250.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31251This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31252parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31253&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31254the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31255provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
31256been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31257.code
31258av_scanner = mksd:2
31259.endd
31260You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31261
31262.vitem &%sock%&
31263.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31264This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31265running on the local machine.
31266There are four options:
31267an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31268a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31269the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31270an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31271an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31272For example:
31273.code
31274av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31275.endd
31276Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31277Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31278Both regular-expressions are required.
31279
31280.vitem &%sophie%&
31281.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31282Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31283You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31284for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31285client communication. For example:
31286.code
31287av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31288.endd
31289The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31290the option.
31291.endlist
31292
31293When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31294the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31295ACL.
31296
31297The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31298makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31299The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31300for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31301However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31302which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31303message.
31304
31305The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31306use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31307The first element can then be one of
31308
31309.ilist
31310&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31311The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31312recommended usage.
31313.next
31314&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31315the condition fails immediately.
31316.next
31317A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31318condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31319expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31320Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31321unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31322.endlist
31323
31324You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31325messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31326Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31327
31328You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31329specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31330For example:
31331.code
31332malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31333.endd
31334A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31335
31336.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31337When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31338is set to record the actual address used.
31339
31340.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31341When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31342&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31343&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31344logging data.
31345
31346If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31347use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31348&%malware%& condition.
31349
31350Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31351imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31352
31353Here is a very simple scanning example:
31354.code
31355deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31356 demime = *
31357 malware = *
31358.endd
31359The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31360.code
31361deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31362 demime = *
31363 malware = */defer_ok
31364.endd
31365The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31366aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31367.code
31368av_scanner = $acl_m0
31369.endd
31370in the main Exim configuration.
31371.code
31372deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31373 set acl_m0 = sophie
31374 malware = *
31375
31376deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31377 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31378 malware = *
31379.endd
31380
31381
31382.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31383.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31384.cindex "spam scanning"
31385.cindex "SpamAssassin"
31386.cindex "Rspamd"
31387The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31388score and a report for the message.
31389Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31390
31391For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31392Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31393&url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31394
31395SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31396.code
31397perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31398.endd
31399SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31400documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31401nicely, however.
31402
31403.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31404By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31405intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31406&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31407you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31408configuration as follows (example):
31409.code
31410spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31411.endd
31412
31413To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31414on TCP port 11333)
31415you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31416.code
31417spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31418.endd
31419
31420As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31421sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31422file name instead of an address/port pair:
31423.code
31424spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31425.endd
31426You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31427reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31428&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31429option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31430.code
31431spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31432 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31433 192.168.2.12 783
31434.endd
31435Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31436When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31437servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31438condition defers.
31439
31440Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31441Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31442and changeable in the usual way.
31443
31444For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31445subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31446and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31447In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31448
31449Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31450are options.
31451The supported options are:
31452.code
31453pri=<priority> Selection priority
31454weight=<value> Selection bias
31455time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31456retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31457tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31458variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31459.endd
31460
31461The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31462higher values being tried first.
31463The default priority is 1.
31464
31465The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31466Within a priority set
31467servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31468The default value for selection bias is 1.
31469
31470Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31471in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31472Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31473characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31474
31475Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31476are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31477
31478The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31479The default value is two minutes.
31480
31481The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31482a failed connect is made.
31483The default is to not retry.
31484
31485The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31486a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31487used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31488expansion.
31489
31490.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31491When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31492is set to record the actual address used.
31493
31494.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31495Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31496.code
31497deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31498 spam = joe
31499.endd
31500The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31501relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31502to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31503default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31504Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31505right-hand side.
31506
31507The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31508principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31509have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31510&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31511read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31512are not set.
31513Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31514(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31515after the first),
31516or the use of PRDR,
31517.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31518are needed to use this feature.
31519
31520The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31521you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31522&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31523
31524
31525Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31526large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31527are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31528example:
31529.code
31530deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31531 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31532 spam = nobody
31533.endd
31534
31535The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31536SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31537&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31538it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31539
31540.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31541When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31542variables.
31543Except for &$spam_report$&,
31544these variables are saved with the received message so are
31545available for use at delivery time.
31546
31547.vlist
31548.vitem &$spam_score$&
31549The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31550for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31551
31552.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31553The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31554example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31555because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31556The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31557
31558.vitem &$spam_bar$&
31559A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31560integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31561&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31562headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31563spam bar is 50 characters.
31564
31565.vitem &$spam_report$&
31566A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31567message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31568This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31569
31570.vitem &$spam_action$&
31571For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31572spam score versus threshold.
31573For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31574
31575.endlist
31576
31577The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31578spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31579does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31580
31581The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31582the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31583failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31584statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31585spam condition, like this:
31586.code
31587deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31588 spam = joe/defer_ok
31589.endd
31590This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31591
31592Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31593condition:
31594.code
31595# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31596warn spam = nobody:true
31597 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31598 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31599
31600# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31601# is over threshold
31602warn spam = nobody
31603 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31604
31605# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31606deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31607 spam = nobody:true
31608 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31609.endd
31610
31611
31612
31613.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31614.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31615.cindex "MIME content scanning"
31616.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31617.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31618The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31619each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31620of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31621specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31622options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31623cases.
31624
31625These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31626ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31627the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31628message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31629ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31630result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31631&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31632
31633You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31634only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31635condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31636&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31637&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31638
31639At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31640information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31641of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31642parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31643part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31644syntax is:
31645.display
31646&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31647.endd
31648The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31649the value can be:
31650
31651.olist
31652&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31653.next
31654The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31655&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31656a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31657full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31658.next
31659A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31660directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31661is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31662the full path and file name.
31663.next
31664If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31665filename, and the default path is then used.
31666.endlist
31667The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31668errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31669a file with its original, proposed filename using
31670.code
31671decode = $mime_filename
31672.endd
31673However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31674anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31675automatically unlinked.
31676
31677For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31678content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31679as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31680variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31681before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31682
31683The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31684used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31685respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31686
31687.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31688The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31689available in the MIME ACL:
31690
31691.vlist
31692.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31693If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31694have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31695has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31696contains the empty string.
31697
31698.vitem &$mime_charset$&
31699This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31700&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31701.code
31702us-ascii
31703gb2312 (Chinese)
31704iso-8859-1
31705.endd
31706Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31707case-insensitively.
31708
31709.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31710This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31711header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31712implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31713only used for display purposes.
31714
31715.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31716This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31717header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31718
31719.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31720This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31721This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31722
31723.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31724This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31725successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31726size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31727has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31728
31729.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31730This variable contains the normalized content of the
31731&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31732type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31733
31734.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31735If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31736value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31737are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31738.code
31739text/plain
31740text/html
31741application/octet-stream
31742image/jpeg
31743audio/midi
31744.endd
31745If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31746empty string.
31747
31748.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31749This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31750successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31751containing the decoded data.
31752.endlist
31753
31754.cindex "RFC 2047"
31755.vlist
31756.vitem &$mime_filename$&
31757This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31758proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31759&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31760RFC2047
31761or RFC2231
31762decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31763 If no filename was
31764found, this variable contains the empty string.
31765
31766.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31767This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31768attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31769content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31770
31771The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31772cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31773follows:
31774
31775.olist
31776The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31777
31778.next
31779If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31780so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31781
31782.next
31783If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31784and the rest are attachments.
31785
31786.next
31787All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31788.endlist olist
31789
31790As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31791alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31792coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31793.code
31794deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31795!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31796condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31797condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31798.endd
31799.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31800This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31801&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31802Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31803want to carry out specific actions on them.
31804
31805.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31806This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31807checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31808decoding is fully recursive.
31809
31810.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31811This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31812starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31813counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31814&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31815complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31816parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31817.endlist
31818
31819
31820
31821.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31822.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31823.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31824You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31825the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31826
31827The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31828matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31829MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31830linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31831have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31832
31833The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31834to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31835part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31836is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31837and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3183832K characters are checked.
31839
31840The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31841literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31842expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31843with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31844Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31845.code
31846deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31847 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31848.endd
31849The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31850&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31851matching regular expression.
31852The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31853are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31854
31855&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31856CPU-intensive.
31857
31858
31859
31860
31861.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31862.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31863.cindex "MIME content scanning"
31864The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31865extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31866&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31867ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31868condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31869the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31870use the &%demime%& condition.
31871
31872The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31873errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31874against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31875parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31876scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31877antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31878
31879On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31880colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31881example:
31882.code
31883deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31884 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31885.endd
31886If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31887false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31888full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31889the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31890
31891The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31892conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31893zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31894
31895The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31896
31897.vlist
31898.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31899.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31900When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31901severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31902severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31903zero, no error occurred.
31904
31905.vitem &$demime_reason$&
31906.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31907When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31908human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31909.endlist
31910
31911.vlist
31912.vitem &$found_extension$&
31913.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31914When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31915extension it found.
31916.endlist
31917
31918Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31919the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31920
31921If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31922condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31923right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31924facility:
31925.code
31926# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31927deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31928 demime = *
31929 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31930
31931# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31932# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31933deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31934 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31935
31936# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31937# examine them and eventually thaw them.
31938deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31939 demime = exe:doc
31940 control = freeze
31941.endd
31942.ecindex IIDcosca
31943
31944
31945
31946
31947. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31948. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31949
31950.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31951 "Local scan function"
31952.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31953.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31954.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31955In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31956want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31957
31958The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31959passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31960a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31961condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31962non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31963
31964To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31965possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31966in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31967can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31968
31969The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31970when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31971It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31972well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31973
31974Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31975option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31976Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31977Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31978before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31979are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31980incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31981For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31982code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31983
31984
31985
31986.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31987.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31988To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31989function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31990&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31991directory, so you might set
31992.code
31993LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31994.endd
31995for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31996Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31997be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31998function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31999commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32000_src/local_scan.c_.
32001
32002If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32003for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32004.code
32005LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32006.endd
32007in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32008
32009
32010
32011
32012.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32013.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32014You must include this line near the start of your code:
32015.code
32016#include "local_scan.h"
32017.endd
32018This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32019prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32020almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32021for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32022It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32023strings and pointers to character strings:
32024.code
32025#define CS (char *)
32026#define CCS (const char *)
32027#define CSS (char **)
32028#define US (unsigned char *)
32029#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32030#define USS (unsigned char **)
32031.endd
32032The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32033.code
32034extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32035.endd
32036The arguments are as follows:
32037
32038.ilist
32039&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32040(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32041recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32042
32043The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32044character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32045id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32046macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32047case this changes in some future version.
32048.next
32049&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32050string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32051.endlist
32052
32053The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32054
32055.vlist
32056.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32057.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32058The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32059the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32060newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32061maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32062
32063.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32064This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32065queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32066
32067.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32068This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32069queued without immediate delivery.
32070
32071.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32072The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32073passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32074they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32075&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32076used.
32077
32078.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32079The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32080message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32081problem"& is used.
32082
32083.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32084This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32085message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32086&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32087&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32088&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32089same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32090
32091.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32092This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32093LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32094.endlist
32095
32096If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32097reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32098&%-oe%& command line options.
32099
32100
32101
32102.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32103.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32104It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32105that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32106want to do this, you must have the line
32107.code
32108LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32109.endd
32110in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32111&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32112file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32113to define them.
32114
32115The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32116&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32117and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32118alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32119variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32120entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32121.code
32122static int my_integer_option = 42;
32123static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32124
32125optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32126 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32127 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32128};
32129
32130int local_scan_options_count =
32131 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32132.endd
32133The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32134configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32135.code
32136begin local_scan
32137my_integer = 99
32138my_string = some string of text...
32139.endd
32140The available types of option data are as follows:
32141
32142.vlist
32143.vitem &*opt_bool*&
32144This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32145variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32146that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32147whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32148TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32149values.)
32150
32151.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32152This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32153The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32154multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32155
32156.vitem &*opt_int*&
32157This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32158&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32159Exim.
32160
32161.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32162This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32163&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32164printed with the suffix K or M.
32165
32166.vitem &*opt_octint*&
32167This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32168octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32169always output in octal.
32170
32171.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32172This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32173variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32174
32175.vitem &*opt_time*&
32176This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32177type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32178.endlist
32179
32180If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32181out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32182
32183
32184
32185.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32186.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32187The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32188are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32189Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32190including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32191C variables are as follows:
32192
32193.vlist
32194.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32195This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32196
32197.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32198This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32199
32200.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32201This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32202is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32203&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32204
32205.ilist
32206The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32207testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32208other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32209
32210.next
32211The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32212by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32213of debugging bits.
32214.endlist ilist
32215
32216Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32217selected, you should use code like this:
32218.code
32219if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32220 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32221.endd
32222.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32223After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32224variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32225
32226.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32227A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32228discussed below.
32229
32230.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32231A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32232
32233.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32234The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32235
32236.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32237This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32238&%-bh%& command line option.
32239
32240.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32241The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32242is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32243
32244.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32245The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32246command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32247specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32248
32249.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32250This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32251&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32252
32253.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32254The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32255
32256.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32257The number of accepted recipients.
32258
32259.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32260.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32261.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32262The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32263&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32264can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32265below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32266adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32267&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32268value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32269blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32270and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32271
32272.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32273The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32274
32275.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32276The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32277locally-submitted messages.
32278
32279.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32280The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32281was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32282
32283.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32284The name of the sending host, if known.
32285
32286.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32287The port on the sending host.
32288
32289.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32290This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32291
32292.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32293This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32294
32295.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32296The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32297requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32298.endlist
32299
32300
32301.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32302The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32303You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32304(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32305their type to *.
32306
32307
32308.vlist
32309.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32310A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32311
32312.vitem &*int&~type*&
32313A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32314characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32315Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32316with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32317rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32318lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32319
32320.vitem &*int&~slen*&
32321The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32322internal newlines.
32323
32324.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32325A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32326a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32327.endlist
32328
32329
32330
32331.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32332The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32333
32334.vlist
32335.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32336This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32337
32338.vitem &*int&~pno*&
32339This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32340the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32341and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32342
32343.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32344If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32345recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32346envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32347router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32348an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32349&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32350is NULL for all recipients.
32351.endlist
32352
32353
32354
32355.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32356.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32357The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32358These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32359release:
32360
32361.vlist
32362.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32363 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32364
32365This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32366&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32367be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32368for the process in &%newumask%&.
32369
32370Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32371and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32372standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32373descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32374argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32375
32376The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32377
32378.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32379This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32380seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32381return value is as follows:
32382
32383.ilist
32384>= 0
32385
32386The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32387ending status.
32388
32389.next
32390< 0 and > &--256
32391
32392The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32393signal number.
32394
32395.next
32396&--256
32397
32398The process timed out.
32399.next
32400&--257
32401
32402The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32403.endlist
32404
32405.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32406This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32407Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32408want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32409forks a subprocess that is running
32410.code
32411exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32412.endd
32413and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32414that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32415of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32416recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32417
32418When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32419finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32420fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32421addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32422
32423
32424.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32425 *sender_authentication)*&
32426This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32427that it runs is:
32428.display
32429&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32430.endd
32431The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32432
32433
32434.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32435This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32436output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32437calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32438conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32439.code
32440if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32441 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32442.endd
32443
32444.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32445This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32446expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32447The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32448expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32449the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32450block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32451&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32452
32453.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32454This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32455existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32456character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32457substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32458if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32459
32460.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32461 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32462This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32463chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32464
32465If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32466&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32467NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32468matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32469&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32470found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32471marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32472option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32473top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32474headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32475.code
32476header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32477 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32478.endd
32479Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32480there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32481
32482
32483.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32484This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32485occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32486particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32487match the specification, the function does nothing.
32488
32489
32490.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32491 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32492This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32493a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32494colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32495&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32496.code
32497if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32498.endd
32499.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32500.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32501This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32502The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32503back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32504zero-terminated.
32505
32506.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32507This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32508zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32509to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32510string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32511yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32512easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32513added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32514
32515.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32516This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32517matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32518.display
32519&`OK `& match succeeded
32520&`FAIL `& match failed
32521&`DEFER `& match deferred
32522.endd
32523DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32524inability to contact a database.
32525
32526.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32527 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32528This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32529controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32530&'lss_match_domain()'&.
32531
32532.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32533 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32534This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32535controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32536matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32537
32538.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32539 uschar&~*list)*&"
32540This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32541expected to be
32542.code
32543lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32544.endd
32545.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32546An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32547is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32548looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32549values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32550returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32551failed.
32552
32553.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32554 *format,&~...)*&"
32555This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32556is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32557&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32558them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32559arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32560contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32561
32562
32563.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32564This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32565is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32566with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32567
32568This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32569described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32570the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32571value afterwards. For example:
32572.code
32573 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32574 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32575 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32576.endd
32577
32578.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32579This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32580recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32581matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32582address.
32583.endlist
32584
32585
32586.cindex "RFC 2047"
32587.vlist
32588.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32589 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32590This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32591these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32592from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32593a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32594made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32595binary string is returned with an error message.
32596
32597The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32598maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32599encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32600
32601.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32602.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32603If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32604contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32605not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32606
32607The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32608&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32609which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32610
32611If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32612argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32613set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32614returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32615with translation.
32616
32617
32618.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32619This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32620below.
32621
32622.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32623The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32624output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32625stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32626SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32627is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32628opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32629test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32630is involved.
32631
32632If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32633output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32634
32635Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32636must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32637LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32638LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32639initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32640to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32641that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32642.code
32643smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32644return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32645.endd
32646Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32647the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32648&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32649multiple output lines.
32650
32651The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32652does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32653the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32654detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32655you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32656dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32657arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32658is an error.
32659
32660.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32661This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32662chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32663runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32664
32665.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32666This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32667permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32668
32669.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32670See below.
32671
32672.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32673See below.
32674
32675.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32676These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32677The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32678number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32679and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32680pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32681more discussion.
32682.endlist
32683
32684
32685
32686.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32687.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32688No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32689The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32690recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32691to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32692message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32693terminates.
32694
32695Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32696data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32697connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32698one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32699
32700If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32701in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32702.code
32703store_pool = POOL_PERM
32704.endd
32705before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32706restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32707the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32708set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32709
32710The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32711&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32712There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32713block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32714&%store_pool%&.
32715.ecindex IIDlosca
32716
32717
32718
32719
32720. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32721. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32722
32723.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32724.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32725.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32726.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32727The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32728that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32729also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32730they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32731
32732The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32733is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32734It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32735commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32736The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32737
32738The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32739is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32740the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32741If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32742of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32743prevent it happening on retries.
32744
32745.vindex "&$domain$&"
32746.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32747&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32748specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32749&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32750you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32751independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32752described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32753
32754
32755.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32756.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32757.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32758The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32759setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32760other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32761&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32762.code
32763system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32764system_filter_user = exim
32765.endd
32766If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32767&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32768specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32769&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32770&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32771by the &%reply%& command.
32772
32773
32774.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32775You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32776filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32777are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32778
32779If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32780you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32781
32782
32783
32784.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32785The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32786files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32787mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32788available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32789If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32790they cause errors.
32791
32792.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32793There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32794files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32795is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32796&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32797subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32798manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32799
32800&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32801specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32802succeed, it will not be tried again.
32803If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32804arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32805
32806When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32807&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32808users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32809to which users' filter files can refer.
32810
32811
32812
32813.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32814.vindex "&$recipients$&"
32815The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32816of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32817filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32818
32819
32820
32821.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32822.cindex "freezing messages"
32823.cindex "message" "freezing"
32824.cindex "message" "forced failure"
32825.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32826.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32827.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32828There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32829always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32830filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32831for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32832word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32833.code
32834fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32835.endd
32836The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32837
32838The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32839message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32840and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32841delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32842that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32843run.
32844
32845The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32846not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32847filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32848is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32849
32850.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32851.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32852The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32853well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32854up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32855log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32856two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32857strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32858message. For example:
32859.code
32860fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32861 because it contains attachments that we are \
32862 not prepared to receive."
32863.endd
32864
32865.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32866Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32867the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32868the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32869command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32870Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32871use, for example
32872.code
32873if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32874then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32875.endd
32876though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32877alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32878generated by the filter.
32879
32880The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32881&%defer%&,
32882&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32883set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32884as
32885.code
32886mail ...
32887freeze
32888.endd
32889to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32890failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32891take place.
32892
32893
32894
32895.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32896.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32897.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32898.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32899Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32900.code
32901headers add <string>
32902headers remove <string>
32903.endd
32904The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32905added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32906filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32907space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32908forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32909
32910You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32911continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32912including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32913example:
32914.code
32915headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32916 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32917 X-header-2: ...."
32918.endd
32919Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32920be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32921space after input continuations is ignored.
32922
32923The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32924This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32925those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32926&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32927header with the same name, they are all removed.
32928
32929The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32930of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32931from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32932modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32933Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32934used for all recipients of the message.
32935
32936During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32937header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32938that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32939routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32940routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32941until the message is actually being written (see section
32942&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32943
32944If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32945added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32946present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32947present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32948message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32949conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32950modified more than once.
32951
32952Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32953use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32954For example:
32955.code
32956headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32957headers remove "Subject"
32958headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32959headers remove "Old-Subject"
32960.endd
32961
32962
32963
32964.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32965.cindex "envelope sender"
32966In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32967.code
32968errors_to <some address>
32969.endd
32970in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32971delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32972user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32973might use
32974.code
32975unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32976.endd
32977to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32978address if its delivery failed.
32979
32980
32981
32982.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32983.vindex "&$domain$&"
32984.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32985In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32986delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32987operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32988such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32989filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32990which implements such a filter:
32991.code
32992central_filter:
32993 check_local_user
32994 driver = redirect
32995 domains = +local_domains
32996 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32997 no_verify
32998 allow_filter
32999 allow_freeze
33000.endd
33001The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33002&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33003the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33004use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33005
33006Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33007specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33008its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33009address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33010normal way.
33011.ecindex IIDsysfil1
33012.ecindex IIDsysfil2
33013.ecindex IIDsysfil3
33014
33015
33016
33017
33018
33019
33020. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33021. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33022
33023.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33024.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33025Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33026all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33027these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33028this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33029removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33030before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33031
33032Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33033&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33034that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33035its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33036set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33037
33038&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33039or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33040loopback interface specially in any way.
33041
33042If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33043that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33044
33045
33046
33047
33048.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33049.cindex "message" "submission"
33050.cindex "submission mode"
33051Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33052&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33053received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33054state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33055.code
33056control = submission
33057.endd
33058in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33059&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33060a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33061known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33062example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33063interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33064.code
33065warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33066 control = submission
33067.endd
33068.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33069There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33070is used to separate options. For example:
33071.code
33072control = submission/sender_retain
33073.endd
33074Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33075true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33076of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33077the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33078authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33079&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33080attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33081
33082When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33083domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33084example:
33085.code
33086control = submission/domain=some.domain
33087.endd
33088The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33089&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33090that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33091&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33092.code
33093accept authenticated = *
33094 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33095 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33096 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33097.endd
33098Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33099option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33100the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33101.code
33102bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33103.endd
33104then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33105line would be:
33106.code
33107Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33108.endd
33109.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33110By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33111used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33112specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33113
33114&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33115ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33116untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33117specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33118does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33119spoof another's address.
33120
33121.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33122.cindex "line endings"
33123.cindex "carriage return"
33124.cindex "linefeed"
33125RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33126linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33127SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33128conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33129use CRLF or just CR.
33130
33131Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33132using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33133receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33134Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33135MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33136has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33137that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33138other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33139follows:
33140
33141.ilist
33142LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33143.next
33144CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33145is ignored.
33146.next
33147The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33148nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33149terminator.
33150.next
33151If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33152the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33153is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33154people trying to play silly games.
33155.next
33156If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33157bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33158line.
33159.endlist
33160
33161
33162
33163
33164
33165.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33166.cindex "unqualified addresses"
33167.cindex "address" "qualification"
33168By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33169host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33170SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33171messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33172requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33173
33174Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33175sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33176&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33177cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33178value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33179
33180.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33181.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33182Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33183that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33184line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33185are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33186other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33187&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33188
33189
33190
33191
33192.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33193.cindex "&""From""& line"
33194.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33195.cindex "sender" "address"
33196.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33197.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33198.cindex "envelope sender"
33199.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33200Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33201with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33202&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33203.code
33204From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33205From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33206.endd
33207This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33208Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33209via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33210such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33211&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33212and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33213regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33214default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33215that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33216
33217.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33218When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33219a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33220contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33221then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33222qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33223the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33224
33225If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33226sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33227that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33228
33229Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33230treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33231as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33232incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33233
33234
33235
33236.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33237.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33238RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33239&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33240recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33241&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33242&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33243
33244.blockquote
33245&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33246processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33247.endblockquote
33248
33249This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33250address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33251follows:
33252
33253.ilist
33254A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33255is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33256.next
33257If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33258&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33259&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33260.next
33261For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33262also removed.
33263.next
33264For a locally-submitted message,
33265if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33266&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33267the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33268included in log lines in this case.
33269.next
33270The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33271&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33272.endlist
33273
33274
33275
33276
33277.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33278Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33279includes the header line:
33280.code
33281Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33282.endd
33283
33284.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33285.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33286If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33287message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33288extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33289existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33290
33291
33292.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33293.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33294If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33295Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33296&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33297
33298.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33299.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33300.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33301&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33302set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33303the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33304in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33305set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33306messages.
33307
33308
33309.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33310.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33311.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33312&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33313Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33314generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33315messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33316(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33317messages.
33318
33319
33320.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33321.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33322.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33323.cindex "message" "submission"
33324.cindex "submission mode"
33325If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33326adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33327
33328.ilist
33329The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33330message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33331.next
33332.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33333The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33334.olist
33335.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33336If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33337&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33338.next
33339If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33340part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33341.next
33342If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33343&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33344.endlist
33345.endlist
33346
33347A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33348
33349If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33350line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33351containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33352are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33353They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33354&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33355&%qualify_domain%&.
33356
33357For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33358&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33359user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33360name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33361
33362
33363.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33364.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33365.cindex "message" "submission"
33366.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33367If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33368&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33369&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33370to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33371creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33372message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33373followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33374in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33375&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33376
33377
33378.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33379.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33380A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33381contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33382Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33383
33384The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33385have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33386line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33387that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33388
33389Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33390changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33391-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33392
33393
33394.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33395.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33396Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33397header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33398section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33399header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33400responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33401processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33402than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33403incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3340411 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33405
33406
33407
33408.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33409.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33410.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33411&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33412it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33413transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33414transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33415default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33416
33417
33418
33419.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33420.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33421.cindex "message" "submission"
33422For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33423existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33424these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33425&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33426control setting.
33427
33428When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33429&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33430control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33431&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33432that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33433&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33434be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33435appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33436line is added to the message.
33437
33438If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33439the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33440&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33441options true at the same time.
33442
33443.cindex "submission mode"
33444By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33445received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33446a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33447not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33448
33449.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33450First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33451authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33452created as follows:
33453
33454.ilist
33455.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33456If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33457&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33458.next
33459If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33460is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33461.next
33462If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33463&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33464.endlist
33465
33466This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33467are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33468added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33469by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33470
33471.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33472&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33473the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33474except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33475
33476
33477
33478.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33479 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33480.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33481.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33482When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33483specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33484process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33485modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33486as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33487
33488In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33489specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33490addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33491changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33492transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33493they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33494
33495&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33496the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33497expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33498
33499For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33500option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33501newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33502.code
33503headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33504 X-added-second: another added header line
33505.endd
33506Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33507
33508Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33509specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33510Each header-line is separately expanded.
33511
33512The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33513list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33514often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33515not part of the names. For example:
33516.code
33517headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33518.endd
33519
33520Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33521specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33522Each item is separately expanded.
33523Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33524form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33525will act as list separators.
33526
33527When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33528items are expanded at routing time,
33529and then associated with all addresses that are
33530accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33531an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33532forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33533
33534.oindex "&%unseen%&"
33535However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33536the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33537&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33538
33539Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33540settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33541dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33542requirements.
33543
33544The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33545with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33546these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33547recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33548consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33549names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33550instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33551
33552After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33553lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33554the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33555header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33556
33557This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33558the following consequences:
33559
33560.ilist
33561The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33562remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33563to it, at all times.
33564.next
33565Header lines that are added by a router's
33566&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33567expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33568.next
33569Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33570in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33571.next
33572Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33573a later router or by a transport.
33574.next
33575An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33576removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33577.code
33578headers_remove = subject
33579headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33580.endd
33581.endlist
33582
33583&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33584for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33585
33586
33587
33588
33589
33590.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33591.cindex "address" "constructed"
33592.cindex "constructed address"
33593When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33594the form
33595.display
33596<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33597.endd
33598For example:
33599.code
33600Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33601.endd
33602The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33603otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33604&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33605ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33606upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33607&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33608The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33609there is no password file entry.
33610
33611.cindex "RFC 2047"
33612In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33613parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33614characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33615including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33616&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33617characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33618&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33619is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33620
33621
33622
33623.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33624.cindex "case of local parts"
33625.cindex "local part" "case of"
33626RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33627be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33628addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33629because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33630routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33631original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33632router option.
33633
33634.cindex "mixed-case login names"
33635If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33636assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33637your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33638correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33639.code
33640correct_case:
33641 driver = redirect
33642 domains = +local_domains
33643 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33644 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33645 @$domain
33646.endd
33647For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33648(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33649up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33650on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33651local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33652
33653
33654
33655.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33656.cindex "dot" "in local part"
33657.cindex "local part" "dots in"
33658RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33659part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33660middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33661empty components for compatibility.
33662
33663
33664
33665.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33666.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33667Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33668happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33669in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33670&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33671
33672Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33673in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33674routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33675example, a header such as
33676.code
33677To: hare@teaparty
33678.endd
33679might get rewritten as
33680.code
33681To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33682.endd
33683Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33684does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33685been routed.
33686
33687Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33688addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33689result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33690deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33691immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33692routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33693.ecindex IIDmesproc
33694
33695
33696
33697. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33698. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33699
33700.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33701.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33702.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33703Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33704LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33705closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33706processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33707
33708.ilist
33709SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33710.next
33711SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33712.next
33713Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33714.endlist
33715
33716For mail delivery, the following are available:
33717
33718.ilist
33719SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33720.next
33721LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33722&"lmtp"&);
33723.next
33724LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33725transport);
33726.next
33727Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33728the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33729.endlist
33730
33731&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33732stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33733used to contain the envelope information.
33734
33735
33736
33737.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33738.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33739.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33740.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33741.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33742.cindex "EHLO"
33743.cindex "HELO"
33744.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33745Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33746The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33747processing is the same in both cases.
33748
33749If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33750parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33751command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33752&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33753such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33754.cindex "transport" "filter"
33755.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33756transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33757suppressed.
33758
33759If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33760pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33761required for the transaction.
33762
33763If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33764was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33765server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33766Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33767is called for verification.
33768
33769If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33770the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33771in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33772
33773.cindex "carriage return"
33774.cindex "linefeed"
33775Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33776LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33777order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33778line terminator.
33779
33780If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33781characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33782same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33783even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33784of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33785they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33786each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33787in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33788significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33789
33790When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33791message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33792records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33793particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33794
33795.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33796Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33797a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33798See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33799
33800.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33801.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33802When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33803looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33804messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33805creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33806a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33807so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33808does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33809turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33810
33811The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33812limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33813
33814.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33815The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33816identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33817square bracket of the IP address.
33818
33819
33820
33821
33822.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33823.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33824.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33825.cindex "host" "error"
33826Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33827message errors, and recipient errors.
33828
33829.vlist
33830.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33831A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33832particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33833
33834.ilist
33835Connection refused or timed out,
33836.next
33837Any error response code on connection,
33838.next
33839Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33840.next
33841Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33842.next
33843I/O errors at any time,
33844.next
33845Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33846the &"."& at the end of the data.
33847.endlist ilist
33848
33849For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33850EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33851error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33852host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33853the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33854alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33855host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33856made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33857
33858.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33859.cindex "message" "error"
33860A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33861particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33862message errors are:
33863
33864.ilist
33865Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33866the data,
33867.next
33868Timeout after MAIL,
33869.next
33870Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33871timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33872connection at any other time.
33873.endlist ilist
33874
33875For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33876to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33877temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33878addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33879a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33880message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33881that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33882time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33883affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33884it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33885
33886If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33887to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33888over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33889response to MAIL.
33890
33891.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33892.cindex "recipient" "error"
33893A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33894recipient errors are:
33895
33896.ilist
33897Any error response to RCPT,
33898.next
33899Timeout after RCPT.
33900.endlist
33901
33902For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33903recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33904sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33905address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33906used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33907routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33908operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33909to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33910if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33911(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33912have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33913the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33914the retry clock is reset.
33915
33916The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33917host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33918other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33919in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33920proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33921than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33922if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33923through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33924recipient's retry time.
33925.endlist
33926
33927In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33928current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33929tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33930own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33931until the next delivery attempt.
33932
33933Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33934MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33935would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33936host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33937What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33938is created.
33939
33940The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33941these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33942procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33943response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33944it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33945message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33946helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33947
33948Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33949host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33950or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33951the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33952then to be treated as a host error.
33953
33954There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33955terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33956reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33957should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33958host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33959
33960
33961
33962
33963.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33964.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33965.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33966.cindex "inetd"
33967.cindex "daemon"
33968Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33969listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33970&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33971.code
33972smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33973.endd
33974Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33975agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33976a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33977the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33978with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33979stream and exits with an error code.
33980
33981By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33982disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33983unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33984&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33985
33986.cindex "carriage return"
33987.cindex "linefeed"
33988Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33989LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33990order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33991line terminator.
33992Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33993sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33994sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33995
33996.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33997.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33998One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33999HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34000commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34001the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34002Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34003match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34004
34005.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34006.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34007The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34008a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34009&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34010false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34011&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34012value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34013message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34014
34015When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34016its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34017logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34018
34019The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34020prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34021number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34022&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34023rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34024
34025The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34026subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34027for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34028things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34029processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34030sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34031it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34032
34033When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34034and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34035high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34036&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34037applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34038
34039Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34040can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34041&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34042number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34043SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34044&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34045subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34046a delivery process.
34047
34048The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34049&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34050started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34051handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34052however, available with &'inetd'&.
34053
34054Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34055are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34056to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34057section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34058
34059Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34060MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34061&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34062
34063
34064
34065.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34066.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34067If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34068commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34069the error response to the last command. The default value for
34070&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34071abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34072circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34073
34074
34075.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34076.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34077.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34078A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34079something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34080address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34081sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34082&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34083drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34084default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34085broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34086
34087
34088
34089.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34090.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34091The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34092DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34093many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34094denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34095client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34096defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34097
34098When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34099allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34100but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34101or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34102starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34103counted.
34104
34105The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34106STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34107RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34108
34109You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34110&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34111&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34112the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34113specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34114
34115
34116
34117
34118.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34119When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34120runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34121appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34122
34123.new
34124.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34125When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34126setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34127(with a 252 SMTP response code)
34128in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34129.wen
34130When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34131called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34132SMTP response codes.
34133
34134.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34135If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34136When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34137EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34138than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34139as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34140of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34141VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34142RCPT failures.
34143
34144
34145
34146.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34147.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34148RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34149overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34150disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34151the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34152should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34153
34154The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34155delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34156the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34157text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34158specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34159the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34160argument. For example,
34161.code
34162ETRN #brigadoon
34163.endd
34164runs the command
34165.code
34166exim -R brigadoon
34167.endd
34168which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34169containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34170default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34171for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34172a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34173
34174.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34175Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34176record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34177the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34178the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34179a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34180left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34181Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34182
34183.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34184For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34185used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34186whatever the form of its argument. For
34187example:
34188.code
34189smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34190 $sender_host_address
34191.endd
34192.vindex "&$domain$&"
34193The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34194expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34195and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34196wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34197under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34198for it to change them before running the command.
34199
34200
34201
34202.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34203.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34204Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34205standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34206line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34207&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34208messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34209sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34210an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34211identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34212runs for RCPT commands:
34213.code
34214accept hosts = :
34215.endd
34216This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34217
34218
34219
34220.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34221.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34222.cindex "batched SMTP output"
34223Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34224batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34225be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34226delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34227envelope along with the message.
34228
34229The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34230MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34231the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34232HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34233can be used to specify it.
34234
34235Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34236one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34237to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34238this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34239chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34240
34241.vindex "&$host$&"
34242When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34243sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34244transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34245router:
34246.code
34247begin routers
34248route_append:
34249 driver = manualroute
34250 transport = smtp_appendfile
34251 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34252
34253begin transports
34254smtp_appendfile:
34255 driver = appendfile
34256 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34257 batch_max = 1000
34258 use_bsmtp
34259 user = exim
34260.endd
34261This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34262format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34263message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34264
34265
34266
34267.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34268.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34269.cindex "batched SMTP input"
34270The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34271reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34272is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34273sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34274rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34275and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34276as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34277
34278Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34279ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34280
34281If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34282the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34283standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34284make some use of automatically, for example:
34285.code
34286554 Unexpected end of file
34287Transaction started in line 10
34288Error detected in line 14
34289.endd
34290It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34291file, for example:
34292.code
34293An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34294The error message was:
34295
34296501 '>' missing at end of address
34297
34298The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34299The error was detected in line 12.
34300The SMTP command at fault was:
34301
34302rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34303
343041 previous message was successfully processed.
34305The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34306.endd
34307The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34308messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34309accepted.
34310.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34311.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34312
34313
34314
34315. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34316. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34317
34318.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34319 "Customizing messages"
34320When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34321configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34322to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34323the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34324string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34325
34326The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34327cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34328option. Exim also adds the line
34329.code
34330Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34331.endd
34332to all warning and bounce messages,
34333
34334
34335.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34336.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34337.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34338If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34339message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34340delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34341&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34342
34343When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34344constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34345separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34346opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34347logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34348item.
34349
34350.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34351.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34352Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34353expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34354the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34355&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34356option, rounded to a whole number.
34357
34358The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34359
34360.ilist
34361The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34362&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34363.next
34364The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34365failing addresses with their error messages.
34366.next
34367The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34368returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34369.next
34370The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34371The fields exist for back-compatibility
34372.endlist
34373
34374The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34375following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34376other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34377.code
34378Subject: Mail delivery failed
34379 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34380 {: returning message to sender}}
34381****
34382This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34383
34384A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34385 {that you sent }{sent by
34386
34387<$sender_address>
34388
34389}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34390This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34391****
34392The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34393****
34394------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34395 ------
34396****
34397------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34398 only the first
34399------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34400****
34401.endd
34402.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34403.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34404.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34405The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34406warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34407text sections:
34408
34409.ilist
34410The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34411&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34412.next
34413The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34414the delayed addresses.
34415.next
34416The third item then ends the message.
34417.endlist
34418
34419The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34420have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34421.code
34422Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34423 $warn_message_delay
34424****
34425This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34426
34427A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34428{that you sent }{sent by
34429
34430<$sender_address>
34431
34432}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34433more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34434
34435The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34436The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34437The date of the message is: $h_date
34438
34439The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34440****
34441No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34442continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34443intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34444mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34445the message will be returned to you.
34446.endd
34447.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34448.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34449However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34450appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34451&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34452minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34453of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34454multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34455handled them.
34456
34457
34458
34459
34460. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34461. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34462
34463.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34464This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34465common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34466
34467
34468
34469.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34470.cindex "smart host" "example router"
34471If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34472should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34473routing explicitly:
34474.code
34475send_to_smart_host:
34476 driver = manualroute
34477 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34478 transport = remote_smtp
34479.endd
34480You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34481If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34482receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34483synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34484&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34485
34486
34487
34488
34489.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34490.cindex "mailing lists"
34491Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34492requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34493Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34494
34495The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34496is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34497independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34498lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34499.code
34500lists:
34501 driver = redirect
34502 domains = lists.example
34503 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34504 forbid_pipe
34505 forbid_file
34506 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34507 no_more
34508.endd
34509This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34510in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34511such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34512routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34513
34514The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34515expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34516a mailing list.
34517
34518.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34519The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34520taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34521original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34522the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34523
34524For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34525&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34526&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34527&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34528There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34529the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34530such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34531or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34532&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34533
34534
34535
34536.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34537.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34538If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34539delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34540list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34541list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34542addresses are not rigorously checked.
34543
34544If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34545entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34546&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34547whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34548&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34549
34550
34551
34552.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34553.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34554Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34555in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34556recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34557cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34558delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34559account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34560the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34561message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34562
34563If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34564on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34565router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34566&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34567&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34568subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34569failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34570pre-existing messages.
34571
34572The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34573addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34574addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34575&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34576one level of expansion anyway.
34577
34578
34579
34580.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34581.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34582The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34583send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34584from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34585&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34586
34587The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34588of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34589.code
34590lists_request:
34591 driver = redirect
34592 domains = lists.example
34593 local_part_suffix = -request
34594 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34595 no_more
34596
34597lists_post:
34598 driver = redirect
34599 domains = lists.example
34600 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34601 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34602 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34603 forbid_pipe
34604 forbid_file
34605 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34606 no_more
34607
34608lists_closed:
34609 driver = redirect
34610 domains = lists.example
34611 allow_fail
34612 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34613.endd
34614All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34615they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34616&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34617mailing list.
34618
34619The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34620checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34621checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34622necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34623because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34624not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34625means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34626&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34627&"unrouteable address"& error.
34628
34629The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34630a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34631the address, giving a suitable error message.
34632
34633
34634
34635
34636.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34637.cindex "VERP"
34638.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34639.cindex "envelope sender"
34640Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34641are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34642address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34643the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34644if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34645original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34646
34647.oindex &%errors_to%&
34648.oindex &%return_path%&
34649Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34650facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34651list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34652these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34653host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34654of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34655of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34656.code
34657verp_smtp:
34658 driver = smtp
34659 max_rcpt = 1
34660 return_path = \
34661 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34662 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34663.endd
34664This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34665SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34666&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34667local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34668example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34669&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34670&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34671rewritten as
34672.code
34673somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34674.endd
34675.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34676For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34677have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34678achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34679might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34680&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34681
34682Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34683probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34684extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34685can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34686.code
34687dnslookup:
34688 driver = dnslookup
34689 domains = ! +local_domains
34690 transport = \
34691 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34692 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34693 no_more
34694.endd
34695If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34696of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34697routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34698errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34699address.
34700
34701On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34702&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34703SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34704and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34705of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34706.code
34707verp_dnslookup:
34708 driver = dnslookup
34709 domains = ! +local_domains
34710 transport = remote_smtp
34711 errors_to = \
34712 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34713 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34714 no_more
34715.endd
34716Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34717configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34718Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34719router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34720them.
34721
34722The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34723message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34724host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34725a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34726a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34727than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34728used).
34729
34730
34731
34732
34733
34734
34735.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34736.cindex "virtual domains"
34737.cindex "domain" "virtual"
34738The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34739meanings:
34740
34741.ilist
34742A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34743aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34744top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34745.next
34746One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34747with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34748have login accounts on that host.
34749.endlist
34750
34751The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34752the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34753aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34754virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34755whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34756to a router of this form:
34757.code
34758virtual:
34759 driver = redirect
34760 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34761 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34762 no_more
34763.endd
34764The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34765is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34766domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34767part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34768setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34769string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34770
34771This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34772follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34773can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34774a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34775
34776The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34777way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34778valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34779.code
34780my_domains:
34781 driver = accept
34782 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34783 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34784 transport = my_mailboxes
34785.endd
34786The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34787can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34788file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34789option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34790because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34791follows:
34792.code
34793my_mailboxes:
34794 driver = appendfile
34795 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34796 user = mail
34797.endd
34798This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34799required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34800
34801The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34802requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34803up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34804information about the domains.
34805
34806
34807
34808.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34809.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34810.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34811.cindex "local part" "prefix"
34812.cindex "local part" "suffix"
34813Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34814incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34815allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34816identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34817parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34818&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34819example, consider this router:
34820.code
34821userforward:
34822 driver = redirect
34823 check_local_user
34824 file = $home/.forward
34825 local_part_suffix = -*
34826 local_part_suffix_optional
34827 allow_filter
34828.endd
34829.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34830It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34831&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34832cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34833.code
34834if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34835save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34836endif
34837.endd
34838If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34839fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34840&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34841control over which suffixes are valid.
34842
34843Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34844&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34845another MTA:
34846.code
34847userforward:
34848 driver = redirect
34849 check_local_user
34850 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34851 local_part_suffix = -*
34852 local_part_suffix_optional
34853 allow_filter
34854.endd
34855If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34856example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34857does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34858subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34859&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34860
34861
34862
34863.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34864.cindex "vacation processing"
34865The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34866a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34867(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34868This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34869that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34870
34871.ilist
34872A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34873can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34874alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34875&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34876.code
34877spqr, vacation-spqr
34878.endd
34879.next
34880The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34881vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34882user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34883ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34884to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34885message.
34886.endlist
34887
34888Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34889use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34890
34891
34892
34893.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34894.cindex "message" "copying every"
34895Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34896be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34897command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34898each day's messages.
34899
34900There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34901messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34902delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34903notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34904
34905
34906
34907.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34908.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34909It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34910Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34911arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34912permanently connected.
34913
34914Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34915particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34916Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34917
34918
34919.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34920It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34921host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34922approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34923being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34924some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34925to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34926resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34927
34928A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34929intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34930into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34931format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34932destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34933in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34934if required.
34935
34936On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34937you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34938intermittent host. For example:
34939.code
34940cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34941.endd
34942This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34943which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34944online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34945options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34946causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34947connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34948immediately.
34949
34950If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34951issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34952mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34953used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34954avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34955Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34956arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34957
34958
34959
34960.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34961The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34962increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34963connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34964delivered immediately.
34965
34966.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34967.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34968.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34969Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34970not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34971possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34972each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34973avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34974&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34975first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34976normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34977destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34978single SMTP connection.
34979
34980
34981
34982. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34984
34985.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34986 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34987.cindex "client, non-queueing"
34988.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34989On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34990email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34991configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34992However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34993configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34994&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34995messages this way.
34996
34997If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34998run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34999any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35000continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35001email is not desirable.
35002
35003There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35004&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35005any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35006host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35007informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35008to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35009to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35010
35011There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35012that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35013ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35014before sending a message to the smart host.
35015
35016Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35017tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35018overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35019
35020.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35021There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35022Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35023assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35024just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35025compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35026router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35027
35028When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35029following ways:
35030
35031.ilist
35032A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35033In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35034.next
35035Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35036assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35037&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35038does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35039successful, a zero return code is given.
35040.next
35041Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35042be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35043the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35044must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35045deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35046are.
35047.next
35048If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35049failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35050successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35051.next
35052Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35053is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35054smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35055the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35056there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35057.next
35058If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35059connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35060failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35061.next
35062When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35063(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35064value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35065are ever generated.
35066.next
35067No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35068.next
35069A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35070true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35071&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35072.endlist
35073
35074The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35075the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35076deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35077privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35078to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35079the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35080
35081
35082
35083
35084. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35085. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35086
35087.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35088.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35089.cindex "log" "types of"
35090Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35091and the panic log:
35092
35093.ilist
35094.cindex "main log"
35095The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35096line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35097down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35098out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35099them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35100they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35101analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35102&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35103.next
35104.cindex "reject log"
35105The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35106of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35107The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35108the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35109is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35110lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35111reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35112host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35113can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35114false.
35115.next
35116.cindex "panic log"
35117.cindex "system log"
35118When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35119error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35120are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35121other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35122therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35123regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35124panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35125is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35126message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35127.endlist
35128
35129Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35130example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35131In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35132.code
351332001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35134 by QUIT
35135.endd
35136By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35137ways of changing this:
35138
35139.ilist
35140You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35141you set
35142.code
35143timezone = UTC
35144.endd
35145the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35146.next
35147If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35148example:
35149.code
351502003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35151.endd
35152.endlist
35153
35154.cindex "log" "process ids in"
35155.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35156Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35157request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35158&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35159brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35160
35161
35162
35163
35164.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35165.cindex "log" "destination"
35166.cindex "log" "to file"
35167.cindex "log" "to syslog"
35168.cindex "syslog"
35169The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35170should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35171are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35172arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35173It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35174need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35175Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35176
35177The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35178&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35179configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35180references to the host name:
35181.code
35182log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35183.endd
35184It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35185rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35186start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35187before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35188configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35189log at all.
35190
35191The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35192list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35193facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35194colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35195otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35196point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35197implying the use of a default path.
35198
35199When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35200LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35201&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35202mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35203files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35204equivalent to the setting:
35205.code
35206log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35207.endd
35208If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35209or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35210that is where the logs are written.
35211
35212A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35213are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35214
35215Here are some examples of possible settings:
35216.display
35217&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35218&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35219&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35220&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35221.endd
35222If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35223error is logged.
35224
35225
35226
35227.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35228.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35229.cindex "cycling logs"
35230.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35231.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35232Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35233log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35234provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35235main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35236keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35237
35238An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35239and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35240example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35241message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35242that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35243something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35244ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35245&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35246does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35247tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35248for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35249renamed.
35250
35251
35252
35253.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35254.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35255Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35256periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35257for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35258&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35259the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35260point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35261.code
35262log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35263log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35264log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35265log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35266.endd
35267As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35268examples of names generated by the above examples:
35269.code
35270/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35271/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35272/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35273/var/log/exim/main.200212
35274.endd
35275When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35276files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35277will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35278run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35279
35280The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35281is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35282When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35283the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35284non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35285character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35286log names:
35287.code
35288/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35289/var/log/exim-panic.log
35290/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35291/var/log/exim/panic
35292.endd
35293
35294
35295.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35296.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35297The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35298except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35299Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35300that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35301&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35302by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35303&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35304SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35305&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35306LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35307the time and host name to each line.
35308The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35309
35310.ilist
35311&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35312.next
35313&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35314.next
35315&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35316.endlist
35317
35318Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35319written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35320these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35321by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35322
35323Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35324entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35325these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35326calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35327870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35328additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35329replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35330RFC 3164, you should set
35331.code
35332SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35333.endd
35334in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35335lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35336
35337To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35338entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35339where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35340components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35341because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35342delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35343870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35344&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35345name, and pid as added by syslog:
35346.code
35347[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35348[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35349[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35350[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35351[5/5] mple>)
35352.endd
35353The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35354(LOG_NOTICE):
35355.code
35356[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35357[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35358[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35359[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35360[5\18] .example>)
35361[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35362[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35363[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35364[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35365[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35366[11\18] 09:43 +0100
35367[12\18] F From: <>
35368[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35369[18\18] X-something: this is another header
35370[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35371[16\18] le>
35372[17\18] B Bcc:
35373[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35374.endd
35375Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35376without modification.
35377
35378If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35379display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35380the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35381where it is.
35382
35383
35384
35385.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35386One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35387successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35388picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35389timestamp. The flags are:
35390.display
35391&`<=`& message arrival
35392&`=>`& normal message delivery
35393&`->`& additional address in same delivery
35394&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35395&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35396&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35397&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35398.endd
35399
35400
35401.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35402.cindex "log" "reception line"
35403The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35404message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35405several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35406.code
354072002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35408 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35409 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35410.endd
35411The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35412bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35413generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35414.code
35415R=<message id>
35416.endd
35417which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35418
35419.cindex "HELO"
35420.cindex "EHLO"
35421For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35422record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35423received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35424host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35425above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35426&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35427by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35428verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35429EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35430name in parentheses.
35431
35432Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35433without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35434the log containing text like these examples:
35435.code
35436H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35437H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35438.endd
35439This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35440on.
35441
35442For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35443the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35444of Exim.
35445
35446.cindex "authentication" "logging"
35447.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35448For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35449message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35450of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35451extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35452session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35453suite that was used.
35454
35455.cindex log protocol
35456The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35457hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35458value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35459there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35460was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35461&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35462authenticator name.
35463
35464.cindex "size" "of message"
35465The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35466received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35467headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35468message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35469other).
35470
35471The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35472data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35473
35474
35475
35476.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35477.cindex "log" "delivery line"
35478The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35479delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35480deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35481to fit it on the page:
35482.code
354832002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35484 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
354852002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35486 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35487 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35488.endd
35489For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35490after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35491intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35492last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35493fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35494
35495If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35496followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35497If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35498option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35499
35500If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35501for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35502.display
35503&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35504.endd
35505If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35506parentheses afterwards.
35507
35508.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35509When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35510SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35511flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35512down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35513lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35514
35515.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35516.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35517When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35518line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35519rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35520
35521The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35522&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35523
35524The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35525data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35526
35527
35528.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35529.cindex "discarded messages"
35530.cindex "message" "discarded"
35531.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35532When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35533obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35534.code
355352002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35536 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35537.endd
35538is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35539because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35540.code
355411999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35542 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35543.endd
35544
35545
35546.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35547When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35548.code
355492002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35550 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35551.endd
35552In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35553last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35554written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35555.code
355562002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35557 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35558.endd
35559When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35560a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35561appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35562
35563
35564
35565.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35566.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35567If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35568following form is logged:
35569.code
355701995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35571 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35572.endd
35573If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35574the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35575.code
355762002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35577 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35578 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35579 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35580 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35581.endd
35582The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35583used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35584disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35585flagged with &`**`&.
35586
35587
35588
35589.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35590.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35591If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35592used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35593&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35594
35595
35596
35597.section "Completion" "SECID257"
35598A line of the form
35599.code
356002002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35601.endd
35602is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35603at the end of its processing.
35604
35605
35606
35607
35608.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35609.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35610A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35611the following table:
35612.display
35613&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35614&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35615&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35616&`CV `& certificate verification status
35617&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35618&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35619&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35620&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35621&`H `& host name and IP address
35622&`I `& local interface used
35623&`id `& message id for incoming message
35624&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35625&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35626&`PRX `& on &'<='& and&`=>`& lines: proxy address
35627&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35628&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35629&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35630&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35631&`S `& size of message in bytes
35632&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35633&`ST `& shadow transport name
35634&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35635&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35636&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35637&`X `& TLS cipher suite
35638.endd
35639
35640
35641.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35642Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35643self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35644
35645.ilist
35646.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35647&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35648during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35649This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35650during the first delivery attempt.
35651.next
35652&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35653temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35654for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35655.next
35656.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35657&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35658some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35659common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35660&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35661doing.
35662.next
35663.cindex "error" "ignored"
35664&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35665message:
35666.olist
35667Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35668&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35669.next
35670A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35671failed. The delivery was discarded.
35672.next
35673A delivery set up by a router configured with
35674. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35675. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35676.code
35677 errors_to = <>
35678.endd
35679failed. The delivery was discarded.
35680.endlist olist
35681.endlist ilist
35682
35683
35684
35685
35686
35687.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35688.cindex "log" "selectors"
35689By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35690default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35691&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35692example:
35693.code
35694log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35695.endd
35696The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35697selection marked by asterisks:
35698.display
35699&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35700&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35701&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35702&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35703&` arguments `& command line arguments
35704&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35705&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35706&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35707&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35708&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35709&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35710&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35711&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35712&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35713&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35714&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35715.new
35716&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35717.wen
35718&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35719&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35720&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35721&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35722&` pid `& Exim process id
35723.new
35724&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
35725.wen
35726&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35727&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35728&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35729&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35730&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35731&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35732&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35733&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35734&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35735&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35736&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35737&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35738&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35739&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35740&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35741&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35742&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35743&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35744&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35745&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35746&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35747&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35748
35749&` all `& all of the above
35750.endd
35751See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35752section &<<SECID99>>&
35753
35754More details on each of these items follows:
35755
35756.ilist
35757.cindex "8BITMIME"
35758.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35759&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35760which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35761that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35762&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35763&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35764.next
35765.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35766&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35767its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35768this log selector is set.
35769.next
35770.cindex "log" "rewriting"
35771.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35772&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35773rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35774such users cannot access the log).
35775.next
35776.cindex "log" "full parentage"
35777&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35778delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35779parentheses between them.
35780.next
35781.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35782.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35783&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35784to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35785feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35786&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35787privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35788that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35789are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35790because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35791only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35792between the caller and Exim.
35793.next
35794.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35795&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35796connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35797.next
35798.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35799.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35800&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35801started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35802messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35803process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35804.next
35805.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35806&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35807perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35808.next
35809.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35810.cindex "size" "of message"
35811&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35812the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35813.next
35814.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35815.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35816.cindex "black list (DNS)"
35817&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35818DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35819.next
35820.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35821.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35822&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35823is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35824command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35825selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35826.next
35827.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35828&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35829any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35830log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35831routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35832.next
35833.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35834.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35835&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35836client's ident port times out.
35837.next
35838.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35839.cindex "log" "local interface"
35840.cindex "log" "local address and port"
35841.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35842.cindex "interface" "logging"
35843&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35844to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35845followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35846added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35847rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35848.new
35849The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35850.wen
35851.next
35852.new
35853.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
35854.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
35855.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
35856&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
35857of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
35858on a proxied connection
35859or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection..
35860See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
35861.wen
35862.next
35863.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35864.cindex "port" "logging remote"
35865.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35866.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35867.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35868&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35869added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35870in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35871changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35872&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35873important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35874.next
35875.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35876&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35877connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35878.next
35879.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35880.cindex "log" "local interface"
35881.cindex "log" "local address and port"
35882.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35883.cindex "interface" "logging"
35884.new
35885&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35886interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35887followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35888off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35889.wen
35890.next
35891.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35892.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35893.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35894&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35895containing => tags) following the IP address.
35896.new
35897The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35898&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35899.wen
35900This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35901configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35902local port is a random ephemeral port.
35903.next
35904.cindex "log" "process ids in"
35905.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35906&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35907immediately after the time and date.
35908.next
35909.cindex "log" "queue run"
35910.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35911&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35912.next
35913.cindex "log" "queue time"
35914&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35915local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35916&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35917includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35918This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35919delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35920message has been successfully received.
35921.next
35922&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35923the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35924example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35925message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35926.next
35927.cindex "log" "recipients"
35928&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35929as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35930that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35931addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35932has taken place.
35933Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35934in the list.
35935.next
35936.cindex "log" "sender reception"
35937&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35938the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35939&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35940.next
35941.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35942&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35943rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35944log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35945rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35946.next
35947.cindex "log" "retry defer"
35948&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35949retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35950message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35951attempt.
35952.next
35953.cindex "log" "return path"
35954&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35955the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35956This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35957or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35958.next
35959.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35960&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35961and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35962This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35963necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35964.next
35965.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35966&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35967gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35968the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35969detail is lost.
35970.next
35971.cindex "log" "size rejection"
35972&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35973it is too big.
35974.next
35975.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35976.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35977&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35978queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35979it.
35980.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35981The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35982.next
35983.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35984.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35985.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35986&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35987outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35988A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35989response.
35990.next
35991.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35992.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35993&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35994established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35995&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35996only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35997processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35998dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35999not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36000of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36001
36002For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36003included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36004reset if the daemon is restarted.
36005Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36006subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36007whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36008match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36009logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36010.next
36011.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36012.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36013&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36014RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36015and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36016line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36017.next
36018.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36019.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36020&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36021connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36022the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36023does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36024an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36025already have their own log lines.
36026
36027The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36028way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36029If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36030an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36031DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36032the same logging options.
36033
36034Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36035is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36036.code
36037C=EHLO,QUIT
36038.endd
36039shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36040than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36041the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36042setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36043have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36044.next
36045&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36046colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36047log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36048was accepted or used.
36049.next
36050.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36051.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36052&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36053encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36054because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36055been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36056it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36057received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36058.next
36059.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36060.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36061.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36062.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36063.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36064&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36065encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36066external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36067using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36068.next
36069.cindex "log" "subject"
36070.cindex "subject, logging"
36071&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36072preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36073Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36074specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36075unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36076.next
36077.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36078&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36079when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36080verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36081.next
36082.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36083.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36084&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36085connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36086.next
36087.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36088.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36089&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36090connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36091added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36092.next
36093.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36094.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36095&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36096the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36097added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36098.next
36099.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36100&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36101result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36102.endlist
36103
36104
36105.section "Message log" "SECID260"
36106.cindex "message" "log file for"
36107.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36108.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36109.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36110In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36111that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36112they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36113message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36114makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36115to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36116is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36117only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36118
36119On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36120per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36121&%message_logs%& option false.
36122.ecindex IIDloggen
36123
36124
36125
36126
36127. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36128. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36129
36130.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36131.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36132A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36133described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36134the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36135
36136.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36137.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36138 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36139.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36140.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36141.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36142.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36143 various criteria"
36144.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36145.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36146 "extract statistics from the log"
36147.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36148 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36149.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36150.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36151.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36152.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36153.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36154.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36155.endtable
36156
36157Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36158&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36159&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36160
36161
36162
36163
36164.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36165.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36166.cindex "process, querying"
36167.cindex "SIGUSR1"
36168On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36169(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36170a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36171Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36172processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36173second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36174order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36175send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36176
36177&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36178use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36179script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36180
36181
36182Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36183varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36184but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36185system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36186it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36187options:
36188.display
36189&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36190&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36191&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36192&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36193.endd
36194An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36195.code
36196164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3619710483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3619810492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36199 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3620010592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3620110628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36202.endd
36203The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36204been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36205
36206
36207
36208.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36209.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36210.cindex "queue" "grepping"
36211This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36212.code
36213exim -bpu
36214.endd
36215or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36216.code
36217exim -bp
36218.endd
36219The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36220contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36221
36222to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36223that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36224
36225.vlist
36226.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36227Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36228tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36229.code
36230exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36231.endd
36232.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36233Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36234tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36235
36236.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36237Match against the size field.
36238
36239.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36240Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36241
36242.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36243Match messages that are older than the given time.
36244
36245.vitem &*-z*&
36246Match only frozen messages.
36247
36248.vitem &*-x*&
36249Match only non-frozen messages.
36250.endlist
36251
36252The following options control the format of the output:
36253
36254.vlist
36255.vitem &*-c*&
36256Display only the count of matching messages.
36257
36258.vitem &*-l*&
36259Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36260the default.
36261
36262.vitem &*-i*&
36263Display message ids only.
36264
36265.vitem &*-b*&
36266Brief format &-- one line per message.
36267
36268.vitem &*-R*&
36269Display messages in reverse order.
36270
36271.vitem &*-a*&
36272Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36273.endlist
36274
36275There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36276
36277
36278
36279.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36280.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36281.cindex "queue" "summary"
36282The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36283-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36284running a command such as
36285.code
36286exim -bp | exiqsumm
36287.endd
36288The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36289it, as in the following example:
36290.code
362913 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36292.endd
36293Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36294volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36295been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36296number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36297
36298A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36299domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36300the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36301respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36302domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36303separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36304sender.
36305
36306The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36307this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36308generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36309option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36310level"& addresses).
36311
36312
36313
36314
36315.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36316 "SECTextspeinf"
36317.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36318.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36319The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36320files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36321extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36322match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36323given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36324The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36325If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36326included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36327.display
36328&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36329.endd
36330If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36331
36332The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36333condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36334they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36335
36336By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36337makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36338large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36339option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36340case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36341
36342The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36343pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36344regular expression.
36345
36346The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36347if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36348
36349The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36350that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36351normally.
36352
36353Example of &%-M%&:
36354user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36355&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36356displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36357the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36358when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36359&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36360search term.
36361
36362If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36363ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36364whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36365If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36366autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36367
36368
36369.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36370.cindex "&'exipick'&"
36371John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36372lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36373of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36374&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36375the &%--help%& option.
36376
36377
36378.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36379.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36380.cindex "cycling logs"
36381.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36382The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36383&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36384you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36385&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36386for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36387There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36388.ilist
36389&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36390default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36391.next
36392&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36393&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36394overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36395configuration.
36396.endlist
36397
36398Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36399the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36400run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36401&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36402&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36403logs are handled similarly.
36404
36405If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36406&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36407to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36408any existing log files.
36409
36410If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36411the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36412using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36413setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36414root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36415.code
364161 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36417.endd
36418assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36419&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36420
36421
36422
36423.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36424.cindex "statistics"
36425.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36426A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36427information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36428Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36429LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36430
36431The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36432latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36433lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36434various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36435list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36436.code
36437eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36438.endd
36439By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36440messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36441both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36442are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36443addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36444options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36445also produced per user.
36446
36447The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36448histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36449hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36450example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36451as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36452
36453Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36454have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36455messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36456and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36457recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36458an entirely separate message.
36459
36460&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36461of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36462each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36463not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36464least one address that failed.
36465
36466The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36467or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36468transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36469(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36470a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36471senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36472and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36473
36474The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36475came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36476without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36477
36478There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36479outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36480by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36481.code
36482perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36483.endd
36484
36485.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36486.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36487.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36488.cindex "checking access"
36489The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36490debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36491policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36492familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36493sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36494access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36495
36496The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36497two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36498.code
36499exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36500.endd
36501The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36502given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36503connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36504is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36505.code
36506Rejected:
36507550 Relay not permitted
36508.endd
36509When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36510for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36511options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36512that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36513you can use:
36514.code
36515exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36516 -f himself@there.example
36517.endd
36518Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36519mandatory arguments.
36520
36521Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36522while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36523&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36524
36525
36526
36527.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36528.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36529.cindex "building DBM files"
36530.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36531.cindex "lower casing"
36532.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36533The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36534the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36535&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36536names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36537can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36538
36539A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36540the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36541&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36542strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36543files.
36544
36545The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36546single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36547It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36548well.
36549
36550.cindex "USE_DB"
36551If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36552configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36553names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36554a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36555.code
36556exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36557.endd
36558reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36559&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36560
36561In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36562Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36563environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36564&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36565when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36566recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36567
36568If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36569finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36570option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36571this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36572&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36573There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36574&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36575return code is 2.
36576
36577
36578
36579
36580.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36581.cindex "retry" "times"
36582.cindex "&'exinext'&"
36583A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36584fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36585complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36586information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36587is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36588output. For example:
36589.code
36590$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36591kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36592 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36593 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36594 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36595roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36596 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36597 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36598 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36599 past final cutoff time
36600.endd
36601You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36602will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36603A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36604message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36605suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36606&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36607run very often.
36608
36609The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36610of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36611passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36612configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36613file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36614environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36615
36616
36617
36618.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36619.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36620.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36621Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36622uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36623arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36624second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36625
36626.ilist
36627&'retry'&: the database of retry information
36628.next
36629&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36630for remote hosts
36631.next
36632&'callout'&: the callout cache
36633.next
36634&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36635.next
36636&'misc'&: other hints data
36637.endlist
36638
36639The &'misc'& database is used for
36640
36641.ilist
36642Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36643.next
36644Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36645&(smtp)& transport)
36646.next
36647Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36648in a transport)
36649.endlist
36650
36651
36652
36653.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36654.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36655The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36656&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36657spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36658.code
36659exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36660.endd
36661Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36662.code
36663T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3666431-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36665.endd
36666The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36667of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36668transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36669a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36670address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36671transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36672to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36673and a textual description of the error.
36674
36675The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36676the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36677ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36678exceeded.
36679
36680Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36681consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36682waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36683one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36684may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36685may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36686cross-references.
36687
36688
36689
36690.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36691.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36692The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36693database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36694days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36695updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36696since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36697for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36698updated sufficiently often.
36699
36700The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36701followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36702the retry database:
36703.code
36704exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36705.endd
36706Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36707message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36708they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36709are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36710types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36711message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36712queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36713&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36714For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36715removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36716whenever it removes information from the database.
36717
36718Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36719needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36720down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36721first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36722records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36723
36724It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36725hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36726a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36727work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36728but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36729After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36730point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36731tidied.
36732
36733&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36734databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36735
36736
36737
36738
36739.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36740.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36741The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36742Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36743getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36744is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36745key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36746displayed.
36747
36748If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36749except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36750out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36751data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36752by new data, for example:
36753.code
36754> 4 951102:1000
36755.endd
36756resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36757sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36758used as optional separators.
36759
36760
36761
36762
36763.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36764.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36765.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36766.cindex "locking mailboxes"
36767The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36768Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36769&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36770a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36771the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36772argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36773second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36774is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36775is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36776
36777.vlist
36778.vitem &%-fcntl%&
36779Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36780
36781.vitem &%-flock%&
36782Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36783supports it.
36784
36785.vitem &%-interval%&
36786This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36787interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36788
36789.vitem &%-lockfile%&
36790Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36791
36792.vitem &%-mbx%&
36793Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36794
36795.vitem &%-q%&
36796Suppress verification output.
36797
36798.vitem &%-retries%&
36799This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36800the lock (default 10).
36801
36802.vitem &%-restore_time%&
36803This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36804locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36805example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36806subsequently sees.
36807
36808.vitem &%-timeout%&
36809This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36810timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36811default), a non-blocking call is used.
36812
36813.vitem &%-v%&
36814Generate verbose output.
36815.endlist
36816
36817If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36818default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36819mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36820&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36821requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36822file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36823more than 30 minutes old.
36824
36825The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36826&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36827to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36828&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36829number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36830can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36831
36832The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36833&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36834suppresses all output except error messages.
36835
36836A command such as
36837.code
36838exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36839.endd
36840runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36841.display
36842&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36843<&'some commands'&>
36844&`End`&
36845.endd
36846runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36847suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36848such as
36849.code
36850exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36851 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36852.endd
36853Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36854second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36855.ecindex IIDutils
36856
36857
36858. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36859. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36860
36861.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36862.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36863.cindex "X-windows"
36864.cindex "&'eximon'&"
36865.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36866.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36867The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36868about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36869perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36870such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36871monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36872
36873
36874
36875.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36876The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36877script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36878binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36879be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36880&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36881parameters are for.
36882
36883The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36884a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36885preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36886.code
36887EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36888.endd
36889(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36890the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36891overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36892&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36893syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36894
36895X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36896way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36897.code
36898Eximon*background: gray94
36899.endd
36900changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36901stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36902black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36903data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36904&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36905For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36906reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36907.code
36908xrdb -merge <<End
36909Eximon*highlight: gray
36910End
36911.endd
36912.cindex "admin user"
36913In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36914&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36915
36916The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36917contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36918if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36919binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36920versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36921
36922The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36923more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36924main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36925delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36926different parts of the display.
36927
36928
36929
36930
36931.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36932.cindex "stripchart"
36933The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36934be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36935&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36936configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36937it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36938hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36939received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36940period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36941parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36942
36943The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36944displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36945title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36946For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36947
36948It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36949a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36950to a single partition.
36951
36952.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36953This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36954the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36955this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36956100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36957SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36958&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36959
36960
36961
36962
36963.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36964.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36965.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36966.cindex "window size"
36967Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36968to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36969shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36970stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36971the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36972in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36973
36974When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36975currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36976size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36977remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36978
36979The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36980stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36981the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36982The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36983&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36984the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36985
36986Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36987built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36988START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36989
36990
36991
36992.section "The log display" "SECID267"
36993.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36994The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36995the main log is maintained.
36996To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36997removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36998The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36999syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37000to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37001
37002The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37003move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37004scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37005LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37006to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37007much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37008a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37009only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37010available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37011normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37012configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37013
37014Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37015and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37016respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37017It cannot go further back up the log.
37018
37019The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37020normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37021by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37022by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37023back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37024the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37025
37026Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37027There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37028the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37029happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37030&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37031^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37032
37033The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37034widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37035&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37036eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37037However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37038provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37039come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37040unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37041on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37042window.
37043
37044
37045
37046.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37047.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37048The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37049are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37050as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37051parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37052at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37053the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37054there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37055to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37056
37057When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37058and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37059with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37060pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37061type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37062such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37063of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37064
37065If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37066are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37067example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37068&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37069has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37070cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37071a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37072
37073While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37074else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37075queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37076pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37077
37078The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37079time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37080message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37081a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37082recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37083listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37084an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37085not shown.
37086
37087.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37088If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37089
37090The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37091of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37092The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37093available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37094display is updated.
37095
37096
37097
37098.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37099.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37100If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37101pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37102line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37103any selected text.
37104
37105If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37106MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37107set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37108value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37109run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37110.code
37111EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37112.endd
37113The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37114follows:
37115
37116.ilist
37117&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37118in a new text window.
37119.next
37120&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37121information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37122&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37123.next
37124&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37125displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37126amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37127option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37128.next
37129&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37130delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37131frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37132a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37133up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37134.next
37135&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37136that the message be frozen.
37137.next
37138.cindex "thawing messages"
37139.cindex "unfreezing messages"
37140.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37141&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37142that the message be thawed.
37143.next
37144.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37145&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37146that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37147for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37148.next
37149&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37150that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37151message.
37152.next
37153&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37154be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37155is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37156Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37157causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37158additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37159which case no action is taken.
37160.next
37161&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37162can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37163is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37164Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37165causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37166recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37167case no action is taken.
37168.next
37169&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37170mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37171.next
37172&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37173sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37174&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37175in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37176bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37177not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37178the address is qualified with that domain.
37179.endlist
37180
37181When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37182other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37183particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37184output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37185from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37186&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37187if no output is generated.
37188
37189The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37190thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37191&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37192force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37193
37194In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37195cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37196and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37197.ecindex IIDeximon
37198
37199
37200
37201
37202
37203. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37204. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37205
37206.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37207.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37208This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37209which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37210
37211For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37212Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37213existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37214chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37215security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37216its security as compared with other MTAs.
37217
37218What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37219have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37220absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37221as soon as possible.
37222
37223
37224.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37225.cindex "security" "build-time features"
37226There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37227to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37228Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37229penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37230
37231.ilist
37232ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37233start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37234names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37235value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37236&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37237default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37238
37239If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37240which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37241into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37242configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37243.next
37244
37245If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37246or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37247file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37248the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37249root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37250right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37251reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37252it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37253privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37254separate commands.
37255
37256.next
37257The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37258with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37259CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37260requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37261the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37262but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37263previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37264.next
37265If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37266is disabled.
37267.next
37268FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37269never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37270option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37271to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37272is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37273.endlist
37274
37275
37276
37277.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37278.cindex "setuid"
37279.cindex "root privilege"
37280The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37281privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37282example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37283may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37284discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37285is required for two things:
37286
37287.ilist
37288To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37289the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37290not required.
37291.next
37292To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37293perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37294configuration.
37295.endlist
37296
37297It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37298receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37299obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37300For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37301&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37302group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37303is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37304&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37305
37306Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37307abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37308&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37309
37310After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37311uid and gid in the following cases:
37312
37313.ilist
37314.oindex "&%-C%&"
37315.oindex "&%-D%&"
37316If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37317the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37318calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37319the calling process.
37320However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37321option may not be used at all.
37322If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37323can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37324user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37325.next
37326.oindex "&%-be%&"
37327.oindex "&%-bf%&"
37328.oindex "&%-bF%&"
37329If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37330(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37331calling process.
37332.next
37333If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37334process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37335uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37336runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37337testing address verification
37338.oindex "&%-bv%&"
37339.oindex "&%-bh%&"
37340(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37341option).
37342.next
37343For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37344remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37345.endlist
37346
37347The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37348
37349.ilist
37350A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37351user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37352function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37353will be used during message reception.
37354.next
37355A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37356job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37357.next
37358A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37359but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37360subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37361deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37362remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37363subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37364while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37365generating bounce and warning messages.
37366
37367While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37368process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37369this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37370gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37371.next
37372A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37373the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37374.endlist
37375
37376
37377
37378
37379.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37380.cindex "privilege, running without"
37381.cindex "unprivileged running"
37382.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37383Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37384operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37385by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37386gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37387(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37388routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37389to any other uid.
37390
37391.cindex SIGHUP
37392.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37393Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37394that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37395correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37396
37397An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37398to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37399process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37400when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37401SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37402
37403It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37404stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37405been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37406effect.
37407
37408If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37409set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37410to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37411
37412In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37413those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37414Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37415that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37416discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37417have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37418number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37419address this problem at this time.
37420
37421For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37422is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37423&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37424be used in the most straightforward way.
37425
37426If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37427number of restrictions on what you can do:
37428
37429.ilist
37430You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37431&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37432normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37433work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37434explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37435.next
37436Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37437not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37438.next
37439Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37440the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37441and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37442enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37443.next
37444Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37445some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37446
37447.olist
37448They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37449implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37450mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37451.next
37452You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37453owned by the Exim user.
37454.next
37455You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37456on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37457mailboxes need to be created manually.
37458.endlist olist
37459.endlist ilist
37460
37461
37462These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37463However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37464gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37465gives more security at essentially no cost.
37466
37467If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37468&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37469
37470
37471
37472
37473.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37474Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37475are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37476
37477
37478
37479.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37480.cindex "security" "local commands"
37481.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37482There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37483commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37484configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37485run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37486
37487.ilist
37488Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37489injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37490be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37491allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37492has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37493.next
37494A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37495&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37496&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37497hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37498NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37499forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37500need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37501.next
37502The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37503administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37504Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37505.next
37506Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37507taint checking might apply to their usage.
37508.next
37509Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37510administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37511instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37512.next
37513Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37514Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37515each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37516of opaque strings.
37517The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37518real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37519injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37520Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37521.endlist
37522
37523
37524
37525
37526.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37527.cindex "security" "data sources"
37528.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37529.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37530.cindex "PCRE" "security"
37531If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37532are some issues to be aware of:
37533
37534.ilist
37535Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37536.next
37537Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37538.next
37539Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37540data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37541"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37542expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37543when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37544possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37545data.
37546.next
37547It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37548&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37549items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37550.next
37551Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37552expected to yield one result.
37553.endlist
37554
37555
37556
37557
37558.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37559.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37560.cindex "IP source routing"
37561Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37562some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37563IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37564IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37565
37566
37567
37568.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37569Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37570be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37571
37572
37573
37574
37575.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37576.cindex "trusted users"
37577.cindex "admin user"
37578.cindex "privileged user"
37579.cindex "user" "trusted"
37580.cindex "user" "admin"
37581Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37582able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37583addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37584local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37585permit a remote host to be specified.
37586
37587.oindex "&%-f%&"
37588However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37589in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37590message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37591but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37592permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37593the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37594
37595Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37596other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37597the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37598as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37599group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37600
37601Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37602can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37603them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37604the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37605includes the contents of files on the spool.
37606
37607.oindex "&%-M%&"
37608.oindex "&%-q%&"
37609By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37610delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37611restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37612Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37613queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37614setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37615
37616Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37617the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37618the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37619group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37620the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37621unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37622files.
37623
37624
37625
37626.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37627.cindex "spool directory" "files"
37628Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37629set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37630&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37631any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37632
37633
37634
37635.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37636Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37637of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37638with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37639to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37640this.
37641
37642
37643
37644.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37645The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37646are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37647Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37648converted output.
37649
37650
37651
37652.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37653Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37654to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37655does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37656arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37657
37658
37659
37660.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37661Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37662defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37663loading it.
37664
37665
37666.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37667.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37668A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37669&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37670The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37671that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37672conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37673
37674The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37675the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37676string.
37677
37678
37679
37680.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37681Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37682formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37683the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37684
37685
37686
37687.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37688These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37689enough to hold the result.
37690.ecindex IIDsecurcon
37691
37692
37693
37694
37695. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37696. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37697
37698.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37699.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37700.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37701.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37702.cindex "spool files" "editing"
37703A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37704followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37705the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37706kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37707two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37708is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37709themselves are recoverable.
37710
37711Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37712need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37713on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37714
37715.ilist
37716You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37717fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37718which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37719place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37720lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37721.next
37722.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37723If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37724&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37725present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37726will always be the case.
37727.next
37728If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37729.next
37730If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37731signature.
37732.endlist
37733All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37734
37735Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37736its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37737files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37738the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37739the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37740is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37741file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37742-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37743attempt.
37744
37745.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37746.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37747.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37748The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37749process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37750gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37751message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37752normally the Exim user.
37753
37754The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37755transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37756empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37757in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37758created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37759&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37760leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37761&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37762
37763The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37764was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37765start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37766warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37767
37768There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37769order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37770
37771.vlist
37772.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37773This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37774&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37775recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37776this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37777identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37778the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37779the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37780the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37781newlines.
37782
37783.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37784A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37785defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37786The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37787starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37788character. It may contain internal newlines.
37789
37790.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37791A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37792Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37793length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37794starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37795character. It may contain internal newlines.
37796
37797.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37798This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37799&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37800
37801.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37802This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37803lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37804transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37805messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37806
37807.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37808This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37809(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37810time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37811hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37812
37813.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37814The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37815&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37816
37817.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37818The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37819&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37820
37821.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37822This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37823present.
37824
37825.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37826This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37827present if the number is greater than zero.
37828
37829.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37830This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37831file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37832
37833.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37834.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37835The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37836
37837.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37838This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37839command.
37840
37841.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37842This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37843the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37844messages.
37845
37846.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37847If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37848the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37849&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37850
37851.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37852This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37853address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37854
37855.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37856.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37857.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37858This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37859if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37860received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37861
37862.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37863For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37864unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37865ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37866supplied by the remote host, if any.
37867
37868.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37869This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37870which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37871generated messages.
37872
37873.vitem &%-local%&
37874The message is from a local sender.
37875
37876.vitem &%-localerror%&
37877The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37878
37879.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37880This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37881when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37882variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37883
37884.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37885The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37886Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37887
37888.vitem &%-N%&
37889A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37890actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37891&%-N%& is assumed.
37892
37893.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37894This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37895the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37896
37897.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37898The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37899to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37900
37901.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37902If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37903of &$spam_score_int$&.
37904
37905.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37906A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37907certificate was verified by the server.
37908
37909.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37910When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37911name of the cipher suite that was used.
37912
37913.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37914When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37915was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37916certificate.
37917.endlist
37918
37919Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37920is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37921line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37922is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37923the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37924balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37925to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37926original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37927addresses are complete.
37928
37929If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37930the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37931Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37932tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37933right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37934follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37935.code
37936YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37937NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37938NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37939.endd
37940After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37941This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37942recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37943delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37944example:
37945.code
379464
37947editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37948darcy@austen.fict.example
37949rdo@foundation
37950alice@wonderland.fict.example
37951.endd
37952However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37953result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37954line is of the following form:
37955.display
37956<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37957 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37958.endd
37959The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37960the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37961fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37962original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37963envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37964length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37965characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37966that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37967
37968
37969A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37970which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37971when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37972character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37973embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37974following:
37975
37976.table2 50pt
37977.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37978.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37979.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37980.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37981.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37982.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37983.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37984.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37985.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37986.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37987.endtable
37988
37989Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37990purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37991typical set of headers:
37992.code
37993111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37994id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37995049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37996038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37997042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37998049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37999099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38000darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38001104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38002darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38003038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38004.endd
38005The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38006&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38007unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38008.ecindex IIDforspo1
38009.ecindex IIDforspo2
38010.ecindex IIDforspo3
38011
38012. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38013. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38014
38015.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38016 "DKIM Support"
38017.cindex "DKIM"
38018
38019DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38020linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38021be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38022DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38023
38024.new
38025DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38026.wen
38027It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38028
38029Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
38030.olist
38031Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38032It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38033(including transport filters)
38034except cutthrough delivery.
38035.next
38036Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38037ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38038different signature contexts.
38039.endlist
38040
38041In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38042default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38043Exim's standard controls.
38044
38045Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38046on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38047exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38048signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38049.code
380502009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38051 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38052 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38053 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38054.endd
38055You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38056or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38057control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38058where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38059senders).
38060
38061
38062.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38063.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38064
38065Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38066These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38067
38068.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
38069MANDATORY:
38070The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
38071option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
38072
38073.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
38074MANDATORY:
38075This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
38076variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
38077variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38078option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38079
38080.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38081MANDATORY:
38082This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38083&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38084The result can either
38085.ilist
38086be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38087.next
38088start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38089the private key.
38090.next
38091be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38092be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38093is set.
38094.endlist
38095
38096.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38097OPTIONAL:
38098This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38099The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38100The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38101only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38102
38103.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38104OPTIONAL:
38105This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38106should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38107either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38108unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38109variables here.
38110
38111.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38112OPTIONAL:
38113When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38114list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38115signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
38116used.
38117
38118
38119.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38120.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38121
38122Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
38123&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38124syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38125A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38126If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38127If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
38128summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38129
38130To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38131containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38132runtime of the ACL.
38133
38134Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38135more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38136&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38137&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38138
38139The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38140list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38141called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38142the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38143list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38144&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38145it defaults as:
38146.code
38147dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38148.endd
38149This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38150DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38151call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38152.code
38153dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38154.endd
38155This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38156and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38157You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38158.code
38159dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38160.endd
38161
38162If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38163&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38164
38165
38166Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38167available (from most to least important):
38168
38169
38170.vlist
38171.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38172The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38173an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38174&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38175.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38176A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38177.ilist
38178&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38179identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38180.next
38181&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38182More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38183.next
38184&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38185available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38186.next
38187&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38188.endlist
38189.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38190A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38191"fail" or "invalid". One of
38192.ilist
38193&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38194key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38195.next
38196&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38197record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38198.next
38199&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38200body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38201means that the message body was modified in transit.
38202.next
38203&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38204could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38205re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38206DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38207.endlist
38208.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38209The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38210an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38211reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38212.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38213The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38214if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38215identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38216.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38217The key record selector string.
38218.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38219The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38220.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38221The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38222.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
38223The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38224.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38225A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38226(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38227.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38228The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38229limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38230that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38231.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38232UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38233When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38234.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38235UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38236signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38237signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38238integer size comparisons against this value.
38239.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38240A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38241.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38242"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38243.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38244"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38245.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38246Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38247in the key record.
38248.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38249Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38250in the key record.
38251.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38252Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38253.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38254Number of bits in the key.
38255.endlist
38256
38257In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38258
38259.vlist
38260.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38261ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38262for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38263(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38264verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38265
38266.code
38267# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
38268warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
38269 sender_domains = gmail.com
38270 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38271 dkim_status = none
38272.endd
38273
38274.vitem &%dkim_status%&
38275ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38276results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38277to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38278
38279.code
38280deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38281 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38282 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38283 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38284.endd
38285
38286The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38287see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38288for more information of what they mean.
38289.endlist
38290
38291. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38292. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38293
38294.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38295 "Proxy support"
38296.cindex "proxy support"
38297.cindex "proxy" "access via"
38298
38299.new
38300A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38301Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38302
38303
38304.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38305.cindex proxy inbound
38306.cindex proxy "server side"
38307.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38308.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38309
38310Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38311that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38312To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38313in Local/Makefile.
38314
38315It was built on specifications from:
38316http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt
38317That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38318http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e
38319
38320The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38321such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38322to distribute load.
38323Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38324the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38325There is no logging if a host passes or
38326fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38327recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38328
38329Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38330main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38331hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38332
38333The following expansion variables are usable
38334(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38335of the proxy):
38336.display
38337&'proxy_host_address '& internal IP address of the proxy
38338&'proxy_host_port '& internal TCP port of the proxy
38339&'proxy_target_address '& external IP address of the proxy
38340&'proxy_target_port '& external TCP port of the proxy
38341&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38342.endd
38343If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_host_address$& is empty
38344there was a protocol error.
38345
38346Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38347per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38348evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38349handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38350With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38351to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38352In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38353need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38354A possible solution is:
38355.display
38356 # Set max number of connections per host
38357 LIMIT = 5
38358 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38359 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38360
38361 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38362 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38363.endd
38364
38365
38366
38367.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38368.cindex proxy outbound
38369.cindex proxy "client side"
38370.cindex proxy SOCKS
38371.cindex SOCKS proxy
38372Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38373using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38374The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38375Local/Makefile.
38376
38377Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38378on an smtp transport.
38379The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38380(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38381Each proxy specifier is a list
38382(space-separated by default) where the initial element
38383is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38384
38385Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38386The list of options is in the following table:
38387.display
38388&'auth '& authentication method
38389&'name '& authentication username
38390&'pass '& authentication password
38391&'port '& tcp port
38392&'tmo '& connection timeout
38393&'pri '& priority
38394&'weight '& selection bias
38395.endd
38396
38397More details on each of these options follows:
38398
38399.ilist
38400.cindex authentication "to proxy"
38401.cindex proxy authentication
38402&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38403Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38404for access to the proxy.
38405Default is &"none"&.
38406.next
38407&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38408Default is empty.
38409.next
38410&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38411Default is empty.
38412.next
38413&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38414Default is 1080.
38415.next
38416&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38417Default is 5.
38418.next
38419&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38420higher values being tried first.
38421The default priority is 1.
38422.next
38423&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38424Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38425weighted by this value.
38426The default value for selection bias is 1.
38427.endlist
38428
38429Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38430and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38431overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38432
38433.section Logging SECTproxyLog
38434To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38435add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38436This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38437.wen
38438
38439. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38440. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38441
38442.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38443 "Internationalisation""
38444.cindex internationalisation "email address"
38445.cindex EAI
38446.cindex i18n
38447.cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38448
38449.new
38450Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38451To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38452Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38453
38454.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38455.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38456The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38457a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38458accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38459SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38460
38461If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38462international handling for the message is enabled and
38463the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38464
38465The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38466message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38467whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38468when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38469
38470Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38471UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38472require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38473the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38474
38475HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38476components expanded to a-label form,
38477and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38478form of the name.
38479
38480.cindex log protocol
38481.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38482Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38483prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38484
38485The following expansion operator can be used:
38486.code
38487${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38488${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38489${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38490${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38491.endd
38492
38493ACLs may use the following modifier:
38494.display
38495control = utf8_downconvert
38496control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38497.endd
38498This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38499a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38500Message Submission Agent context.
38501If a value is appended it may be:
38502.display
38503&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
38504&`0 `& no downconversion
38505&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
38506.endd
38507
38508If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
38509is initially set to -1.
38510
38511
38512There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
38513Configurations supporting these should inspect
38514&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
38515
38516There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
38517Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
38518for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
38519
38520There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
38521and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
38522
38523
38524
38525.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
38526To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
38527the following expansion operator can be used:
38528.code
38529${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
38530.endd
38531
38532The string is converted from the charset specified by
38533the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
38534or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
38535to the
38536modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
38537with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
38538(which has to be a single character)
38539are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
38540<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
38541
38542The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
38543The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
38544
38545This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
38546by many other IMAP servers.
38547
38548Examples:
38549.display
38550&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
38551&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
38552&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
38553.endd
38554
38555Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
38556must be representable in UTF-16.
38557
38558.wen
38559
38560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38561. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38562
38563.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
38564 "Events"
38565.cindex events
38566
38567.new
38568The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
38569of points. It was originally invented to giave a way to do customised logging
38570actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
38571processing actions.
38572
38573Most installations will never need to use Events.
38574The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
38575in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38576
38577There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
38578The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
38579a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
38580
38581Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
38582An example might look like:
38583.cindex logging custom
38584.code
38585event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
38586{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
38587 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
38588 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
38589 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
38590 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
38591 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
38592 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
38593 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
38594} {}}
38595.endd
38596
38597Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
38598The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
38599expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
38600
38601The current list of events is:
38602.display
38603&`msg:complete after main `& per message
38604&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
38605&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
38606&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
38607&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
38608&`msg:fail:delivery after main `& per recipient
38609&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
38610&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
38611&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
38612&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
38613&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
38614.endd
38615New event types may be added in future.
38616
38617The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
38618event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
38619or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
38620
38621The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
38622before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
38623can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
38624
38625An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
38626with the event type:
38627.display
38628&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation mssage
38629&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
38630&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
38631&`msg:host:defer `& error string
38632&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
38633&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
38634.endd
38635
38636The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
38637
38638For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
38639however due to the multiple contextx that Exim operates in during
38640the course of its processing:
38641.ilist
38642variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
38643transport call
38644.next
38645acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
38646and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
38647.endlist
38648Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
38649a useful way of writing to the main log.
38650
38651The expansion of the event_action option should normally
38652return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
38653following will be forced:
38654.display
38655&`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
38656&`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
38657&`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
38658&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
38659&`tcp:close `& (ignored)
38660&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
38661&`smtp:connect `& close connection
38662.endd
38663No other use is made of the result string.
38664
38665For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
38666then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
38667the target system.
38668
38669For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
38670chain element received on the connection.
38671For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
38672loaded locally.
38673.wen
38674
38675. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38676. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38677
38678.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
38679 "Adding drivers or lookups"
38680.cindex "adding drivers"
38681.cindex "new drivers, adding"
38682.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
38683The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
38684authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
38685
38686.olist
38687Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38688existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38689.next
38690Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38691.display
38692<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38693.endd
38694where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38695code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38696should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38697.next
38698Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38699.code
38700#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38701.endd
38702.next
38703Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38704and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38705.next
38706Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38707near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38708Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38709As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38710simple form that most lookups have.
38711.next
38712Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38713&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38714driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38715.next
38716Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38717&_src_&.
38718.next
38719Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38720as for other drivers and lookups.
38721.endlist
38722
38723Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38724proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38725occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38726options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38727searched using a binary chop procedure.
38728
38729There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38730the interface that is expected.
38731
38732
38733
38734
38735. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38736. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38737
38738. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38739. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38740. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38741. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38742. processors.
38743. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38744
38745.literal xml
38746<?sdop
38747 format="newpage"
38748 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38749 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38750?>
38751.literal off
38752
38753.makeindex "Options index" "option"
38754.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38755.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38756
38757
38758. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38759. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////